2014 - Internal Audit of Plantation Industry

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 205

GUIDANCE NOTE

ON
INTERNAL AUDIT
OF
PLANTATION INDUSTRY

PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT COMMITTEE

HQ: CMA Bhawan, 12, Sudder Street, Kolkata-700 016


Delhi Office: CMA Bhawan, 3, Institutional Area, Lodhi Road, New Delhi-110003
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

Professional Development Committee of The Institute of Cost Accountants of India


(2014-15):

Chairman

CMA Dr. S C Mohanty Member

CMA Rakesh Singh Member

CMA M. Gopalakrishnan Member

CMA Dr. Sanjay R Bhargave Member

CMA Manas Kumar Thakur Member

Shri G. Sreekumar, Government Nominee Member

Dr. Asish K Bhattacharya (Co-opted) Member

CMA. J.K. Budhiraja Director (PD) and Secretary to PD


Committee
INDEX OF CONTENTS
Chapter Description Page No
1 Introduction to Internal Audit 1-13
2 Documentation and Working Papers 14-15
3 Planning an Internal Audit and Audit Programme 16-18
4 Audit Sampling 19-20
5 Audit Evidence 21-21
6 Analytical Procedures 22-23
7 Accounting System and Internal Control 24-25
8 Control and Risk Assessment 26-27
9 Internal Audit in ERP Environment and Systems Audit 28-30
10 Relying on External Opinion and Reference of Auditor Expert 31-32
11 Audit Conclusion and Corrective Measures 33-34
12 Report Writing and Audit Report 35-37
13 Introduction to Plantation Industry 38-66
14 Special transactions peculiar to the industry 67-69
15 Activities/ Services of the industry 70-71
16 Audit of Plantation Industry 72-93
17 Audit of Special Areas with reference to peculiar transactions 94-119
18 Audit of Functional Areas 120-170
19 Maintenance of Cost Records and Cost Audit specific to the Industry 171-174
20 Audit Follow up 175-175
21 Annexure I: Form – CRA-1 176-199

22 Annexure II: Form CRA-3 200-201


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Chapter 1 Introduction to Internal Audit

Introduction
Shocking revelations of failures of the Management of renowned enterprises across the Globe to
run the enterprise in a manner that would serve the interest of the stake-holders shook the
business world time and again over the past decade. More importantly, many of these enterprises
were the ones which once struck the imagination of the business world through their
phenomenal growth, riding on their aggressive policies. Investigation for the causes of the failures
brought to the fore certain aspects which were highlighted as the primary causes of the failure,
viz.
1. Aggressive business policies, which ignored the regular policies and practices of the entity
and which could not be sustained
2. Lack of financial discipline and
3. Lack of transparency in the functioning of the Management which prevented timely
detection of the early signals of failure that if known and corrective actions taken, could
prevent a complete debacle.
Thus, the need for improved Corporate Governance which would be in line with the principles of
prudence, sustainability and transparency, were felt necessary. The initial emphasis on Corporate
Governance subsequently gave way to Enterprise Governance with more focus on performance
analysis rather than mere compliance.
Now, even the best business models backed by the best Corporate Governance practices need
perpetual monitoring and critical appraisal of its activities, which is accomplished through
“Internal auditing”.
While earlier internal audit focused on the arithmetical accuracy of the accounting records, in
finding out whether there is any material misstatement and safeguarding the assets of the entity,
with increased emphasis on ‘Enterprise Governance’, internal audit additionally encompasses the
efficacy of the internal control system to churn-out the correct, relevant and timely information,
effectiveness of the decisions taken towards implementation of the policies and plans, adherence
to the statutes, regulations and norms, optimum utilization of the resources and the evaluation of
perceived risks and the effectiveness of the internal control system to identify and mitigate these
risks.
Failure to provide good governance and ensure financial discipline is not limited to the private or
public enterprises. Even the Indian Government has over the years failed to control its fiscal
deficit and the major cause of which can be assigned to failure for the government to control its
non-plan expenditure and lack of prudent and sustainable models for successful execution of
projects under the Five-year plans.
Any well-organized enterprise, whatever may be its objective, has different types of functions
which are assigned to different departments and each type of function involves several activities.
Internal audit depending on its Scope and Terms of Engagement can and should ideally
encompass all the functions of an Enterprise. Thus, Internal Audit generally is a multi-disciplinary
audit which might require the services of professionals from various disciplines depending on the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 1


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
nature of the activities of the Enterprise.
An internal audit does not ensure discovery of all material misstatements, deliberate
misrepresentation by the management or fraud committed because the audit does not involve
exhaustive examination of all transactions and activities and is based on selective verification, the
nature and extent of which depends on the judgment of the auditor of what would constitute
sufficient appropriate audit evidence.
The extent of verification of individual transactions depends primarily upon the auditor’s
appraisal of the internal control system, adequacy of its design and structure and the
effectiveness of its functioning. If the auditor is satisfied with this appraisal then he may decide on
‘auditing in depth’, selectively; using ‘statistical sampling techniques’ for selection.
‘Auditing in depth’ involves tracing a transaction through its various stages from origin to
conclusion, examining the supporting records at each stage and ascertaining whether all the
requirements laid down in the system of internal check have been complied with.
On several occasions the auditor has to exercise his judgment on ‘Materiality’. ‘Materiality’ in
audit depends on the size and nature of the item and is judged in the particular
circumstances of its misstatement. Thus while the amount of an item is significant in judging
the concept of ‘Materiality’ (e.g. the amount of an expenditure compared to the total
expenditure or the value of an item of fixed asset compared to the total value of fixed assets),
whether it could influence the economic decisions of the user of the information, needs to be
judged as well.
Defining Internal Audit
Internal Audit can be defined as “an independent, objective assurance and consulting activity
which involves a continuous and critical appraisal of the functioning of an entity designed to add
value and improve an organization's internal control system, risk assessment and management
mechanism and overall governance mechanism”.
The definition brings to the fore the following points:
1. Independent and objective assurance.
The internal audit activities should be free from any interference and the auditor should not be
influenced by anything that might hamper his objectivity thus ensuring that the findings of the
audit are free from any bias. Therefore, the auditor needs to be insulated from the auditee. The
appointment of the internal auditor and determination of the internal audit is made by the Audit
Committee working under the Board of Directors. The auditor should instantly report any
occurrence of his authority and rights as an auditor being curtailed to an extent which would
prevent him from carrying out his duties.
2. Continuous and critical appraisal of the functioning.
The internal audit is a perpetual exercise and involves critical assessment of the activities of the
entity. For critical appraisal the auditor needs to gather sufficient, relevant information of the
organizational structure, statutory and regulatory requirements, policy, plans, practices and
procedures of the entity along with live information about how the entity carried out its activities
in adherence with the organizational, statutory and regulatory requirements.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 2


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
3. To improve the effectiveness of the risk management, control and governance process.
The primary objective of the internal audit exercise is to ascertain the scope for continual
improvement in the operations of the entity by assessing the shortcomings and thereby ensuring
value addition. Improvement can be achieved in the internal control system, the inbuilt system of
identification, assessment and mitigation of the risks and overall corporate governance. The
auditor’s assessment of the existing internal control system and risk management framework
brings to the fore the adequacy of the existing framework and auditor while pointing out the
lapses or shortcomings in the existing framework, is required to give suggestions for its
improvement whereby the entity is fortified to maximize value to its stakeholders.
Necessity of Internal Audit
The emergence of the corporate governance culture has witnessed paradigm shift in the way
today’s companies operate. Organizations of today are more system dependent than people
dependent. It is necessary that the systems are robust and flexible enough for the organizations
to be responsive and effective. Hence, today’s audit focus is more on whether the systems are
performing than on whether people are performing. The audit function has changed to reflect
this phenomenon over time.
During the 20th century, the necessity of internalizing the audit function was felt to tackle the
issues related to non-compliance or non-adherence to the internal operating procedures. It was
essential to observe whether the operating processes and procedures in the organization are
efficient and effective.
In the current parlance, the need for the internal audit has become more comprehensive and has
definitely scoped beyond mere compliance. The organizations of today look at the internal audit
function to provide the assurance on the following aspects of the business:
 To comment on the accuracy and reliability of the financial and other information generated
within the organization
 To assess and suggest whether the internal policies & procedures and the external laws are
properly complied with

 To identify and assess the risks associated with the assets and comment whether they are
providing a fair return to the company

 To critically evaluate whether the operational resources are used efficiently and economically
It is necessary for every company to continuously ensure authenticity and reliability of data
generated and used for decision making and also to avoid duplication of data. It is necessary to
verify the source, the quantum and the reliability of all records. The Internal Audit function will
primarily concentrate on the system for collection, collation and analysis of data to go into final
cost compilation and decision making. The main objective of Internal Audit of Accounts is, to
ensure implementation of Control and continuous monitoring of systems being followed.
When Internal Audit is carried out for the first time, the ground rule for Internal Audit needs to be
laid down, inter alia, including;

 The Internal Audit will primarily concentrate on flow of data and justification of basis

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 3


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
instead of vouching.
 The materiality of cost and product under consideration would always be borne in mind
during Internal Audit process.
 Objectivity in approach would be a consistent feature in Internal Audit.
 Main thrust would always be on deviations and significance of deviations with impact of
the same on the performance of the organization.
As the Internal audit cycle stabilizes, it will help companies in the following areas:
1. Assess Compliance
The organization needs to adhere to rules, regulations, laws, codes of practice, guidelines and
principles as they apply individually and collectively to all parts. The Internal Audit cycle
periodically checks such compliances and reviews their adequacy.
2. Monitoring Controls
The Internal Audit function must clearly understand the quality and risk management philosophy
of the organization before evaluating or reporting on the efficiency and effectiveness of the
implementation of management policies.
3. Analyze Operational Performance
Internal Audit function works closely with lower and middle level managers to review daily
operations then report their findings. The strategic objectives of the organization play a significant
role in understanding how the operations of any given part of the organization fit into the macro
level picture.
4. Evaluation on Risk based approach
Internal Audit function identifies key accomplishments and relevant risk factors while evaluating
their significance. Any important change in business, economic, political or social conditions
impact the way the internal audit function must assess risk. The role of internal auditing has
changed from being a reactive and post mortem form to a more proactive and risk based
approach. This enables the internal auditor to anticipate possible future threats and opportunities
while simultaneously identifying current concerns and providing their preventives.
The increased interaction between the evolving internal audit function and the management is an
important area for organizations to focus on and develop for both short and long term benefits.
Once risk factors are identified by the management based on data generated from Internal Audit,
it is utmost necessary to assess the quantum and seriousness of risk. For example, various
Companies started manufacturing in Hilly States like Himachal Pradesh, Uttarakhand, and Jammu
& Kashmir and of late in Sikkim and North Indian states. These units will enjoy benefit of
exemption from Excise Duty, VAT and Income Tax. Further, past experience had shown that the
incentives offered can get diluted half the way causing losses and some times, viability of the new
unit. Under such, circumstances, the function of Internal Audit has to be proactive instead of
reactive. The Internal Audit should go beyond the records available within the Company.
Objectives and Principles of Internal Audit
Internal audit primarily serves the following objectives:
1. Reviewing compliance with
(a) The policies and plans of the entity being audited

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 4


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(b) The relevant statutory and regulatory requirements
(c) The internal and external norms, guidelines, financial and cost accounting standards and
procedures
2. Ascertaining to what extent the existing internal control system is being adhered to,
assessing the efficacy of the internal control system and suggesting improvement in the
internal control system.
3. Reviewing the management information system to ascertain the adequacy, relevance,
reliability and timeliness of the system and security of the information flowing through the
system.
4. Assessment of the risks confronting the entity and the effectiveness of the risk management
system to mitigate the risk and suggesting means for the improvement of the system. The
auditor may also identify risks and suggest ways to mitigate the same.
5. Ensuring optimum utilization of the resources of the entity which include both tangible
resources and intangible resource like time.
6. Providing a reasonable assurance that the financial statements and the cost statements are
free from material misstatement
7. Safeguarding the assets of the entity.
8. Timely identification of a liability of the entity, including contingent liability.
Basic Principles
Proper conduct of the internal audit requires that the following principles be adhered to:
1. Independence of the auditor is a primary requirement for any audit which aims at ensuring
that the outcome of the audit is not prejudiced. While there have been serious efforts to
ensure “independence” by laying down in the Indian Companies Act, certain relationships
between the auditor and the auditee, existence of which will deter a person from being the
auditor, these cannot be the only test for lack of independence of the auditor. Accordingly it
is more important for the auditor to act professionally, maintaining the highest levels of
ethics and competence and not to give in to any interference in performing his duties. The
auditor should refrain from getting himself involved in any activity which might be construed
as affecting his impartial attitude or objectivity. He should also not judge an activity in which
he is involved.
2. The internal auditor should be professionally competent and exercise care, diligence and skill
necessary for discharging his responsibilities, the extent of which depends on the scope of
the assignment and auditor’s assessment of the environment in which he is discharging his
duties. Audit environment is determined by the nature of the organization, its internal
control system and the complexities of its activities.
3. The internal auditor should ensure confidentiality of the information received by him in the
course of the audit. Unless he is otherwise required by any legal, regulatory or professional
pronouncement, he shall not divulge any information without the express consent of the
management.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 5


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
4. The internal auditor is primarily responsible for expressing his opinion on the areas subjected
to audit and therefore he has to take sufficient care to be satisfied that he can adequately
rely on the work performed by other professionals/experts, before he uses the work done by
others in forming his opinion. Similarly, if he delegates any portion of the audit-work to his
assistants he should carefully supervise and review the work.
5. Like any other audit, documentation is very important in internal audit as it provides
evidence of the audit having been conducted in accordance with the applicable standards
and substantiate that his findings are based on sufficient appropriate evidence which forms
the basis of his opinion. It also helps in current and future planning of the audit-work,
supervision and review of the audit functions.
6. Effective and timely conduct of any activity depends largely on the efficiency of the planning
which precedes the performance of the activity. Internal audit is not an exception. It is
imperative for the auditor to carefully plan his work which shall primarily focus on the
selection of skilled personnel in accordance with the degree of complexity and materiality
involved extent of work to be done for obtaining sufficient and appropriate evidence and the
time frame for completion of each activity. The planning process shall start with
understanding the legal and regulatory framework within which the entity operates, the
hierarchical structure of the organization, the organizational policy and plans, the activities
and the processes carried out, the design and efficacy of the financial and cost accounting
systems, internal control system and risk management system and above all the terms of
engagement. Like every other plan, internal audit plan needs to be reviewed and altered
from time to time to meet the changing circumstances.
7. The final output of the internal audit is the audit report which shall be carefully drafted to
ensure lucid communication of the findings of the audit relating primarily to the
shortcomings of the internal control system, risk management system and the governance
processes and the measures required for correction and improvement. The audit report shall
also highlight on other issues which in the opinion of the auditor should be brought to the
notice of the management. A discovery of fraud or misappropriation of assets should be
brought to the notice of the management instantly without waiting for the delivery of the
formal audit report.
Internal Audit Strategy and Approaches
There are several different approaches to Internal Audit. International best practice suggests that
systems audit is the most effective way that Internal Audit can add value to an organization.
However, it is considered necessary for Internal Audit to complement systems audit with a pre-
audit approach. If a pre- audit approach is adopted the Head of Internal Audit, the Audit
Committee and the CFO/CEO should discuss the extent that this is necessary. They should also
consider suitable means of reducing the proportion of time that Internal Auditors spend on pre-
audit work.
The systems approach to Internal Audit seeks to assess and improve the effectiveness of the
organization’s internal control system.
The prime purpose of a systems Audit should be to evaluate the extent to which the system may

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 6


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
be relied upon to ensure that the objectives of the system are met.
Where internal controls are not adequate and reliable Internal Audit should make practical
recommendations to ensure that these controls are improved.
Internal Audit evidence should be adequate to meet the objectives of Audit assignments.
Internal Auditors should be satisfied with the nature, adequacy and relevance of Audit evidence
before placing reliance on that evidence. Information should be collected analyzed and
documented by the use of appropriate Audit techniques.
The production of Audit evidence should be supervised and reviewed by the Head of Internal
Audit. To meet an acceptable standard the evidence should be sufficiently adequate and
convincing to the extent that a prudent, informed person would be able to appreciate how the
Auditor’s conclusions were reached.
Internal Audit may also complement its systems approach with other techniques, for example:
 Performance auditing;
 Control self assessment;
 Advice and assistance on control issues;
 Helping with risk management.
Conclusions are the Internal Auditor’s evaluations of the effects of the findings on the particular
system reviewed. They should:
 Put the findings in perspective based on the overall implications and significance of the
weaknesses identified;
 Identify the extent to which the system’s control objectives are being achieved and the
degree to which the internal control systems should ensure that the goals and objectives of
the organization are accomplished efficiently.
Management should be required to respond in writing to each Internal Audit report.
Management and Internal Audit should agree officer responsibility and target dates for
implementation of agreed recommendations. The responsibility for final editing of Audit reports
should remain with the Head of Internal Audit who should always retain the right to issue reports
without further editing.
Follow-up activity is the process by which Internal Audit confirms that agreed recommendations
have been implemented by line managers. Internal Audit should periodically follow up Audit
reports to review and test the implementation of agreed Internal Audit recommendations.
The Head of the Internal Audit should submit to the CFO/CEO and Audit Committee, at agreed
intervals, a report of Internal Audit activity and results. The report should compare actual Internal
Audit activity against the annual Internal Audit plan and should clearly indicate the extent to
which the total Internal Audit needs of the public sector organization have been met.
In the annual Internal Audit report the Head of the Internal Audit should give a formal opinion to
the CFO/CEO and Audit Committee on the extent to which reliance can be placed on the
organization’s internal control system. The attention of the CFO/CEO and Audit Committee should
be drawn to any major Internal Audit findings where action appears to be necessary but has not

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 7


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
been undertaken.
Terms of engagement of Internal Auditor
Unlike a statutory audit where the scope of the audit and the authority and responsibility of the
auditor is guided by the statute under which the appointment is made, in case of internal audit
these and several other aspects are ascertained specifically for each audit engagement and
decided and agreed upon jointly by the internal auditor and the auditee. Thus in case of an
internal audit the audit engagement letter assumes special significance. The letter may be drawn
up by the auditor but it needs to be approved by the Board of Directors or the Audit Committee
or any person officially authorized for this purpose. The drawing up of the letter is preceded by
extensive discussion on the terms of the internal audit which shall include:
1. Scope: The broad areas which should be covered by the audit and what is expected from the
auditor should be clearly laid down in the engagement letter. Internal audit generally serves
the “objectives” mentioned in the previous chapter but the functions of the auditor and
what is expected as the output of the audit e.g. observations, suggestion and
recommendations in general or on a specific function of the entity, should be outlined. It
shall also mention that the internal auditor is not required to express an opinion or issue any
sort of assurance on the financial statements.
2. Responsibility: While most of the auditor’s responsibilities arise from the scope of the audit
and the statutory and professional pronouncements, the responsibility of the auditee which
plays an important role in the effective completion of the audit needs to be mentioned in the
engagement letter along with the responsibility of the internal auditor. The auditor’s
responsibility includes timely intimation of material weakness or other major issues related
to the internal control system and material misstatements in the cost and financial
information to the management and others to whom the auditor is required to intimate. The
auditee’s primary responsibility is to extend fullest co-operation to the audit team and
provide correct and precise data, information and records in time.
3. Authority: The auditor should be authorized to have unhindered access to the data,
information, records, properties and personnel. He should have the authority to call for
information from the concerned department/personnel and to carry out audit procedures
using his technologies, hardware and audit tools.
4. Confidentiality: The engagement letter shall mention that the auditor will ensure full
confidentiality of the data, information and records accessed in the course of the audit
subject to any statutory obligation to share the same with any authority. While the audit
working papers are the sole property of the auditor, he may share non-proprietary
information with the auditee and the engagement letter shall mention the modalities for
sharing of information with the auditee and third parties like the external auditor or for the
purpose of ‘peer-review’.
5. Limitation: The audit engagement letter should mention any limitation on scope, coverage
and reporting requirement if there is any. For example, the letter may state that the internal
auditor or any of its team members shall not be liable for any claim, damage, liability or
expense relating to the engagement more than the aggregate amount of compensation

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 8


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
agreed between the auditor and the audited.
6. Reporting: The manner of reporting, the periodicity of reporting and the intended recipients
of the report should be clearly mentioned in the letter.
7. Compensation: The remuneration payable for the audit assignment and what expenses
incurred in connection with the audit will be reimbursed to the internal auditor and to what
extent, shall be mentioned in the audit engagement letter.
8. Compliance with the standards: The audit engagement letter shall contain a statement that
the auditor will comply with the applicable professional pronouncements.
The terms of audit engagement shall be reviewed from time to time jointly by the auditor and
the auditee in relation to the changing circumstances or requirements and the addition or
alteration in the terms shall be documented in form of the audit engagement letter.
Independence of Internal Auditor
From the definition of internal audit, it is quite evident that the internal auditor’s opinion has to
be independent. This would mean that the opinion is free from any biases. The independence
could be ensured that the person performing the duties as an internal auditor is in no way
participating in any of the activities of the organization.
The Institution of Internal Auditors defines independence as “the freedom from conditions that
threaten the ability of the internal auditor to carry out internal auditing responsibility in an
unbiased manner”. It is essential to understand potential impairment threats to the objectivity
and independence of the internal auditor.
The auditor should ensure that the staff that engaged is not connected with the business of the
auditee company in a manner that would potentially lead to any conflict of interest. E.g. in case of
a bank audit, no audit team member should be a major borrower or investor with the bank.
Further, Independence of an Internal Audit team helps to distinguish it from all other internal
controls, systems and procedures. The Internal Audit function is not subject to the authority of
the areas of the organization that it audits. Thus, 'operational independence' is ensured and the
entire exercise is objective, impartial and free from any conflict of interest, inherent bias or undue
external influence. Although the internal audit function is independent in its working, it provides
a service to the management, reports to the Audit Committee and is ultimately accountable to
the Chief Executive or the Board for the achievement of its set objectives and the utilization of
resources.
The independence presupposes that the internal auditor would have a direct access to the
information, the systems, and also a communication link with the management. Without this
support the independence will remain only on paper thus hampering the quality of the audit.
It is required that the work of internal auditor should be free of any undue influence. This would
ensure that there won’t be any significant hindrance or restriction of his/her work and also on the
contents of the report. Of course, the internal auditor should be able to use professional
judgment and should not ignore materiality when reporting matters.
A general list is given below:

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 9


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
a) The internal audit function must report directly to the Audit Committee
b) The lead internal auditor must have direct access to the Chairman of the Audit committee
and the Board of Directors
c) Regular meetings must be held between the lead Internal auditor and the management
d) Any external consultants approached by the internal audit function must be validated by the
management
e) The internal audit charter should not include any activity which may be or lead to a conflict
of interest
The above mentioned steps helps the internal audit function maintain objectivity and undertake
judgment based purely on tangible evidence devoid of influence.
Pronouncements on Internal Audit
The compliance with the laws of the home country as well as the laws of the foreign country land
for existence of businesses in India and abroad is a critical factor. As per the legal obligation /
requirement under different statutes in India and abroad a Company shall have internal audit of
its accounts carried out, at such interval and in such manner as may be specified.
Clause 49 of Listing Agreement: Corporate Governance (SCRA)
In case of the listed companies as per the Clause 49 of Listing Agreement the audit committee
should be reviewing the adequacy of internal audit function, if any, including the structure of the
internal audit department, staffing and seniority of the official heading the department, reporting
structure, coverage and frequency of internal audit.
Under Section 177 of the Companies Act 2013 the internal auditor, if any, shall attend and
participate at meetings of the Audit Committee of the company.
The provisions for constitution of the Audit Committee under Section 292A of the Companies Act
1956 has been replaced by Section 177 of the Companies Act 2013, which are as follows:
177. (1) The Board of Directors of every listed company and such other class or classes of
companies, as may be prescribed, shall constitute an Audit Committee.
(2) The Audit Committee shall consist of a minimum of three directors with independent directors
forming a majority:
Provided that majority of members of Audit Committee including its Chairperson shall be persons
with ability to read and understand, the financial statement.
(3) Every Audit Committee of a company existing immediately before the commencement of this
Act shall, within one year of such commencement, be reconstituted in accordance with sub-
section (2).
(4) Every Audit Committee shall act in accordance with the terms of reference specified in writing
by the Board which shall, inter alia, include,—
(i) The recommendation for appointment, remuneration and terms of appointment of
auditors of the company;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 10


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(ii) Review and monitor the auditor’s independence and performance, and effectiveness of
audit process;
(iii) Examination of the financial statement and the auditors’ report thereon;
(iv) Approval or any subsequent modification of transactions of the company with related
parties;
(v) Scrutiny of inter-corporate loans and investments;
(vi) Valuation of undertakings or assets of the company, wherever it is necessary;
(vii) Evaluation of internal financial controls and risk management systems;
(viii) Monitoring the end use of funds raised through public offers and related matters.
(5) The Audit Committee may call for the comments of the auditors about internal control
systems, the scope of audit, including the observations of the auditors and review of financial
statement before their submission to the Board and may also discuss any related issues with the
internal and statutory auditors and the management of the company.
(6) The Audit Committee shall have authority to investigate into any matter in relation to the
items specified in sub-section (4) or referred to it by the Board and for this purpose shall have
power to obtain professional advice from external sources and have full access to information
contained in the records of the company.
(7) The auditors of a company and the key managerial personnel shall have a right to be heard in
the meetings of the Audit Committee when it considers the auditor’s report but shall not have
the right to vote.
(8) The Board’s report under sub-section (3) of section 134 shall disclose the composition of an
Audit Committee and where the Board had not accepted any recommendation of the Audit
Committee, the same shall be disclosed in such report along with the reasons therefore.
(9) Every listed company or such class or classes of companies, as may be prescribed, shall
establish a vigil mechanism for directors and employees to report genuine concerns in such
manner as may be prescribed.
(10) The vigil mechanism under sub-section (9) shall provide for adequate safeguards against
victimisation of persons who use such mechanism and make provision for direct access to the
chairperson of the Audit Committee in appropriate or exceptional cases:
Provided that the details of establishment of such mechanism shall be disclosed by the company
on its website, if any, and in the Board’s report.
Section 138(1) of the Companies Act provides that such class or classes of companies as may be
prescribed shall be required to appoint an internal auditor, who shall either be a chartered
accountant or a cost accountant, or such other professional as may be decided by the Board to
conduct internal audit of the functions and activities of the company.
Under SEBI Circular No. MRD/DMS/Cir-29/2008, October 21, 2008 in partial modification of SEBI
circular No. MIRSD/ DPSIII/ Cir-26/ 08 dated August 22, 2008 on the above subject, the SEBI has
mandated that stock brokers/trading members/clearing members shall carry out complete

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 11


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
internal audit on a half yearly basis by chartered accountants, company secretaries or cost and
management accountants who are in practice and who do not have any conflict of interest.
Under Circular of SEBI No. SEBI/MIRSD/CRA/Cir-01/2010 dated January 06, 2010 Internal Audit
for Credit Rating Agencies (CRAs) has been prescribed under Regulation 22 of the SEBI (Credit
Rating Regulations), 1999, which shall be undertaken on a half yearly basis and shall be
conducted by Chartered Accountants, Company Secretaries or Cost and Management
Accountants who are in practice and who do not have any conflict of interest with the CRA.
Under IRDA (Investment) (Fourth Amendment) Regulations, 2008
i. An Insurer having Assets under Management (AUM) not more than Rs.1000 Crore shall
conduct a Quarterly Internal Audit to cover both Transactions and related Systems.
ii. The Audit Report of the company shall clearly state the observation at transaction level and
its impact, if any at System level. The Audit Report shall be based on Exception Reporting.
Corporate Responsibility for Financial Reports (Under Section 302 of Sarbanes Oxley Act of
2002)
(a) Regulations Required: The Commission shall, by rule, require, for each company filing periodic
reports under section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 [15 U.S.C. 78m, 78o
(d)], that the principal executive officer or officers and the principal financial officer or officers, or
persons performing similar functions, certify in each annual or quarterly report filed or submitted
under either such section of such Act that—
(1) The signing officer has reviewed the report;
(2) based on the officer’s knowledge, the report does not contain any untrue statement of a
material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements made, in
light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading;
(3) based on such officer’s knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information
included in the report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition and results of
operations of the issuer as of, and for, the periods presented in the report;
(4) The signing officers—
(A) Are responsible for establishing and maintaining internal controls;
(B) have designed such internal controls to ensure that material information relating to the
issuer and its consolidated subsidiaries is made known to such officers by others within those
entities, particularly during the period in which the periodic reports are being prepared;
(C) Have evaluated the effectiveness of the issuer’s internal controls as of a date within 90 days
prior to the report; and
(D) Have presented in the report their conclusions about the effectiveness of their internal
controls based on their evaluation as of that date;
(5) The signing officers have disclosed to the issuer’s auditors and the audit committee of the
board of directors (or persons fulfilling the equivalent function)—

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 12


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(A) all significant deficiencies in the design or operation of internal controls which could
adversely affect the issuer’s ability to record, process, summarize, and report financial data
and have identified for the issuer’s auditors any material weaknesses in internal controls; and
(B) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have
a significant role in the issuer’s internal controls; and
(6) The signing officers have indicated in the report whether or not there were significant changes
in internal controls or in other factors that could significantly affect internal controls subsequent
to the date of their evaluation, including any corrective actions with regard to significant
deficiencies and material weaknesses.
(b) Foreign re-incorporations have no effect: Nothing in this section 302 shall be interpreted or
applied in any way to allow any issuer to lessen the legal force of the statement required under
this section 302, by an issuer having reincorporated or having engaged in any other transaction
that resulted in the transfer of the corporate domicile or offices of the issuer from inside the
United States to outside of the United States.
(c) Deadline: The rules required by subsection (a) shall be effective not later than 30 days after
the date of enactment of this Act.
Management Assessment of Internal Controls (Under Section 404 of Sarbanes Oxley Act of
2002)
(a) Rules Required: The Commission shall prescribe rules requiring each annual report required
by section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (15 U.S.C. 78m or 78o(d)) to
contain an internal control report, which shall—
(1) State the responsibility of management for establishing and maintaining an adequate internal
control structure and procedures for financial reporting; and
(2) Contain an assessment, as of the end of the most recent fiscal year of the issuer, of the
effectiveness of the internal control structure and procedures of the issuer for financial reporting.
(b) Internal Control Evaluation and Reporting: With respect to the internal control assessment
required by subsection (a), each registered public accounting firm that prepares or issues the
audit report for the issuer shall attest to, and report on, the assessment made by the
management of the issuer. An attestation made under this subsection shall be made in
accordance with standards for attestation engagements issued or adopted by the Board.
Any such attestation shall not be the subject of a separate engagement.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 13


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 2 Documentation and Working Papers

Documentation refers to an comprehensive record of the internal audit activity and includes the
terms and conditions of the audit engagement, audit plan, audit program, checklists, details of
the nature, extent and timing of the audit procedures carried out, documentary evidences
obtained including abstract or copies of entity’s records, letters of confirmation and
representations, notes on significant matters, analysis of the data collected in the course of the
audit procedures, the outcome of the periodical review of the audit work by the auditor and
actions taken thereon, conclusion drawn from the evidences obtained in the course of the audit,
response of the management on the audit findings, draft and the final audit report and the
corrective actions taken by the management on the suggestions and recommendations contained
in the audit report of the previous period.
The internal audit documentation should cover all the important aspects of an engagement viz.,
engagement acceptance, engagement planning, risk assessment and assessment of internal
controls, evidence obtained and examination/ evaluation carried out, review of the findings,
communication and reporting and follow up. In case the internal audit is outsourced, the
documentation should include a copy of the internal audit engagement letter, containing the
terms and conditions of the appointment.
Internal audit documentation should be designed in accordance with requirement of specific
audit and properly maintained to meet the requirements and circumstances of each audit. All
significant issues which require special attention, together with internal auditor’s observation
thereon should be appropriately included in the internal audit documentation.
The form, contents and the extent of coverage of documentation depends on the judgment of the
internal auditor based on the requirement of a particular audit but the documentation should be
designed and organized properly and contain sufficient information so as to enable an internal
auditor not previously associated with the entity, to obtain a complete understanding of the
audit. The documentation shall be signed by the preparer and reviewer of the documentation.
Documentation helps in the following manner:
1. Planning and performing the internal audit
2. Supervision and review of the internal audit work
3. Establishing that the opinion expressed in the audit report is based on the inference drawn
from the audit evidences obtained in the course of the internal audit procedures performed
4. Makes possible review of the audit activity by third party where necessary
5. Establishing that the internal audit procedures conform to the terms of audit engagement
and the relevant professional pronouncements. The professional pronouncement of a
institute of which the internal auditor is not a practicing member is not binding on the
internal auditor but he can still abide by them whereby he can follow certain standardized
audit practices and which might immune him from legal actions in case the question of the
auditor being biased or ineffective is raised.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 14


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
The ownership of the internal audit documentation lies with the internal auditor and the auditee
can have access to the documentation with prior approval of the internal auditor and the client.
The documentation cannot be accessed by a third party without the approval of the client unless
any legal or regulatory requirement or any professional pronouncement permits such access.
The auditor shall decide on the retention period for the internal audit documentation within the
frame work of the overall policy of the entity in relation to retention.
Use of Working Papers as evidence
Internal audit documentation covers the internal audit charter, the internal audit plan, the type
and extent of audit procedures performed, timings and the conclusions drawn from the evidence
obtained. Proper documents act as basis for the planning and performing the internal audit.
Documents provide the evidence of the work of the internal auditor. Internal audit
documentation should be detailed and comprehensive to obtain an overall understanding of the
audit.
The internal auditor should document the issues that are important in providing evidence and
support his findings or in preparation of the report. In addition, the working papers also help in
planning and carrying out the internal audit, review and control the work and most importantly,
provide evidence of the work performed to support his observations/ findings in the report.
The internal audit Documents provide the evidence of the work of the internal auditor and are
important in providing evidence to his opinion or the findings. Following are the advantages of
having sufficient and properly maintained working papers:
i. Assistance in the performance of the audit.
ii. Forming basis of the auditor’s observations/ findings in his report.
iii. Providing information for the report.
iv. Aiding the review and evaluation of the work done.
v. Aiding cross referencing between audit evidence and decision taken by the internal auditor.
vi. Providing record of work done.
The internal auditor should formulate policies as to the custody and retention of the internal
audit documentation within the framework of the overall policy of the entity in relation to the
retention of documents and in accordance with the practices prevailing in the profession.
Note: For more details, the readers may refer to Cost Audit and Assurance Standard (CAAS 102)
on “Cost Audit Documentation” issued by the Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 15


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 3 Planning an Internal Audit and Audit Programme

Planning
Internal audit is a management function and therefore the audit plan has to be drawn in
consultation with the management i.e. the people in charge of governance which shall include
the audit committee where there is one. The audit plan helps in timely and efficient conduct of
the audit in accordance with the scope of the audit and terms of engagement.
The internal audit plan is a comprehensive document which shall lay down the areas to be
covered by the audit, the manner in which the audit will be conducted, the extent of assessment
or verification to be done, the resources to be employed and the distribution of total available
time among different activities, so that the overall objective of the internal audit is fulfilled and
the audit is conducted in accordance with the terms of the audit engagement.
The internal audit planning shall begin with understanding:
1. The business of the entity, its policy, plans and procedures
2. Its hierarchical structure
3. The statutory and regulatory framework within which it operates
4. The existing accounting and internal control system
5. The prevalent management information system
6. The entity’s risk perception and risk management plan
7. The level of assurance to be obtained for different facets of the entity’s activities which shall
depend on the efficacy of the accounting system, internal control system and risk
management system of the entity
8. The degree of complexity and materiality of the activities covered by the terms of audit
engagement.
For obtaining the above mentioned understanding of the entity the auditor shall:
1. Examine the Policy document and the procedural manual (e.g. the management policy
manual, accounting manual and the internal control manual)
2. Study the organizational chart, job descriptions, authority and responsibilities of various
positions and delegation of the responsibilities
3. Study the significant legislations and regulations that affect the entity
4. Study the minutes of the General meetings, Board meeting and important Committee
meetings
5. Study the previous statutory audit reports, management audit reports and internal audit
reports
6. Refer to external sources of information about the entity like newspaper, trade journal and
third party sources
7. Visit the production units and various departments for hands on experience about their
functioning
8. Engage in discussion with the management and personnel of the entity
9. Study the type of information and reports generated through the accounting system, internal
control system and the management information system

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 16


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
10. Study the security of the information generated and the policy for their safe custody and
destruction, when no longer required.
The findings from the above actions shall be documented which shall help in deciding the nature,
extent and timing of the audit procedures to be conducted.
The internal audit plan inter alia shall include:
1. The detailed program for review of different areas under audit
2. The audit procedures to be employed
3. The frequency and extent of the audit procedure
4. The criticality and complexity of specific areas requiring special attention
5. The significant risk associated with a specific area requiring special attention
6. The engagement of personnel in accordance with the requirement of knowledge and skill for
different audit procedures
7. The allotment of time for different audit procedures
The internal audit plan needs to be changed with the changing audit environment, resulting from
changes within the organization, external changes affecting the organization and new findings
from the audit procedures and the resultant major changes in the internal audit plan shall be
discussed with the management. The changes in the audit plan shall be documented mentioning
the circumstances warranting such change.
Audit Programme
The internal auditor should device a documented internal audit programme describing the
processes essential to meet the objective of internal audit plan. Internal audit programme to be
drawn before the start of the audit in consultation with relevant stake owners.
The internal audit programme identifies, in appropriate details:
 the objectives of the internal audit in respect of each area,
 the staff responsible for carrying out the particular activity,
 the time allocated to each activity as also the sufficiently detailed, and
 Sufficiently detailed instructions to the staff as to how to carry out those procedures.
The internal audit programme may also have provision for information such as:
 The procedures actually performed,
 Reasons for not performing the originally identified procedures,
 Actual time consumed in carrying out the relevant procedure, and
 Reasons for deviations from budgeted time etc.
A well prepared, comprehensive audit programme helps proper execution of the work as well as
of the proper supervision, direction and control of the performance of the engagement team.
Sample- Information requisition
Description of Information/Data
 Copy of existing process flow charts, operating procedures and policies including specifically
the following:
a. Schedule of authority for expense and payments.
b. User manual and process flows used for Oracle.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 17


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
c. Valid circulars/ mails on policies.
 Summary of active projects - Project Description, Nature of Project (commercial/
residential), Location, Project Size (Budget, Duration), Current Completion status, Project
Head etc.
 Details of management review committees (Composition, Role, Responsibilities,
Frequency of meetings, Agenda, Minutes of meeting for last 1 year etc)
 Copies of internal audit reports/ management audit reports for last 2 years.
 Copy of Information presented to the Board as part of the Board Agenda (last two months)
and copy of Minutes of the meetings (Board, Audit Committee and Executive Committee if
any) for last two years.
 Summary of agreements with main service providers and business associates

 Copies of existing statutory and legal compliance checklists and procedures


 Listing of existing MIS Reports by Function/ Company as a whole (Daily/ Weekly/
Monthly/ Quarterly) and copy for last 3 consecutive months
 Details of IT Applications currently in use as follows:
a) Name of the application
b) Purpose of the application
c) Integrated with main financial application - yes / no, (if no is it proposed to be integrated -
yes / no)

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 18


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 4 Audit Sampling

Sampling refers to selection of a portion (sample) of the total (population), on a certain basis so
that the portion is representative of the total. Therefore one has to be careful about deciding on
the size of the sample and the manner of selecting the items from the population to ensure that
the sample actually represents the characteristics of the population.
The selection can be done using both statistical and non-statistical methods. The statistical
methods are those which use the random number table or the theory of probability for selection
of a sample. In case of test of controls where the auditor is trying to ascertain the effectiveness of
the internal control system, the auditor’s analysis of the nature and cause of error is more
important than the statistical analysis of mere presence or absence of error and therefore in such
situation, non-statistical sampling approach is preferred. However, in case of a test of details
where the auditor is trying to ascertain the occurrence of material error or misstatement,
statistical sampling approach is preferred because that eliminates the risk of bias creeping into the
selection of sample.
Now, in audit it is neither possible nor desirable to examine all the transactions or activities of an
entity within the time-frame of an audit. Therefore the auditor has to decide upon samples from
the classes of transactions covered by the audit on which the audit procedures are applied to
obtain sufficient appropriate audit evidence that would enable the auditor to have reasonable
assurance about the characteristics of the class of transactions. However, it is not necessary that
selective verification will be done in respect of all classes of transactions and the auditor might
decide on examination of the total population in respect of a particular type of transaction, where
in his opinion there is a high risk of drawing an incorrect conclusion based on selective verification
and he requires a higher level of confidence about that class of transactions. The size of audit
samples shall largely depend on the level of confidence the auditor has on the efficacy and actual
performance of the internal control system and the auditor’s acceptance of the tolerable error
(maximum possibility of the sample not representing the population) in sampling. In order to
lower the sampling error and thus the risk of drawing an incorrect conclusion, size of the sample
should be bigger.
The internal auditor shall first decide upon what would be the appropriate population for deriving
a particular audit assurance and whether the population is complete. For example to derive a
assurance about the balances of debtors the complete list of sales invoice, debit/credit notes and
complete details of receipts from debtors shall constitute the appropriate population. The internal
auditor may classify an appropriate population meant for a certain audit procedure into various
categories (or strata) based on certain criteria (e.g. monetary value) and then decide on different
sample size for different categories. As for example, for checking of sales invoices, the invoices
may be grouped into three categories (high, medium and low) based on monetary value and the
auditor may decide to go for 100% verification of the high value invoices and no sampling is
involved, for verification of the medium value invoices the auditor may go for a sample size of 60%
of the population of medium value invoices and for verification of the low value invoices the
auditor may go for a sample size of 30% of the population of low value invoices.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 19


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
After selection of samples and conducting audit procedures on them the auditor shall evaluate
the findings to determine whether the assessment of the relevant characteristics of the
population is confirmed or whether it needs to be revised.
The internal auditor shall document the issues related to the sampling process which will help the
auditor to substantiate his decisions.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 20


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 5 Audit Evidence


The primary objective of internal audit is to enable the auditor express his opinion on the efficacy
and performance of the systems, procedures and controls and the financial, cost and other
statements generated by the entity. For this purpose, the auditor carries out audit procedures to
derive sufficient appropriate audit evidence and draws conclusion there from which forms the
basis of his opinion. Now, “sufficiency” refers to the quantum of the audit evidence and
“appropriateness” refers to the relevance and reliability but what constitutes “sufficient
appropriate audit evidence” depend on the professional judgment of the auditor.
The internal auditor’s judgment as to “sufficient appropriate audit evidence” is influenced by the
nature and materiality of the item, nature and size of the business, efficacy and functioning of the
controls and his assessment of the risk of a material misstatement.
The source of the audit evidence which can be internal or external and in whose custody it is
being kept, decides the level of reliability of the evidence, to a great extent. The main types of
audit evidence in order of their reliability are:
(a) Documentary evidence originated from and held by third party
(b) Documentary evidence originated from third party and held by the entity
(c) Documentary evidence originated from the entity and held by third party
(d) Documentary evidence originated from and held by the entity.
The internal auditor obtains the audit evidences through:
(a) Compliance procedures which are tests of control and are intended to obtain reasonable
assurance that the controls on which audit reliance are to be placed are in effect
(b) Substantive procedures which are performed to obtain satisfaction about the
completeness, validity and accuracy of the data on which the audit procedures are carried
out. The substantive procedures are of two types:
(i) Tests of details of transactions and balances and
(ii) Analysis of significant ratios and trends and resultant enquiry into unusual fluctuations
and items.
The majorities of the audit evidences are indicative of the occurrence or non-occurrence of a
certain event or existence or non-existence of a certain state of affairs and are not conclusive in
nature. Therefore, such audit evidence has to be corroborated by evidence of another nature or
from another source and in case of inconsistency between the two evidences; further audit
procedures are to be carried out to obtain reliability.
The internal auditor obtains evidence by performing one or more of the following procedures:
(a) Inspection of records or tangible assets
(b) Observation of a process or activity being performed by others
(c) Inquiry whether formal written inquiry or informal oral inquiry, seeking relevant
information from competent persons whether within or outside the entity and
confirmation received in response to the inquiry
(d) Checking the arithmetical accuracy of the records and doing independent calculations
and
(e) Analysis of significant ratios and trends and resultant enquiry into unusual fluctuations and
items

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 21


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 6 Analytical Procedures

The internal auditor carries out the analytical procedures initially to understand the functioning of
the entity, its environment and the risk of material misstatement in the information on which the
audit procedures will be carried out and based on this understanding he plans the nature and
extent and timing of the audit procedures. The analytical procedures are applied again to
corroborate the conclusions drawn from the evidence arising out of the tests of details, based on
the findings of which the auditor might decide to apply further audit procedures to derive higher
level of assurance about the evidence.
Analytical procedures include but are not limited to probing into the significant deviations and
fluctuations in ratios and trends between that derived from the financial and non-financial
records of the entity and the corresponding results from previous period or industry sources and
expectations of the entity or the auditor, which deviation and fluctuation may result from error,
fraud, unusual and non-recurring transactions and events etc. Analytical procedures also involve
establishing relationships between various elements of the financial data or non-financial data or
both and drawing conclusion from there.
Where the result of the analytical procedures show significant deviations or fluctuations or
establish relationships that are inconsistent with the results of other audit procedures or the
expected results the auditor shall obtain sufficient explanation from the management to remove
the doubt about any irregularity or obtain appropriate corroborative evidence or apply further
audit procedures until the auditor is satisfied with the results. Where the deviation, fluctuation or
relationship is not satisfactorily explained or where the auditor is not satisfied with the results of
further audit procedures it might be indicative of possible irregularity which should be brought to
the notice of the management and suitable course of action may be suggested.
For finding out the similarity or divergence, comparison of the derived ratio and trends is
generally done with:
(a) the documents and reports of the previous periods
(b) projections or budget of the entity
(c) information from the industry like the industrial standard or comparable data from a similar
entity within the same industry
(d) the estimates of the internal auditor based on his study of the ratios and trends of the entity
The methods and extent of application of analytical procedures depends on the judgment of the
internal auditor based on:
(i) Nature of the entity
(ii) Availability, reliability and relevance of the information available
(iii) Source of the information e.g. internal or external
(iv) Comparability of the information
(v) Efficiency and effectiveness of a particular procedure to achieve a particular objective
(vi) Experience from the previous internal audits conducted at the entity
(vii) Effectiveness of the controls over the preparation of the information

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 22


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

However, the extent of reliance the internal auditor shall place on the results of the analytical
procedures will depend on the judgment of the internal auditor based on:
(a) Materiality of the items involved
(b) Outcome of the other audit procedures
(c) The extent to which the outcome of the analytical procedure can be relied for deriving
assurance about a particular item
(d) Whether the systems, procedures and controls as a whole are efficient and functioning
effectively.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 23


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 7 Accounting System and Internal Control

An entity carrying on any commercial activity needs to have certain system of documentation of
its activities and transactions, assets and liabilities accompanied by a system of checks and
controls, depending on the nature of business and size of the entity. Existence of these systems
enables the management and the stake holders to have information about its functioning and the
state of affairs and assurance about the reliability of this information. Thus, an entity maintains
the accounting system, management information system and the internal control system. The
efficacy of the design of these systems has a significant bearing on effective Corporate
Governance and Enterprise Risk Management.
While the cost and financial accounting systems together with the management information
system generate the information the internal control system ensures the orderly and efficient
conduct of the business, including adherence to management policies, the safeguarding of assets,
the prevention and detection of fraud and error, the accuracy and completeness of the
accounting records, and the timely preparation of reliable cost, financial and other quantitative
information, so far as feasible.
Internal control system consists of all the policy and procedure instituted by the management to
obtain reasonable assurance about:
1. Execution of transaction in accordance with management’s general or specific
authorization
2. Prompt and accurate recording of all transactions
3. Safeguarding of assets and records from unauthorized access, use or disposition
4. Physical verification of assets with the records at reasonable intervals and appropriate
action for any difference
5. Efficacy of design of the systems and procedures and their efficient operation
6. Timely identification of risks and their mitigation to a reasonable extent.
Internal control system is implemented by human being and so the existence of control manuals
or forms cannot by itself ensure absolute assurance mainly because of the following inherent
limitation in the internal control system:
1. Reluctant of the management to establish a control if the benefit derived does not exceed
the cost incurred
2. Failure to understand the instructions, wrong judgment and lackadaisical approach towards
the work fail to achieve the desired result
3. Possibility of evasion of a control procedure either in collusion with other employees or
outside parties
4. Management overriding a control procedure to get certain immediate convenience
Internal control activities include prior approval of an activity or transaction, post activity
authorization in agreement of the proper conduct of an activity or transaction, verification to
establish the correctness of a data or information or to ascertain the existence of an asset,
document or record, reconciliation between records to obtain corroborative evidence about their

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 24


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
authenticity, review of a performance, security of assets, separation of duties and controls over
assets and information system.
The Management of an entity is primarily responsible for designing, implementing, maintenance
and documentation of the internal controls.
The Internal auditor’s responsibility lies in examining the continuing effectiveness of the internal
control system through evaluation of the system and intimating the management of its significant
deficiencies and material weaknesses together with making recommendations for improvement
of its effectiveness.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 25


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 8 Control and Risk Assessment

Internal audit exercise to assess the efficacy of the control aspects and to evaluate the enterprise
risk begins with the auditor’s understanding of the internal environment of the entity in which the
control procedure works. In understanding the control environment the auditor shall look into the
following aspects:
1. The entity's organizational structure and methods of assigning authority and responsibility,
including segregation of duties and supervisory functions
2. The function of the board of directors and its committees, in the case of a company or the
corresponding governing body in case of any other entity
3. Management's philosophy and operating style
4. Management's control system including the internal audit function, personnel policies and
procedures
5. Integrity and ethical values
6. Commitment to competence
7. Human resource policies and practices
The next step is to obtain an understanding of the existing business processes, accounting and
internal control system by performing tests like a “walk through” test which is testing a few
transactions through the accounting system. The internal auditor shall document the design and
operations of internal controls through narrative details, drawing flow charts and obtaining
answer to questionnaires developed by the auditor.
The Internal auditor shall then carry out tests of control to make preliminary assessment of the
adequacy of the accounting and internal control systems and decide on the likely nature, timing
and extent of the internal audit procedures. This will also help the auditor to develop the internal
audit plan and chalk out an effective audit approach.
Tests of control may include:
1. Inspection of documents supporting transactions and other events to gain audit evidence
that internal controls have operated properly, e.g., verifying that a transaction has been
authorized
2. Inquiries about and observation of internal controls which leave no audit trail, e.g.,
determining who actually performs each function and not merely who is supposed to
perform it
3. Re-performance of internal controls, e.g., reconciliation of bank accounts, to ensure they
were correctly performed by the entity
4. Testing of internal control operating on specific computerized applications e.g., control on
access, editing or changing the program.
Risk is a threat of the occurrence of an event or action which is likely to adversely affect the
entity’s ability to maximize the value of the stake holders and to achieve the business objectives.
Magnitude of the risk depends on the probability of the occurrence of the event or action and the
adverse financial impact on the entity.
Risks can be internal or external and are broadly categorized into:

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 26


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
1. Strategic Risks – associated with long term objectives and direction of the business.
2. Operational Risks – associated with day to day operations of the entity.
3. Financial Risks – related to the processes, techniques and instruments utilized to manage the
finances of the entity and those processes involved in sustaining effective financial
relationships with customers and third parties.
4. Knowledge Risks – associated with the management and protection of knowledge and
information within the enterprise.
Enterprise Risk Management is a structured, consistent and continuous process of risk
identification, prioritization and reporting, risk mitigation, risk monitoring and assurance.
Management is responsible for establishing and operating the risk management framework.
The internal auditor should review the maturity of an enterprise risk management structure by
considering whether the framework so developed, inter alia:
a) protects the enterprise against surprises;
b) stabilizes overall performance with less volatile earnings;
c) operates within established risk appetite;
d) Protects ability of the enterprise to attend to its core business; and
e) Creates a system to proactively manage risks

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 27


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 9 Internal Audit in ERP Environment and Systems Audit

ERP (Enterprise Resource Planning) environment is signified by extensive use of Information


Technology (IT) to process, retrieve and report data (financial, quantitative, statistical and others)
in an environment where data arising from all the processes and activities are integrated through
a network of nearby or remote computers and server with in-built security system to protect the
data through a hierarchy of the right to enter or alter data and authorization of the entries. Thus
in an ERP environment nothing different are done but are done in different ways.
Therefore, auditing in an ERP environment does not change the scope and the objective of an
internal audit but since the methods of collection, recording, processing, storing, retrieval and
reporting data changes the procedures adopted by the internal auditor in carrying out the internal
audit functions for obtaining sufficient appropriate evidence necessary to assess the efficacy and
appropriateness of the internal control system and the entity’s preparedness to encounter and
mitigate perceived risks. One of the peculiarities of auditing in an ERP environment is that the
audit trail is not comprehensively visible, as is available in a manual system.
Auditing in an ERP environment requires the auditor to familiarize himself with the environment
and for that purpose the auditor primarily need to obtain the following understanding:
1. The reliability of the data flowing into the “Central Processing Centre” or the “ERP System
Server” .
2. The processing and analysis that takes place within the processing centre.
3. The reports that are generated from the system.
4. The structure of authority for entering data, approval and accessing the data.
5. The impact the ERP system has on the audit trail which is otherwise available in a manual
system.
The auditor needs to have specialized skills for auditing in an ERP environment, at least a fair idea
of operating in a specialized ERP system which will enable the auditor to design and perform
appropriate tests of control and substantive procedures and to determine the effect of the ERP
environment on assessment of overall audit risk. However, in this regard the auditor can take the
assistance of experts who may or may not be an employee of the auditor in accordance with the
general sanction for ‘using the work of an expert’.
In planning the internal audit the auditor should consider the following aspects of an ERP
environment:
1. Information Technology infrastructure consisting of a structured and documented IT Policy,
the hardware (Computers, File Servers, Printers, Modems, Switches, Routers, Hubs, etc.) and
software (both system and application software). In case of any change in hardware and/or
software since the last audit, whether the procurement has been done from reliable and
authorized vendors and the software has valid license and serial number.
2. The absence of audit trail or the trail being in a machine readable form makes it difficult to
obtain sufficient assurance about the correctness of processing of data particularly where a
large amount of data are processed through a large number of complex steps. Thus
existence of programming or system related errors resulting in inappropriate processing and

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 28


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
incompatible information might go undetected as it is generally difficult to detect them
manually, on a timely manner.
3. Transactions or entries are automatically generated by the System without specific
authorization for such transactions or entries, individually and which cannot be Validated
independently.
4. Existence of systems like the EDI (Electronic Data Interchange System) whereby transactions
are electronically exchanged with other entities without verification of their correctness and
appropriateness.
5. Although unauthorized access and alteration of data is not normally possible in an ERP
environment due to the existence of elaborate security controls embedded in any ERP, the
distribution of ERP related activities (like programming, processing and data sourcing) within
the entity and coordination among the various functionaries assumes vital significance.
Several functions which may be done by different individuals in a manual control
environment may be carried out by a single individual in an ERP environment thus increasing
the control risks.
6. The lesser possibility of human errors in processing data which is done uniformly by the use
of software takes care of some of the control risks but emphasis needs to be given on the
effectiveness of the general computer information systems control.
7. The risks and controls associated with an ERP environment create a potential impact on the
internal auditor’s assessment of risk and the nature, timing and extent of audit procedures.
The various reports generated by the ERP system may assist the auditor in performing
substantive tests. The use of computer assisted audit techniques provides the auditor with
several analytical tools that increases the efficiency of the performance of the internal audit
procedures.
In evaluating the internal control system in an ERP environment the following aspect should be
looked into:
1. That there is a structured and documented IT Policy and the personnel are well conversant
with the same.
2. That authorized, correct and complete data is made available for processing.
3. That the errors are detected and corrected timely.
4. That in case of interruption in the working of the ERP environment due to power, mechanical
or processing failures, and the system restarts without distorting the completion of the
entries and record.
5. That the output is complete and accurate.
6. That sufficient data security is available against unforeseen calamities, errors and frauds.
7. That there is sufficient protection against unauthorized amendments to the programme and
provision is made for safe custody of source code of application software and data files.
For conducting internal audit in an ERP environment, the auditor has to depend primarily on the
information generated by the IT systems. Accordingly it is necessary for the auditor to obtain
sufficient assurance about the proper safeguarding of the IT assets, maintenance of data integrity
and effective operation of the systems which would ensure valid, reliable, timely and secure
input, processing and output at all levels of a system’s activity.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 29


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
The internal auditor can obtain this assurance from a ‘Systems Audit’ which evaluates the
system’s internal control design and effectiveness and includes efficiency and security protocols,
development processes, and IT governance or oversight.
‘Systems audit’ shall be carried out by independent and qualified persons having special skills and
training (e.g. persons having ‘SISA’ qualification).
Accordingly, the internal auditor should review the strength and effectiveness of the ERP
environment and consider any weakness or deficiency in the design and operation of any control
within the entity, by reviewing:
1. System Audit reports of the entity, conducted by independent Information System auditors;
2. Reports of system breaches, unsuccessful login attempts, passwords compromised and other
exception reports;
3. Reports of network failures, virus attacks and threats to perimeter security, if any;
4. General controls like segregation of duties, physical access records, and logical access
controls;
5. Application controls like input, output, processing and run-to-run controls; and
6. Excerpts from the IT policy of the entity relating to business continuity planning, crisis
management and disaster recovery procedures.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 30


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 10: Relying on External Opinion and Reference of Auditor Expert

Internal audit is a multi-disciplinary audit and it is not likely or expected that the internal auditor
shall possess all the necessary knowledge and skills which the internal auditor might require to
handle all parts of the internal audit engagement. Accordingly, the internal auditor is entitled to
avail the services of experts at his discretion to ensure proper conduct of the audit.
The Internal auditor has to decide on the need to obtain the opinion and advice of an Expert on
the following basis:
1. Whether the matter or issue on which opinion is to be sought is material enough to seek an
opinion or advice of an expert
2. The element of risk involved in forming an erroneous opinion by the internal auditor in the
absence of an opinion or advice of an expert
3. The other evidences available with the internal auditor in respect of the matter or issue,
which could enable the auditor to form an opinion without seeking the opinion or advice of
an expert.
The internal auditor should take into consideration the following factors in deciding on the expert
to be engaged:
1. The competency of the expert as represented by professional qualification or membership of
an appropriate professional body
2. The experience of the expert in the relevant field and reputation to handle similar type of
engagement
The expert should not have any personal, financial or organizational relationship with the entity
which might affect his objectivity. His opinion and advice should be free from any prejudice or
bias. If the internal auditor has any reason to doubt the objectivity of the expert he should
perform more detailed audit procedures to obtain sufficient appropriate evidence or might refer
to another expert.
To ensure that the work of an expert serves the desired objective, the internal auditor should
gain sufficient insight into the terms of engagement of the expert, to establish the objective and
scope of his work and the access the expert can have to the records, personnel and physical
properties of the entity. The auditor shall also seek reasonable assurance that the conclusions
drawn by the expert is backed by appropriate evidence, by referring to the source data used by
the expert and the assumptions made and methods employed by the expert.
In exceptional cases, where the opinion of the expert is inconsistent with the overall findings of
the auditor, the auditor should attempt to resolve the inconsistency through deliberation with
the auditee and the expert. The auditor may also contemplate performing more detailed
procedures or engage another expert.
It is not normal for the internal auditor to draw reference to the opinion or advice of an expert on
which he has relied to express his opinion but if the auditor feels that such reference shall
promote a better understanding of the conclusions drawn by the internal auditor he may state

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 31


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
the conclusions drawn by the expert in his report but in doing so, he should mention the
assumptions made and the broad methodology adopted by the expert.
Where the internal auditor considers it necessary to disclose the identity of the expert he should
obtain a prior, written consent from the expert.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 32


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 11 Audit Conclusion and Corrective Measures

The definition of internal audit refers to internal audit as “consulting activity which involves a
continuous and critical appraisal of the functioning of an entity”. The goal of an audit is to form
and express an opinion on financial statements. The audit is performed to get reasonable
assurance on whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit also
includes assessing the accounting principles used and the significant estimates made by the
management. Audit conclusions and reporting are one of the principles governing an audit.
Steps Involved
Following are the steps involved in audit conclusion:
a. Gathering of audit evidence
An auditor should be thorough in his efforts to gather the audit evidence, and be impartial in its
evaluation. Substantive procedures such as enquiry, information, confirmation, observation,
compilation, verification and valuation, etc. are used to substantiate the transactions. Carrying
out such procedures on a reasonable number of transactions provides a basis for drawing a
conclusion on a particular head of account (line item). Having gathered the audit evidence by
substantive procedures, the auditor should ensure that the entity has complied with the
necessary requirements such as requirements of law, applicable Accounting Standards issued by
the ICAI/ NACAS , accounting policies adapted by the entity from time to time, and internal
control systems.
b. Evaluation of audit evidence
Having gathered the audit evidence, the auditor goes through the evidence with a fine-toothed
comb to properly evaluate it, judge their reliability and draw logical conclusions. He has to
document the reasons for accepting or rejecting certain replies and reports.
c. Analysis of evidence
The auditor uses analytical procedures such as accounting ratios, analyses; intercompany
comparisons, comparing the industry norm with the data of the unit, etc. to analyze the data.
d. Audit conclusion
Such analyses help the auditor to draw conclusions regarding various aspects of the line items of
the financial statements. These conclusions should be independent and factual, and not based on
assumptions. A set of such conclusions leads to forming an opinion.
Reporting is the last procedure of the process of an audit. Therefore, while the internal auditor’s
report lays down the observations and comments of the auditor, the audit findings and put forth
suggestions for improvement, the auditor shall facilitate meaningful communication with the
auditee to ensure that there is an agreement between the auditor and the auditee in respect of
the observations and suggestions and these are capable of being implemented.

Internal auditor should present the draft report before the auditee for review and discuss with the
auditee the audit findings to arrive at a consensus, before the final report is issued. The final

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 33


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
report shall take into consideration the revision or modification done in the draft report in
consequence of the discussions with the auditee.
The auditor should also check the status of the compliance with the points mentioned in the
previous audit report and where corrective action has not been taken by the auditee, the reason
for such non-action should be enquired into and reported suitably along with the revised timeline
and fixation of responsibility on the concerned process owner.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 34


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 12: Report Writing and Audit Report

Internal Audit Report


The final output of the internal audit exercise is a written expression of the opinion of the internal
auditor on the internal control system, risk management system and the overall governance
process of the entity and his suggestions for improvement, based on the inference drawn from
the analysis of the evidences obtained through the internal audit procedures and the
management’s reply to the audit findings.
The report shall have a lucid but brief presentation, free from ambiguity and narrate all material
facts and findings and prepared timely, before the report would lose its utility. Though there is not
any specific format for internal audit report the auditor should standardize the report so far as
possible which will benefit the user of the report to understand and relate similar items within
the same report and between reports of different periods.
The essential items of the internal audit report shall ideally be arranged in the following manner:
1. The report shall begin with a “Title” which can simply be “Internal Audit Report”.
2. The internal audit report should normally be addressed to the appointing authority i.e. the
authority signing the audit engagement letter, unless the terms of engagement require
otherwise.
3. The report shall state the period covered by the report.
4. The report shall contain a list of recipients of the report; that is the persons or designations
to whom the report shall be distributed. It shall also mention that the distribution of the
report shall be limited to the persons mentioned in the list.
5. Thereafter the report shall contain a statement about the responsibility of the management
of the entity which primarily is to ensure proper functioning of the systems and processes
and to safeguard the assets of the entity and the responsibility of the auditor which primarily
is to express an opinion on the efficacy of the internal control system, risk management
system and the over governance procedures, highlighting any failures and recommend
improvements therein.
6. The report shall give an outline of the systems, processes and other management feature
audited, the audit methodologies adopted and procedures performed.
7. The report shall state the scope of the audit and shall mention that:
(a) The audit was conducted in accordance with the generally accepted audit practices
(b) The terms of engagement were followed in letter and spirit
(c) examination of evidence on selective basis were carried out for obtaining reasonable
assurance that the systems, controls and processes operated efficiently and the financial
and cost statements are free from any material misstatement
(d) Ascertainment of the efficacy of the internal control system and the risk management
system was done and weaknesses and risks therein were identified
(e) Any limitation in the scope of the internal audit work caused by situations beyond the
control of the internal auditor shall be stated
8. A paragraph shall be dedicated for a summary of the major audit findings, observations
and recommendations by the internal auditor

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 35


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
9. Management’s response to the observations and recommendations which can be a
clarification or an action plan to rectify the shortcoming or effecting an improvement
suggested by the report. The action plan shall mention the time frame for such action, the
person responsible and the resources required.
10. Corrective action taken by the entity on the observations and recommendations
contained in the previous internal audit report shall also find a place in the audit report.
11. The report shall state that it shall be used only for the purpose agreed upon and narrated
in the audit engagement letter.
12. The report shall conclude with the date and place of signing the report, the auditor’s
signature and his membership number
Before the final internal audit report is issued, the auditor shall discuss the initial draft audit
report with the management and come up with the final draft report, after incorporating the
changes/ modifications necessitated by the response of the management to the initial draft audit
report. Once the management agrees to the final draft report, the final internal audit report shall
be submitted.
However for general guidance the structure of an Internal Audit Report shall cover the following
contents with an Executive summary.
1: Brief Summary of Internal Audit Report
A) Name of the Unit audited :
B) Audit Period Covered as per approved
IA Schedule :
C) Department/Area Covered under IA Scope :
D) Audit Risks Suggested areas
(With quantified, if any)
i) High :
ii) Medium :
iii) Low :
1. Introduction
1.1 Name of the Auditee (unit audited)
1.2 Period covered under current audit
1.3 Brief description of duties/functions of Auditee
2. Objective and Scope
The objectives of this internal audit engagement were
a) (Objective)
b) (Objective)
c) (Objective)
3. Methodology
The methodology adopted by the Internal Auditor needs to get changed from time to time
based on the Scope/subject and type of audit assignment and urgency of the requirement of the
Management. Accordingly the checking tools like observation, obtaining sample evidence, the
principle records to be checked.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 36


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
This section should refer to the methodology adopted for conduct of Internal Audit engagement
viz. interview, Observation, Sampling, Sample size used for checking records, the number of
records checked, and type of records checked. It should also include checklists (if any) used
during the engagement etc.
4. Results and Observations for action:
a) Strengths observed during the audit engagement,
b) Weaknesses observed in the functioning of office, maintenance of records etc. observed
during the audit engagement.
The very objective of Reporting shall be kept in mind while giving the Results and Findings in the
Report. The summary should be as brief as possible and draw on the observations under the Para
on Consequence/Effect /Impact of each Audit observation. It should also include a summation of
outstanding statutory and Internal Audit observations.
5. Opinion
It is equally important that the Opinion of the Internal Auditor shall be communicated to the
auditee in a lucid manner.
6. Audit Recommendations
The recommendations of Audit Team on the observed weaknesses shall be stated here.
This could be presented in a box of highlighted print. (To grab the attraction and immediate
attention)
7. Acknowledgement
It is customary to state that the carrying of the task is possible with the Co-operation extended by
the management and to express the acknowledgement of the help.
An Audit Report shall contain the data of Previous Audit points raised, closed and pending points
that needs attention and rectification, before submission of the Present Report for action.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 37


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 13 Introduction to Plantation Industry

Plantation Industry plays an important role in Indian economy both in terms of addition to
economic value as well employment generation since the Indian economy is still predominantly
an agrarian economy. Plantation Industry is very vast and represented by many crops such as tea,
coffee, rubber, coconut, cardamom, cashew, cinnamon, cloves, cocoa, tobacco, mango, oil palm,
pepper etc. Further, the following three industries constitute a major share of the total plantation
industry:
(i) Tea plantation
(ii) Rubber plantation
(iii) Coffee plantation
In terms of turnover, these three industries contribute maximum to Plantation Industry. Besides
this, plantation industry, particularly, Tea and Coffee are also the two major foreign exchange
earners of the country.
Plantation Industry is the employment provider to a large mass of people, particularly, in the areas
inhabited by backward classes and tribes whose level of skill is much lower in comparison to the
skill of urban industrial labour. In some part of the country, for example, North-Eastern Region,
economy mostly revolves around the plantation industry.
1.1 Unique features of Plantation Industry:
1. Plantation Industry is the only Industry where the total activities, starting from the
agricultural activities involving the production of raw-materials to the manufacturing
activities for finished products are located at the same place under the umbrage of the single
management. In case of most of the organisations engaged in plantation industry, the
organization handles all activities pertaining to production of raw-materials, production of
finished products and marketing of the finished products also.
2. There is considerable time lag (sometimes many years) between the time of planting and
being ready for commercial harvesting, for example:
Tea: 3-5 years
Coffee: 3-4 years
Rubber: 6-7 years
3. The Commercial harvesting may be for many years, for example:
Tea: 30-35 years
Coffee: 20-25 years
Rubber: 25-32 years
4. At the Estate level, the strength of the managerial staff is much less as compared to the total
number of workers engaged. Also the total number of managerial staff as compared to total
number of workers is much lower than the other industries. At the Estate level, most of the
managerial staff has to handle multiple operational functions like overseeing the agricultural
activities, manufacturing, labour management, office administration etc.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 38


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
5. Plantation Industry is highly labour intensive. Majority of the workforce directly attached
with the plantation industry reside in the labour quarters situated within the Estate. As a
result, the Management has to look after the total maintenance of the labour quarters,
maintenance of law and order situation as well as general administration of labour and
smooth provisioning of the entitlements to which workers are entitled to statutorily.
6. The plantation products pass through a single or a few intermediate marketing points for the
purpose of further processing, standardization or bulking/storage before they reach to end
consumer.
7. The plantation industry requires large amounts of fixed capital investment in tree crops,
processing/ packaging, transportation facilities or special port facilities.
8. The output in plantation industry is also highly dependent on the climatic condition.
Commercial Plantation in India
In India, plantation crops occupy merely 2-3 percent of the total area under cultivation in India
but contribute to about 75% of the total export earnings from agriculture based industry. This
highlights the importance of commercial plantation in India.
While several plantations like Jatropha plantation for bio-diesel, plantation of trees for pulp
production in paper industry, teak plantation, beetle nut plantation, macadamia plantation or
spices plantations are gaining importance in India, Tea, Coffee and Rubber continue to be the
major plantations in the organized sector. Plantation industry, particularly, Tea and Coffee, are also
the two major foreign exchange earners of the country.
India occupies a prominent place in the World both in terms of quantity and quality of the tea
produced. India for long held the first position as the largest producer of tea in the World but has
lost his position to China in the last 7-8 years. However, so far as the aroma (or flavor) is
concerned, ‘Darjeeling Tea’ of India continues to be the most sought after tea in the World,
recording the highest market price.
So far as coffee plantation is concerned, India ranks sixth in the World Coffee and has about 90
different spices out of which 5 to 6 are commercially important. Cultivated coffee is mainly
derived from two spices Coffea Arabica (Arabica coffee) and C. canephora (Robusta coffee) and is
grown primarily in the South Indian states of Karnataka, Kerala and Tamil Nadu. In recent years,
new areas have developed in the states of Andhra Pradesh, Orissa and the ‘Seven Sister States’ of
Assam, Manipur, Meghalaya, Mizoram, Tripura, Nagaland and Arunachal Pradesh.
In rubber production India ranks fourth in the World. Rubber cultivation in India has been
traditionally confined to the hinterlands of the southwest coast, mainly in Kanyakumari District of
Tamil Nadu and Kerala. However, over the years several other areas have taken up rubber
cultivation as a commercial proposition. These are hinterlands of coastal Karnataka, Goa, Konkan
Region of Maharashtra, hinterlands of coastal Andhra Pradesh and Orissa, the northeastern states,
Andaman and Nicobar Islands etc, where rubber is now being grown.
Tea Plantation
Tea industry consists of two parts, viz. one part involves agricultural activity and is engaged in the
production of tea leaves in the tea plantations and the other part involves manufacturing activity

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 39


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
where the final products (also known as ‘Made Tea’) like black tea, green tea etc. which are ready
for consumption are produced in the factory. In India, majority of the tea plantations are
managed by large growers but there are small growers and self-help groups and others who sell
their produce to the large growers for processing into ‘Made Tea’. Dooars area in the state of West
Bengal, Assam, Munnar and Nilgiri Belt in the state of Tamil Nadu and certain areas on Kerala and
Karnataka account for maximum production of tea in India.
Tea plants are propagated from seed and cutting. Outside the three botanical varieties of ‘Assam’,
‘China’ and ‘Combod’, there are many strains and modern Indian clonal varieties.
It takes about 4 to 12 years for a tea plant to bear seed, and about three years before a new plant
is ready for harvesting. Tea plants require at least 127 cm (50 inches) of rainfall a year and prefer
acidic soils. Many high-quality tea plants are cultivated at elevations of up to 1,500 m (4,900 ft)
above sea level; at these heights, the plants grow more slowly and acquire a better flavour.
Only the top 1-2 inches of the mature plant are picked. These buds and leaves are called flushes. A
plant will grow a new flush every seven to 15 days during the growing season, and leaves that are
slow in development tend to produce better-flavoured teas.
A tea plant will grow into a tree of up to 16 m (52 ft) if left undisturbed, but cultivated plants are
pruned to waist height for ease of plucking.
The factors affecting tea quality apart from those involved in processing can be distinguished in 3
groups viz. genetic, environmental and cultural as detailed below:

(a) Tea quality is primarily determined by the genetic properties of the tea planting and those of
the tea bush in particular.

(b) Both soil and climate are influencing the quality of tea. Climatic conditions including
temperature, humidity, sunshine duration, rainfall are important in determining quality.

(c) Field operation like pruning, fertilizing, shading, plucking round and plucking standard are
also playing the important role in determining the quality of tea.

The major activities of the tea plantations can be classified into the following:
1. Maintenance of Nursery: Tea plantations maintain nursery for tea saplings and shade tree
saplings for being planted in the fields. Separate nurseries are maintained for tea saplings and
shade tree saplings. At the tea sapling nursery the saplings are grown either from the seeds
sown on the nursery bed (seed nursery) or from the cuttings taken from a tea bush known as
the ‘mother bush’ (propagation nursery). The seeds used in the nursery may be taken from
the tea bushes or purchased from the market. The seeds are sown in different sections in the
‘seed nursery’ according to the grades. Growing tea saplings from cuttings, also known as
vegetative propagation or ‘clonal planting’, is preferred to seed plantation because of the
uniform growth of the tea bushes in case of ‘clonal planting’. Tea saplings grown in the nursery
require adequate care until these attain suitable growth when these are planted in the field.
Similarly, in shade tree nursery, shade tree saplings are maintained from where these are
planted in the field as and where necessary.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 40


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
2. Tea planting: Planting is done under following circumstances –

(a) New plantation is done in vacant land (which may be reclaimed) never used earlier for
plantation. In this connection it may be noted that many tea estates in India which came into
existence in the pre-independence period have large areas which have not been brought
under tree plantation for various reasons.

(b) Re-plantation is done by clearing a section, by up-rooting aged trees, which are no longer
suitable for growing satisfactory quantity and quality of tea leaves and thus are not
commercially viable (tea bushes gives the optimum production between 10 and 30 years but
can be plucked upto 80 years or more but the productivity goes down), or

(c) Planting to fill gaps in various sections of the tea estate, resulting from occasional uprooting of
tea bushes, necessitated by death or destruction of individual bushes. The plantation area in
tea estates are divided into various sections and in each section tea of the same grade or
variety (determined by the seed or clone) are planted which enables better maintenance and
administration of the plantation. In each section a specific distance between the tea plants
are maintained referred to as ‘spacing’, during plantation and when some of the tea trees are
uprooted gaps are created which are sometimes filled by plantation of younger trees.
New plantation or total re-plantation in a section starts with ground preparation which involves:

(i) Uprooting of old plants using heavy machinery which is normally hired. The uprooted tea
bushes may be used for ‘mulching’ to reduce the soil erosion, to maintain soil moisture and
check weed growth. These tea bushes over a period of time decompose and serve as
manure.

(ii) Ploughing, harrowing and leveling the ground are done using implements and tractors.

(iii) During this time the PH factor of the soil is tested at the Government approved laboratories
(Tea Research Association Lab or others) and if the PH factor is high (PH factor between 4.5
and 5.5 is ideal for tea cultivation) gypsum or aluminum sulphate is applied to make the soil
less alkaline. When the PH factor is less than the ideal, then dolomite is applied to make the
soil less acidic.

(iv) Subsequently, citreonela grass or Guatemala grass may be planted and kept for 18 to 20
months to improve the soil fertility (to increase the soil nutrients and carbon status and
micro organism and to reduce the oil toxicity caused by years of using inorganic fertilizers.

(v) Thereafter saplings from the nursery are planted. The planting can be done in two ways, one
by shifting the plant along-with the roots and soil, from the bed of the nursery and another
by shifting the sapling without the soil. Moreover, depending on the spacing to be
maintained between the tea plants, plantation is done by either of the two methods of ‘Pit
planting’ or ‘Trench planting’. Spacing between plants depend on the type of plants being
planted (some types grows upwards and are less bushy while some spreads side-wise
requiring more space) but normally, 15000 to 18000 plants are planted per hectare. Saplings
from seed are preferred in geographical areas where there is more gravel in the soil or the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 41


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
ground water level is low because these plants will have stronger roots, where as in most
area of Assam clones are used. Seeds variety gives tea which will be blacker and clones are
fibrous and brownish in color.

(vi) The planting is followed by ‘mulching’ which is an activity of covering the ground with green
vegetative matter, like tea leaves, twigs and bark of tea plants, leaving a gap of 10cm from
the collar of the plant. Mulching helps in maintaining the moisture of the ground improves
soil fertility and prevents growth of weeds.

(vii) These saplings are to be nurtured for at least three years before the tea bushes are matured
for plucking. During this period along with the normal activities of weeding, manuring, pest
and disease control, irrigation and drainage, efforts are to be made to ensure that the tea
plants attain the desirable frame once it is ready for plucking. The proper frame signifies
uniform, radial, all-round growth of the tea plant which is achieved by periodically removing
the main stem beyond 20 cm from the ground and other methods.
3. Shade for tea plants: Another important feature of tea plantation are the ‘shade trees’ which
protect the tea bushes from direct sunlight and ensures that the moisture in the leaves are
not lost easily and provides scores of other benefits for the tea plants. Shade trees once
matured, do not require as much attention as the tea bushes but when new shade trees are to
be planted (with the samplings being nurtured in the shade tree nursery), these are to be
reared till they are full grown.
The shade trees also help in preventing soil erosion and increasing soil fertility while providing
for timber and fire woods, once it’s utility as shade tree is lost.
4. Irrigation and Drainage: Tea plantations require adequate supply of water and during dry
seasons when there is not sufficient spells of rain (ideally between 2000 to 3000 mm per
annum, in Assam) irrigation becomes necessary. Even during winter season when rainfall is
less, irrigation becomes necessary. Irrigation is done by pumping water from nearby water
sources like river or water bodies, rain water storage tanks, boring well (it is expensive to bore
a well which may give water upto 11 years) etc. However, stagnation of water in tea
plantations is harmful for proper growth and therefore proper drainage system should be
maintained to drain out surplus water.
5. Manuring: The depletion of nutrients in the soil occurs with repeated cultivation as the plants
draw nutrition from the soil. In some cases the soil is inherently deficient in nutrients. In
either situation the soil is to be provided with nutrients on regular basis for healthy growth of
the tea plants, which is done through manuring.
6. Pest and Disease control: The tea plants are prone to various types of diseases and attacks by
pests (the most common and dangerous among them being ‘blights’). The plants are kept
under regular watch for any indication of disease or attack by pests and chemicals and
pesticides are sprinkled or sprayed either as a preventive measure or to cure any disease or
ward-off any pest attack.
7. Weeding: Growth of weeds around the tea bushes is a natural phenomenon which needs to
be controlled. This is done either by hand-picking the weeds or by use of

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 42


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
chemicals/herbicide.
8. Plucking: Plucking refers to the harvesting of the tea leaves produced for manufacture of
‘Made Tea’. There are different type of plucking on which depends the quantity and quality of
the green leaves plucked and also the shoots that come out after plucking. The common types
of plucking are ‘Janam’ (scale leaf plucking), standard plucking and Black plucking. Ideally two
leaves and the terminal bud are picked by hand periodically and the frequency of the plucking
rounds depends on the pruning type (discussed below), regeneration of the leaves and bud,
plucking type and the management policy. Plucking is generally done when the plant has buds
and leaves at the terminals which are commonly known as ‘flushes’. Flushes refer to the top
1-2 inches of a mature plant that contains the bud and the leaves. A plant will grow a new
flush every seven to 15 days during the growing season, and leaves that are slow in
development tend to produce better-flavoured teas. In India the flushing period is divided
into the early flush, between ends of March to May, the Main flush, between mid-June to mid
September and the back end flush, between mid-September to the end of the season, beyond
which the tea bushes are pruned and allowed to grow again, till the next flush. Plucking is a
labour intensive activity and due to shortage of labour in several tea estates timely plucking is
affected which results in lesser number of plucking rounds having a bearing on both the
timely availability of green leaves and quality of the leaves. To tackle this situation, plucking by
machines has been carried out on experimental basis by many tea estates but has not turn
out to be successful.
9. Pruning: This is a vital activity in tea plantations which has two main objectives, namely, to
control the vertical growth of the tree within manageable limit and to stimulate vegetative
growth resulting in horizontal expansion with vigorous branching pattern. The quantity and
quality of tea leaves largely depend on the pruning-routine and constitute a major part of
management of tree plantation. Pruning is done with pruning shears and is primarily of the
following types, each type having different objective, bringing in different benefits and
necessitated under different situations:
(a) Collar prune
(b) Heavy prune
(c) Medium prune
(d) Light prune/Top prune/Cut across prune
(e) Skiff prune/Lung prune
Skiff prune is again classified into:
(a) Deep skiff [DSK]
(b) Medium skiff [MSK]
(c) Light skiff [LSK]
(d) Level off skiff [LOSK]
(e) Unpruned [UP]
The pruning cycle (the interval between two prunes) and the type of pruning are decided by
the Management of the tea estate depending on the following and other factors:
(a) Crop & yield required
(b) Growth time required

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 43


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(c) Rest period required
(d) Nutrient status
(e) Damage done by sun scorch, blister, pest etc.
10. Soil rehabilitation:
The yield of the tea bushes which have crossed the prime gradually falls and these old tea bushes
are uprooted for re-plantation. But due to years of growing tea, physio-chemical as well as the
biological properties of the soil deteriorates. To recover from this situation, after uprooting of old
tea bushes, the land is put under rehabilitation crop for a period of 18-24 months. Some of the
most common rehabilitation crops are Guatemala grass and citronella grass. Rehabilitation crops
require manuring with cow dung. Soil rehabilitation program is followed by ground preparation
for re-plantation.

Other prominent activities ancillary to tea production that is witnessed in the Tea Estates in
India involves:
1. The majority of the tea estates have large areas of vacant land which are not used for tea
plantation for various reasons. The Management of several tea estates uses these areas for
different type of cultivation with commercial proposition. Several tea estates have got into
cultivation of spices like black pepper and cardamom. Even rubber and other trees are also
planted. These small scale parallel activities ensure productive use of vacant land with limited
use of other resources.
2. Another trend in tea plantation is ‘Tea Tourism’ which has gained immense popularity,
particularly in the Dooars region. Under this concept, well furnished and beautifully designed
bungalows are built with kitchen garden, overlooking lush green tea gardens, which are
offered to tourists for stay. Superior hospitality and tours of the tea gardens and
manufacturing facilities provide for added attraction in ‘Tea Tourism’. This new concept has
caught up with foreign tourists and helps the tea estates to earn additional revenue while
providing additional opportunity for marketing their brand of tea.
Tea Manufacturing
After picking, the tea leaves soon begin to wilt and oxidize, unless they are immediately dried. The
leaves turn progressively darker as their chlorophyll breaks down and tannins are released. This
enzymatic oxidation process, known as fermentation in the tea industry, is caused by the plant's
intracellular enzymes and causes the tea to darken. In tea processing, the darkening is stopped at
a predetermined stage by heating, which deactivates the enzymes responsible. In the production
of black teas, the halting of oxidization by heating is carried out simultaneously with drying.
Without careful moisture and temperature control during manufacture and packaging, the tea
may become unfit for consumption, due to the growth of undesired moulds and bacteria. At
minimum, it will make the taste unpleasant.
The tea manufacturing process depends on the type of tea to be produced. The different varieties
of tea that are manufactured include:
1. Black Tea
2. White Tea
3. Oolong Tea

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 44


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
4. Green Tea
5. Organic Tea
6. Instant Tea
However, in India, the black tea is produced in maximum quantity, while green tea is also
produced, which may or may not be blended with different grades of tea or differently flavoured
by use of additives (to create scented and flavored variants like Earl Grey, caramel etc.).
Black Tea Manufacturing:
Black tea is either of the orthodox variety or CTC variety which requires slightly different
manufacturing activities. The primary processes for manufacturing either Orthodox tea or CTC tea
are:
1. Withering
2. Sifting and conditioning
3. Rolling
4. Fermentation
5. Drying
6. Sorting & Grading
7. Winnowing
8. Packing
1. Withering:
After the tea leaves are plucked and brought to the factory they are checked and graded for the
quality of leaves and weighed before putting it for withering. The tea leaves, beside the entity’s
own production can be bought from other gardens (bought leaves). Withering is the process
during which the excess water in the leaves are removed and change in chemical composition of
the leaves by breaking down of chlorophyll and release of tannin is allowed to take place. The
leaves are spread in long troughs in a cool breezy atmosphere for the leaves to loose surface
moisture. Large industrial (heavy duty) fans are often used to create the breeze. During rainy
season when the humidity is high, heated air may be circulated to speed up the process of
withering. Induced withering although helps the leaves to loose moisture speedily, reduces the
time for chemical withering and can have a bearing on the quality of the final product. This
process of trough-withering which is the most common takes about 18 hours under normal
atmospheric condition without induction of heat or induced air circulation. Alternatively, the
leaves can be spread on ‘tats’ (on tightly stretched jute fabric or on wire netting) where the rate of
withering is controlled by the thickness of the spread and the length of time allowed for
withering. The leaves sometimes lose more than a quarter of their weight in water during
withering.
2. Sifting and conditioning:
The tea leaves brought from the garden normally contain stones, soil and metal bits which are
cleared at this stage so that these do not get carried into the machines in the subsequent
processes and the leaves are fed uniformly into the machines. The green leaf sifter is a power
driven wire mesh or perforated tray which vibrates continuously and feeds the withered leaves to
the next process. The sifter contains powerful magnet to catch iron pieces remaining in the
withered tea leaves. The process of sifting is accompanied with conditioning which is directed at

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 45


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
giving the right curl to the withered leaves. This is done to ensure that flat leaves are not fed into
the CTC machines which will prevent proper fermentation of the leaves, causing poor liquor
quality of the ‘Made Tea’. The conditioning is done by using a combination of leaf shredder and
rotor vane machines. The chopped and mashed leaves from the shredder are minced and crushed
in the rotor vane machine before it is taken for rolling.
3. Rolling:
This process as is suggested by the name of the process twists and turns the leaves thus breaking
the leaves and consequently releasing the enzymes and substrates, thereby starting fermentation.
While the process of rolling is done by ‘Orthodox-roller’ machines, in case of very high grade tea it
can be rolled by hand as well. The output from the rolling process has an appearance of lumps of
leaf mass which is separated and sorted into uniform size so as to have the same rate of
fermentation.
The above process of rolling used for Orthodox tea is different from the rolling process for CTC
tea. CTC stands for Crush, Tear and Curl and during the rolling process, the leaves are crushed,
torn and curled thereby getting granulated and considerably reduced in size and the cells getting
ruptured facilitating more intensive and speedy fermentation. As a result the CTC tea produces
thicker liquor than Orthodox tea.
4. Fermentation:
This is a process of oxidation triggered by breaking down of the ‘chlorophyll’ and the release of
the enzyme ‘tannin’ thus causing the leaves to turn blackish from green. This process begins
during rolling and the leaves are spread out on flat surfaces (may be perforated trays) in thin
layers to enable the enzymic oxidation to continue. Alternatively, the leaves are put into large
rotating drums through which fresh air is passed. The constant movement of the leaves ensures
that the every bit of the leaves is exposed to fresh air and oxidation is uniform and thorough.
Moreover, the leaves rub with each other whereby the juices present in the micro cells of the
leaves are uniformly coated on the exterior of the leaves. The aroma of the tea is developed
during this process. The period for which the fermentation is done has a major impact on the
colour and aroma of the ‘made tea’.
5. Drying:
The fermentation process is stopped at a predetermined stage by ‘drying’ the leaves. In case of
Green Tea, fermentation is stopped at an early stage as compared to Black Tea.
Drying can be done using the following methods and in either case heat is generated by
combustion of fuel (HSD or coal) which raises the temperature of the ambient air:
(a) The conventional method is to move the leaves repeatedly through a series of moving
perforated trays while subjected to a continuous flow of hot air circulated by using
industrial (heavy duty) fans run by electricity.
(b) Another method is known as ‘fluidized bed drying’ in which the leaves on reaching the
drying chamber initially gets a blast of hot air which evaporates the maximum moisture
contained in the leaves. Thereafter the flow of air gradually reduces as the tea passes
through the chamber and at the end of the chamber the dried tea is shifted into a cooling
chamber where normal air is introduced by a fan.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 46


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
6. Sorting and Grading:
After drying the black tea is ready which are sorted and graded before packing. Sorting is done by
machine where meshes in automated motion act like sieves and separate the tea on the basis of
the size. Bigger sizes fetch better price in the market. The tea-fibers and flakes of coarse leaves
etc. which are separated at this stage, called the ‘tea waste’, are mostly used for either making
‘instant tea’ or as manure in the tea garden.
‘Tea Waste’ as defined by the ‘The Tea Waste (Control) Order, 1959’ means tea sweepings, tea
fluff, tea fiber or tea stalks or any article purporting to be tea which does not conform to the
specification for tea laid down under the Prevention of Food Adulteration Act, 1954 (37 of 1954)
but does not include green tea or green tea stalks.
The removal of tea-fibers and flakes of coarse leaves is done by PVC rollers which are induced with
static electricity by bringing in contact with ‘felt’ and when the dried leaves are passed through
the electrically charged PVC rollers, the fibers and flakes which contain more moisture than
quality tea get removed from the bulk. This process can be effective only if it is done immediately
after the drying process and before the dried tea absorbs moisture by coming in contact with
humid atmosphere thereby reducing the difference of moisture content between the tea and the
fibers and flakes.
Grading is generally done into four main sizes namely, Whole leaf grades, Broken, Fanning and
Dust which are further classified into grades of various qualities. The grading into the four main
sizes is done in case of Black Tea and Green Tea and in case of CTC Tea, the ‘Whole leaf’ is not
available.
7. Winnowing:
This is a further cleaning process before packing which is a routine and during this process stalks,
fibrous residue and other foreign matter are removed.
8. Packing:
Packing is done as per requirement into air tight packets of various sizes and ensuring that the
‘made tea’ does not catch moisture which can result in loss of flavour of the tea. Before packing
several batches manufactured during the day of similar grade are mixed to ensure uniformity in
the quality. Traditionally, tea was packed in plywood chests lined with aluminum foils. While
packing is also done in corrugated cardboard boxes lined with aluminum foils and polylined jute
bags, the present trend is to pack tea in HDPE woven sacks with HMHDPE inner liner. Packing is
done by machines during which magnets fitted in the packing machine take out any iron bits lying
in the tea. Black tea may be further processed with the help of tea bagging machine to
manufacture ‘tea bags’. “Filter papers” is used as packaging material for manufacture of tea bags.
Types of Tea
Tea is known by the terms Green, Oolong and Black. The types are references to processing and
oxidization. The simplest explanation is to think of leaf that is picked or falls from any bush. The
leaf turns stages of colors until it is finally black. In the case of tea, oxidization is stopped at
various stages.
1. Green Tea
Green tea is nothing more than the leaves of the camellia sinensis that have been processed a

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 47


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
certain way. Green tea skips the oxidizing step. It has more delicate taste and is light green or
golden in colour. They are also lower in caffeine and have higher antioxidant properties.
2. Oolong Tea
The best way to describe oolong tea is that they are somewhere in between green and black tea.
This is because they are only partially oxidized during the processing. Oolong tea is popular in
China.
3. Black Tea
Black teas are the most consumed of teas and accounts for 83% of the world tea trade. They are
the highest in caffeine. Black tea is the most popular tea in the world. It is the tea most widely
used in making iced tea and English tea. There are two types of Black Teas:

1. Orthodox Tea - It accounts for 44% of the world market


2. CTC Tea- It accounts for 39% of the world market.
It is tea that has been fully oxidized or fermented and yields a hearty flavored amber brew. Some
of the popular black teas of India origin include Assam, Darjeeling and Nilgiri.

Manufacturing of Tea:
White Tea manufacturing:
White Tea processing is much simple compared to that of black tea. The two leaves and a bud at
the terminal of a shoot, the most prized part of the tea plant are steamed and dried either under
the sun or fried in large steel pans which resemble huge woks. The leaves are rotated by hand to
ensure uniform drying. White tea has high medicinal values but is not commonly consumed.

Oolong Tea manufacturing:


The consumption of this variety of tea is mostly confined to China and involves intricate
processing. Oolong tea is a whole leaf tea which is partially fermented and is highly aromatic.
Green Tea manufacturing:
This manufacturing process is signified by controlled fermentation and arrested enzymatic
oxidation. Heat is not applied for drying and thus the leaves retain the green colour instead of
turning black. Green tea is known for its therapeutic values.
Organic Tea manufacturing:
The primary requirements for being identified as Organic Tea are –
(a) The unit growing the tea should have a self-sustaining system with facilities like cattle
farming and the animal droppings can be used as organic manure and as fuel for generating
gas to be used for heating, thus using environment friendly techniques.
(b) The farm/product should be certified as ‘Organic’ in accordance with the ‘National
Standards of Organic Products’.
Over the years the demand for organic tea has risen globally, which has encouraged the Indian tea
manufacturers to go for the manufacture of organic tea which though is a more expensive
proposition can command a premium of about 35%, thereby making it more remunerative.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 48


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Instant Tea:
Instant tea refers to a variety of tea which is instantly soluble in water and does not leave behind
residual tea leaves after these are soaked in water to prepare the beverage. The manufacturing
process is capital intensive and uses a different technology.
The process begins with selection of tea leaves as per the requirement of the specific market and
the restrictions attached to its manufacture. Tea leaves taken for instant tea manufacturing are
partially fermented and not dried thus black tea from an intermediate stage of manufacturing
when the tea leaves have been partially fermented and not put to drying can form the raw
material for instant tea manufacturing. Similarly, oolong tea and green tea can also be used.
An important process in manufacturing of instant tea is extraction of the solids and concentrated
solution from the leaf which is done by a technique called the ‘Counter current extraction’
technique. At this stage chemicals and enzymes are applied to enhance the percentage of solids in
the extracts. However, during concentration of the tea extract, the aroma of the tea is lost to a
great extent and so before concentration, the extract is stripped off the aroma by exposing the
extract to the stripping gas, which is subsequently added back to the concentrated solution.
On cooling down of the concentrated solution, a material is obtained which mainly consist of
caffeine, theaflavins and thearubigins and is termed as the ‘cream’. The quality of the tea is
characterized by the amount of the cream. Solubilisation of the cream is the next step in the
process. Cold soluble tea is produced by separating the cream from the tea extract and oxidizing
under specific temperature, maintaining specific PH and by addition of enzyme. The cold soluble
tea is concentrated before passing to the drier. However, exposure to high temperature damages
the product and so concentration is often done by evaporation under low pressure without
exposing to high temperature. The tea extract is now spray dried while ensuring that the flavor is
not lost under high temperature and the concentrated dried powder is packed as per
requirement.
Flavoured Tea:
Beside the pure variety of tea, the flavor in some teas is enhanced through additives or special
processing. Tea is highly receptive to inclusion of various aromas; this may cause problems in
processing, transportation, and storage, but also allows for the design of an almost endless range
of scented and flavoured variants, such as Earl Grey, vanilla, and caramel.
In order to prevent tea from any possible adulteration, the Prevention of Food Adulteration (PFA)
Act, 1954 is in existence. Tea therefore shall conform to the following specifications as indicated
in the PFA Act, 1954.
a) Total ash determined on tea dried to a 4.0 to 8.0 percent by weight
constant weight at 100° C
b) Total ash soluble in boiling distilled water Not less than 40.0 percent of total ash
c) Ash insoluble in HCL Not more than 1.0 percent by weight on dry
basis
d) Extract obtained by boiling dry tea (dried Not less than 32.0 percent
to constant weight at 100° C) with 100

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 49


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
parts of distilled water for one hour under
reflux
e) Alkalinity of soluble ash Not less than 1.0 percent and not more than
2.2 percent expressed as K2O on dry basis
f) Crude fiber determined on tea dried to Not more than 17.0 percent
constant weight at 100° C

Note:-
1. It shall not contain any added colouring matter or added flavouring matter.
2. Provided that tea for export may contain added flavour under proper label declaration.
3. Provided further that the tea used in the manufacture of flavoured tea shall conform to
the standards of tea.
Coffee Plantation
The coffee industry of India is the sixth largest producer of coffee in the world, accounting for
over four percent of world coffee production, with the bulk of all production taking place in its
Southern states.
Coffee Plantation in India began with planting of ‘Seven seeds’ of ‘Mocha’ during 1600 AD by the
legendary holy saint Baba Budan, in the courtyard of his hermitage on ‘Baba Budan Giris’ in
Karnataka. The plants remained as a garden curiosity for long and spread slowly as back yard
plantings. The commercial plantations of coffee were started during British India in 18th century
in the hostile forest terrain in south India.
Since then, Indian coffee industry has made rapid strides and earned a distinct identity in the
world. Coffee in India is grown under a canopy of thick natural shade in ecologically sensitive
regions of the Western and Eastern Ghats. This is one of the 25 biodiversity hotspots of the
world. Coffee contributes significantly to sustain the unique bio- diversity of the region and is also
responsible for the socio-economic development in the remote, hilly areas.
In India, coffee is traditionally grown in the Western Ghats spread over Karnataka, Kerala and
Tamil Nadu. Coffee cultivation is also being expanding rapidly in the non-traditional areas of
Andhra Pradesh and Odisha as well as in the North East states comprising the states of Assam,
Manipur, Meghalaya, Mizoram, Tripura, Nagaland and Arunachal Pradesh.
Coffee is predominantly an export oriented commodity and 65% to 70% of coffee produced in the
country is exported while the rest is consumed within the country. Indian coffee has created a
niche for itself in the international market and the Indian Coffees are earning high premium,
particularly Indian Robusta which is highly preferred for its good blending quality. Arabica Coffee
from India is also well received in the international market.
Not only Coffee is an export product with low import intensity but also provide high employment
content. More than six lakh persons are directly employed and an equal numbers of individuals
get indirect employment from this sector.
Varieties of coffee
The two main varieties of coffee viz., Arabica and Robusta are grown in India. Arabica is mild

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 50


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
coffee, but the beans being more aromatic, it has higher market value compared to Robusta
beans. On the other hand Robusta has more strength and is, therefore, used in making various
blends. Arabica is grown in higher altitudes than Robusta. The cool and equable temperature,
ranging between 150c to 250c, is suitable for Arabica while for Robusta, hot and humid climate
with temperature ranging from 200c to 300c is suitable. Arabica requires more care & nurture
and is more suitable for large holdings whereas Robusta is suitable irrespective of size of the
farm. Arabica is susceptible to pests & diseases such as White Stem Borer, leaf rust etc., and
requires more shade than Robusta. The harvest of Arabica takes place between November to
January, while for Robusta it is December to February.
Growing Conditions
India cultivates all of its coffee under a well-defined two-tier mixed shade canopy, comprising
evergreen leguminous trees. Nearly 50 different types of shade trees are found in coffee
plantations. Shade trees prevent soil erosion on a sloping terrain, they enrich the soil by recycling
nutrients from deeper layers, protect the coffee plant from seasonal fluctuations in temperature,
and play host to diverse flora and fauna.
India’s coffee growing regions have diverse climatic conditions, which are well suited for
cultivation of different varieties of coffee. Some regions with high elevations are ideally suited for
growing Arabica of mild quality while those with warm humid conditions are best suited for
Robusta.
Factors Arabica Robusta
Soils Deep, fertile, rich in organic matter, well drained Same as Arabica
and slightly acidic (Ph6.0-6.5)
Slopes Gentle to moderate slopes Gentle slopes to fairly level
fields
Elevation 1000-1500m 500-1000m
Aspect North, East and North- East aspects Same as Arabica
Temperature 150 C – 25 0 C; cool, equable 200 C – 300 C; hot, humid
Relative 70-80% 80-90%
humidity
Annual rainfall 1600-2500 mm 1000-2000 mm
Blossom March- April (25-40mm) February – March (25-40
showers mm)
Backing April-May (50-75 mm) well distributed March-April (50-75 mm)
showers well distributed
The major activities of the Coffee plantations can be classified into the following:

1. Planting
A coffee bean is actually a seed. When dried, roasted and ground, it is used to brew coffee. But if
the seed is not processed, it can be planted and will grow into a coffee tree.
Coffee seeds are generally planted in large beds in shaded nurseries. After sprouting, the
seedlings are removed from the seed bed to be planted in individual pots in carefully formulated

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 51


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
soils. They are watered frequently and shaded from bright sunlight until they are hearty enough
to be permanently planted. Planting generally takes place during the wet season, so that the soil
around the young trees remains moist while the roots become firmly established.
2. Harvesting the Cherries
Depending on the variety, it takes approximately 3 to 4 years for the newly planted coffee trees
to bear fruit. The fruit is called the coffee cherry and when it turns bright, deep red after ripe, it is
ready to be harvested. In most countries, the coffee crop is picked by hand but where the
landscape is relatively flat and the coffee fields immense, the process is mechanized. Whether the
coffee crop is picked by hand or by machine, all coffee is harvested in one of two ways:
Strip Picked - all of the cherries are stripped off of the branch at one time either by machine or by
hand.
Selectively picked – In this case, only ripe cherries are harvested and individually picked by hand.
This process of harvest is labor intensive and costly. It is used primarily to harvest the finer
Arabica beans.
3. Processing the Cherries
Once the coffee has been picked, processing should begin as quickly as possible to prevent
spoilage. Depending on location and local resources, coffee is processed in one of two ways as
follows:
The Dry Method
Under this method, the freshly picked cherries are spread out on either on large concrete or huge
surface or brick patios to dry in the sun. To prevent the cherries from spoiling, they are raked and
turned throughout the day and covered at night and to prevent them from getting wet. It may
take up to 4 weeks before the cherries are dried to the optimum moisture content, depending on
the weather conditions. On larger plantations, machine-drying is sometimes used to speed up the
process after the coffee has been pre-dried in the sun for a few days. When the moisture content
of the cherries drops, the dried cherries are moved to warehouses for storage.
The Wet Method
In the wet processing method, the fruit covering the seeds/beans is removed before they are
dried and washed. Coffee processed by the wet method is called wet processed or washed coffee.
As to the wet processing, the beans are subject to cleaning to segregate defective seeds. The wet
method requires the use of specific equipment and substantial quantities of water. The beans of
different varieties and sizes are then blended to derive the best flavour.
Next they are passed through a series of rotating drums which separate them by size. After
separation, the beans are transported to large, water-filled fermentation tanks. The fermentation
process has to be carefully monitored to ensure that the coffee doesn't acquire undesirable, sour
flavors. Depending on a combination of factors -- such as the condition of the beans, the climate,
thickness of the mucilage layer and concentration of the enzymes and the altitude -- they will
remain in these tanks for about 12 to 48 hours. When fermentation is complete the beans will feel
rough, rather than slick, to the touch. At that precise moment, the beans are rinsed by being sent
through additional water channels. They are then ready for drying.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 52


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
4. Drying the Beans
If the beans have been processed by the wet method, the pulped and fermented beans are to be
dried to soak moisture and properly prepare them for storage. These beans, still encased inside
the parchment envelope (the endocarp), can be sun dried by spreading them on drying tables or
floors, where they are turned regularly, or they can be machine dried in large tumblers. After
drying, these beans are referred to as 'parchment coffee'.
5. Milling the Beans
Milling the beans process involves removing the last layers of dry skin and remaining fruit residue
from the dry coffee or parchment coffee, and cleaning and sorting it. The parchment coffee is
processed in the following manner:
Hulling
The first step in dry milling is the removal of entire dried husk from the bean. Hulling is done with
the help of machines, which can range from simple millstones to sophisticated machines that
gently whack at the coffee.
Polishing
This is an optional process in which any silver skin that remains on the beans after hulling is
removed in a polishing machine. Polished beans are considered superior to unpolished however,
in reality there is a little difference between the two.
Grading & Sorting
Coffee beans are sorted out based on size, weight, altitude, tastes etc. They will also be closely
evaluated for color flaws or other imperfections.
Next defective beans are removed. This process can be accomplished with the help of
sophisticated machines and also can be done by hand. Beans of unsatisfactory size, color, or that
are otherwise unacceptable, are removed. This might include over-fermented beans, those with
insect damage or that are un-hulled.
6. Tasting the Coffee or Coffee cupping
This is a practice of observing the tastes and aromas of brewed coffee. At every stage of
production, coffee is repeatedly tested for its quality and taste. This process is also referred to as
'cupping' and usually takes place in a room specifically designed to facilitate the process. Samples
from a variety of batches and different beans are tasted daily. Coffees are not only analyzed this
way for their inherent characteristics and flaws, but also for the purpose of blending different
beans or determining the proper roast.
7. Roasting the Coffee
Roasting coffee transforms the chemical and physical properties of green coffee beans into
roasted coffee products. The beans are kept moving throughout the entire process to keep them
from burning and when they reach a particular degree of temperature, they begin to turn brown
and the caffeol, or oil, locked inside the beans begins to emerge and expand to change in colour,
taste, smell, and density.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 53


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
8. Grinding Coffee
The flavor of coffee depends on how the coffee is coarse or ground and on the method by which
the coffee is to be brewed. Generally, the finer the grind the more quickly the coffee would be
prepared.
Rubber:
Rubber is a prominent plantation crop of considerable significance to the Indian economy. A
native to Brazil, rubber was introduced to India in 1873 and its commercial cultivation started in
1902. Natural Rubber tapped from the bark of the tree Hevea brasiliensis is the raw material for
an industry manufacturing the products with rubber. India is one amongst the top ten rubber
producing countries. Kerala is leading rubber plantation state in India. The first commercial rubber
plantations in India were established at Thattekadu in Kerala in 1902. But wide cultivation of
rubber started after 1940 in Kerala. The places in Kerala where rubber is grown are Malanaadu,
Idanaadu, Kottayam, Palakkad.
India's northeast has the potential to transform itself into the world's largest natural rubber
producing region, and the country's second rubber-based industrial park has been set up in
Tripura to boost the industry.
The rubber industry had passed through a great depression during the World War and had
become dearer. This had led to intensive research on synthetic alternatives world over. During
post-war period, the rubber industry in India gained the patronage of the Government, and both
plantation and manufacturing industry achieved spectacular development. Reclamation of rubber
which was initiated during the World War also developed into a robust industry in India.
With the invention of the automobile in the late 19th century, the rubber boom began. The
demand for rubber is soaring due to huge production of passenger and commercial vehicles in
India. A huge quantity of rubber goes into automobiles for various usages. Further, globalization
has evolved the world markets into a single market. Only those players could survive in the
market whose products are ccompetitive both in terms of cost and quality.
1. The Rubber Tree
Many plant species produce natural rubber. However, in view quality and economics, it is limited
to natural rubber, one of species, namely Hevea brasiliensis. The young plant shows characteristic
growth pattern of alternating period of rapid elongation and consolidated development.
The leaves are trifoliate with long stalks. The tree is deciduous in habit and winters from
December to February in India. The rubber tree may live for a hundred years or even more. But its
economic life period in plantations is only around 32 years – 7 years of immature phase and 25
years of productive phase.

2. Plant Development
Rubber tree seeds complete germination 10-15 days after sowing and produce hypogeal
seedlings.
3. Natural Rubber
Natural rubber is a solid product obtained through coagulating the latex (milky secretion)
produced by Hevea brasiliensis. This is also known Pará rubber and is a quick growing, fairly

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 54


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
sturdy, perennial tree of a height of 25 to 30 metres.
4. Propagation of Rubber
In India, Hevea seeds normally ripen during July-September when the seeds are collected and
seedlings raised. All earlier plantations were raised from unselected seeds. Selection work
on Hevea with a view to improving the planting materials and the introduction of vegetative
propagation by budding led, in course of time, to the establishment of numerous valuable clones.
5. Seedling Production
Different approaches are available for producing rubber tree seedlings. It is common to use seeds
produced in native areas but the quality of material is lower, so crop growth and yield are
affected. In order to produce vigorous rubber tree, it is essential to use high quality seeds. Further,
the selection and production of high quality clones contributes to high crop yields. Rootstocks
from seeds of hybrid cultivars are generally more vigorous in comparison to seeds from the native
areas. Rubber tree seedling production often involves rootstock growth in nurseries, stalk
formation and grafting operations.
6. Nursery Establishment
Nurseries are established and maintained for raising various propagation materials for planting.
These include seedling stumps, budded stumps and advanced planting materials like polybag
plants, stumped budding and soil core plants. Mother plants or source bushes for the
multiplication of bud wood are also grown in nurseries. Raising of plants is easier and cheaper in
nurseries than in the main field. Moreover, nurseries offer an opportunity for selection of vigorous
and uniform plants.
Types of Nursery
Planting materials for establishing rubber plantations are generated in seedling, bud wood and
polybag nurseries:
 Seedling Nursery: Seedling nurseries are established for the production of budded stumps,
stumped budding and bud wood.
 Bud wood Nursery: Buds required for bud grafting are collected from bud wood obtained
from plants raised specifically for this purpose. Bud wood nurseries are of two types, namely
brown bud wood nursery and green bud wood nursery. The former produces brown buds
while the latter, green buds.
 Polybag Nursery: Planting materials in polybags can be prepared by two different methods.
Budded stumps can be planted in polybag and the scion allowed to develop till they are ready
for planting in the field. In the other method, germinated seeds are planted in polybags and
bud-grafted when five to six months old. The former gives greater opportunity for selection
of the most vigorous plants and avoids wastage of bags containing poor seedlings and
budding failures. The roots of budded stumps can be treated with indolebutyric acid (IBA), a
hormone which enhances root growth. Dipping root in cow dung slurry before planting
enhances root development.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 55


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
7. Nursery Management
Nursery Management is required for the purpose of rapid and economic production of good
quality of rubber plants. In India, seed fall occurs generally from July to September and hence the
period available for nursery growth is about 10 months. Therefore, efficient nursery management
should aim at production of the maximum number of buddable or transplantable seedlings at the
end of the 10 month period. Unhealthy and weak seedlings are removed. The ideal time for this
culling is three to four weeks after the first fertilizer application, by which time the vigorously
growing and stunted plants can easily be distinguished.
8. Field Planting
The success of rubber planting depends on the prevailing weather conditions, quality of the
planting materials used and the care with which the planting operation is done. Continuous wet
weather can be expected during June-July in the major rubber growing areas in India and hence
this period is considered to be ideal for planting rubber. Different types of planting materials used
are seeds, seedling stumps, budded stumps and polybag plants.
9. Planting of Rubber Trees
For planting the Rubber Trees, some special type of labourers is employed. Rubber is planted from
the seedlings, and becomes ready for tapping in 6 or 7 years. For making the rubber plants high-
yielding, its seedlings are grafted. The graft is, then, kept bound and left for a few weeks. After a
few weeks the grafted buds sprout. Then, the old tree is cut off just above the point of union. The
grafted seedlings are, then, planted in row 5 or 6 metres apart from each other. In order to
conserve the soil and its fertility, some crop covers (leguminous creepers etc.) are planted in
between the seedling trees. During the period of its growth, planters take all the measures against
pest and diseases. Manure and fertilizer are regularly added.
10. Rubber Tapping
This is the process by which latex is collected from a rubber tree. Rubber tapping is done by
wounding the bark of the rubber trees by cutting through the latex vessels to collect the flows of
liquid in vessels. Tapping of the trees is usually done on alternate days. Timing for this process is
to be planned within the planting cycle to optimize the latex yield.
11. Crop Collection
The main crop from rubber plantation is latex, a milky white dispersion of rubber in water, which
is harvested by the tapping process. Two to three hours after tapping, the latex collected in the
vessel/cup is transferred to a clean bucket. About 70-80 per cent of the crop from a rubber
plantation is in the form of latex. The latex which gets solidified in the tapping panel (tree lace)
and the collection cups also form the part of the crop. The latex split and overflowed to the
ground (earth scrap) when gets dried is also collected as scrap once in a month. These are
collectively called coagulum.
Latex and field coagulum is highly susceptible to bacterial action and therefore it is essential to
process them into forms in order to storage safely and for marketing.
Latex can be processed into any of the following forms:
1. Preserved field latex and latex concentrate.
2. Sheet Rubber.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 56


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
3. Block rubber.
4. Crepe rubber.
Field coagulum can be processed only into crepe or block rubber. Presently, a major quantity of
natural rubber produced in India is marketed in sheet form, which is the oldest and the simplest
method of processing latex into a marketable form.
Climatic Conditions for Optimum Growth of Rubber Tree
The climatic conditions for optimum growth of rubber trees are:
1. Rainfall of 2000 to 3000 mm evenly distributed without any marked dry season and with 125
to 150 rainy days per annum
2. Maximum temperature of about 29oC to 34oC and minimum of about 20oC or more with a
monthly mean of 25 to 28oC
3. High atmospheric humidity of the order of 80%
4. Bright sunshine amounting to about 2000 h per annum at the rate of 6 h per day through all
the months
5. Absence of strong winds
Only a few regions in India meet all these requirements. Rubber can also be grown successfully
under moderately deviating conditions. The rubber tree may live for a hundred years or even
more. But its economic life period in plantations, on general considerations is, only around 32
years – 7 years of immature phase and 25 years of productive phase.
Legal and Regulatory Framework
There are many Acts and Rules which regulate Planation Industry. These Acts/ Rules are given
below in two parts one relating to specific Plantation Industry and general laws as applicable to
Plantation Industry under “General Laws and Regulatory framework for Plantation Industry”.
Legislative Enactments on Tea
An entity engaged in production of tea leaves and manufacture of ‘made tea’ have to abide by the
following:

1. Tea Act, 1953, Tea Rules, 1954 and Investigation of Tea Undertaking/ Tea Units (Procedure)
Rules, 1981
The preamble to the Act refers to this as an Act to provide for the control by the Union of India, on
the tea industry, including the control, in pursuance of the International Agreement now in force,
of the cultivation of tea in, and of the export of tea from, India and for, that purpose to establish a
Tea Board and levy a duty of excise on tea produced in India. This Act deals with:
(i) the constitution, functioning, dissolution and other issues related to the Tea Board of
India;
(ii) permission to be taken by a tea unit for bringing new land under cultivation of tea;
(iii) the authority of the Government to make investigation into the functioning of a tea unit
under certain circumstances;
(iv) winding up of a tea unit;
(v) control over the export of tea and tea seeds;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 57


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(vi) levy of cess on tea;
(vii) control of the Central Government over the price and distribution of tea and tea waste;
(viii) licensing of the tea estate and the tea brokers; and
(ix) other matters.
2. Tea Waste (Control) Order, 1959
This is an order issued in exercise of the powers conferred by subsections (3) and (5) of section 30
of the Tea Act, 1953 and provides for:
(a) Definition and treatment of tea waste before sale or export except when to be used as raw
material for manufacturing instant tea, bio-nutrient and bio-fertilizer;
(b) Minimum quantity of tea waste that shall be generated during manufacture;
(c) Restriction on possession of stock of Tea waste and manner of disposal of tea waste;
(d) Mandatory license for purchase, sale, import, export and storage of tea waste, rules for
application, grant, renewal, amendment, suspension and cancellation of such license,
period of validity, conditions associated with it, requirements attached with it and
mandatory maintenance of records and submission of returns;
(e) search and seizure; and
(f) other matters.
3. Tea Warehouses Licensing Order, 1989
This is an order issued in exercise of the powers conferred by subsections (3) and (5) of section 30
of the Tea Act, 1953 and provides for:
(a) Mandatory license for the Warehouse owners, its applicability, rules for application, grant,
renewal, amendment, suspension and cancellation of such license, period of validity,
conditions associated with it, requirements attached with it and mandatory maintenance
of records and submission of returns;
(b) search and seizure; and
(c) other matters.
4. Tea (Marketing) Control Order, 2003
This is an order issued in exercise of the powers conferred by subsections (3) and (5) of section 30
of the Tea Act, 1953 in suppression of the previous Tea (Marketing) Control Order, 1984. This
order provides for:
(i) mandatory registration of manufacturer and producer of tea and tea buyers with the right
of Central Government to suspend or cancel the registration under certain grounds;
(ii) maintenance of records and filing of returns by the manufacturer, producer and buyers;
(iii) mandatory licenses for organizers of tea auctions and brokers participating in tea auctions
together with rules for renewal, suspension and cancellation of license;
(iv) issuance of directions for the license holders, maintenance and submission of accounts
etc. by the licensee;
(v) regulate price and purchase and sale of tea through public auction or otherwise;
(vi) provides for search and seizure at the premises of the registered authority and licensed
authority;
(vii) direct adherence to the standard of tea manufactured and sold; and
(viii) other matters.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 58


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

5. Tea (Distribution and Export) Control Order, 2005


This is an order issued in exercise of the powers conferred by subsections (3) and (5) of section 30
of the Tea Act, 1953 in suppression of the previous Tea (Distribution and Export) Control Order,
1957. The order provides for:
(i) Mandatory business license for the tea Distributors and Exporters, its applicability, rules
for application, grant, renewal, suspension and cancellation of such license, period of
validity, conditions associated with it, requirements attached with it and mandatory
maintenance of records and submission of returns;
(ii) Rules regarding application, issuance of certificate of origin for tea designated as
geographical identification and refusal thereof, period of validity and suspension or
cancellation of the certificate;
(iii) Rules regarding issuance of non-preferential certificate of origin, refusal thereof, period of
validity and suspension or cancellation of the certificate;
(iv) Regulation and restriction of distribution and export of tea;
(v) restriction on distribution on imported tea;
(vi) empowering the licensing authority or the Board to issue directives and carry out search
and seizure;
(vii) empowering license authorities to approve independent inspection agencies and to
suspend and cancel the approval; and
(viii) other matters.
Legislative Enactments on Coffee
Coffee Act 1942
The preamble to the Act states that it is expedient in the public interest that the Union should take
under its control the coffee industry.
Act provides for constitution of a Board by the name of the Indian Coffee Market Expansion Board
under section 4 of the Indian Coffee Market Expansion Ordinance, 1940.
Every owner of land planted with coffee plants, whether such land is comprised in one estate or in
more than one estate and whether it is situated wholly or only partly in India, is required to
register under the Act.
The State Government may, by notification in the Official Gazette, make rules to carry into effect
the provisions of section 14.
The Central Government may, by notification in the Official Gazette fix the price or prices at which
coffee may be sold wholesale or retail in the Indian market.
Legislative Enactments on Rubber
Rubber Act 1947
The preamble to the Act states that it is hereby declared that it is expedient in the public interest
that the Union should take, under its control, the rubber industry.
Provides for constitution of Rubber Board to promote by such measures, as it thinks fit, the
development of the rubber industry.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 59


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
The Central Government may fix the maximum price or the minimum price or the maximum and
minimum prices to be charged, in the course of a business of rubber.
The selling and buying by any person shall be in accordance with the terms of a general or special
licence issued by the Board.
The Board is authorized to levy such fees as may be prescribed for the issue and renewal of special
licences under Section 14 or Section 15.
Rubber (Production and Marketing) Act, 1947
The Rubber (Production and Marketing) Act, 1947 provided for the overall promotion and
development of the sector. The Rubber (Production and Marketing) Act, 1947 has been
superseded by the Rubber Rules, 1955.
Rubber Rules, 1955
The Government of India notified Rules vide S.R.O 1662 in supersession of the Rubber (Production
and Marketing) Rules, 1947. The Rubber Rules, 1955 lay down the guidelines for the Board to
follow in carrying out the purposes of the Act. The Rules have been amended by the Rubber
(Amendment) Rules 2010.

General Laws and Regulatory framework for Plantation Industry


1. Plantations Labour Act, 1951
The Plantation Labour Act, 1951 provides for the welfare of plantation labour and regulates the
conditions of work in plantations. As per Act, 'Plantation' means "any plantation to which this Act,
whether wholly or in part, applies and includes offices, hospitals, dispensaries, schools, and any
other premises used for any purpose connected with such plantation, but does not include any
factory on the premises to which the provisions of the Factories Act, 1948 apply”.
The aim of the Act is to improve the institutional framework for dispute settlement and amending
labour laws relating to industrial relations to ensure that the country gets a stable, dignified and
efficient workforce, free from exploitation and capable of generating higher levels of output.
This is a special Labour Act for plantations using or which intends to use land measuring 5
hectares or more and employing 15 or more employees at any time during the preceding 12
months.
2. Factories Act, 1948
It applies to factories covered under the Factories Act, 1948 engaging ten (10) or more than ten
workers on any day of the preceding twelve months and are engaged in manufacturing process
being carried out with the aid of power or twenty or more than twenty workers are employed in
manufacturing process being carried out without the aid of power, are covered under the
provisions of this Act.
(i) Grant of Licences and to take action against factories running without obtaining Licence.
(ii) Renewal of Licences granted;
(iii) Inspections of factories for investigation of complaints, serious/fatal accidents as well as suo
moto inspections to check compliance of provisions of this Act relating to:

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 60


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Health
 Safety
 Welfare Facilities
 Working Hours
 Employment of Young Persons
 Annual Leave with wages etc.

3. Industrial Disputes Act, 1947


The Act is to secure industrial peace and harmony by providing machinery and procedure for the
investigation and settlement of industrial disputes by negotiations.
The laws apply only to the organized sector. The Act requires firms employing 100 or more
workers to obtain government permission for layoffs, retrenchments and closures.
The Act also lays down:
(a) The provision for payment of compensation to the workman on account of closure or lay off
or retrenchment;
(b) The procedure for prior permission of appropriate Government for laying off or retrenching
the workers or closing down industrial establishments;
(c) Unfair labour practices on part of an employer or a trade union or workers.

The Act also lays down provisions for making enquiry into and settlement of any dispute in
connection with the compliance or not of the terms and conditions of employment.

4. Employees Provident Fund & Miscellaneous Provisions Act, 1952


As per Preamble to the Act, the EPF Act is enacted to provide for the institution of provident
funds, pension fund and deposit lined insurance fund for employees in factories and other
establishments. The Act covers three schemes i.e. PF (Provident Fund scheme), FPF (Family
Pension Fund scheme) and EDLI (Employees Deposit Linked Insurance scheme).
The EPF Act contains basic provisions in respect of applicability, eligibility, damages, appeals,
recovery etc.
(i) The Act is applicable to every establishment which is a factory engaged in industry specified
in Schedule- I to the Act and in which 20 or more persons are employed; and
(ii) any other establishment or class of establishment employing 20 or more persons which may
be specified by Central government by notification in official gazette.

5. Employees State Insurance Act, 1948


The ESI Act is a social welfare legislation enacted with the object of providing certain benefits to
employees in case of sickness, maternity and employment injury. Under the Act, employees will
receive medical relief, cash benefits, maternity benefits, pension to dependents of deceased
workers and compensation for fatal or other injuries and diseases. The Act is applicable to workers
covered under Factory Act 1948. The act also applies to shops and establishments.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 61


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
6. Payment of Wages Act, 1936
The Payment of Wages Act, 1936 is a central legislation which has been enacted to regulate the
payment of wages to workers employed in certain specified industries and to ensure a speedy and
effective remedy to them against illegal deductions and/or unjustified delay caused in paying
wages to them. It applies to the persons employed in a factory, industrial or other establishment
or in a railway, whether directly or indirectly, through a sub-contractor.

7. Minimum Wages Act, 1948


This Act has been enacted to safeguard the interests of workers, mostly in the unorganised sector
by providing for the fixation of minimum wages in certain specified employments. It binds the
employers to pay their workers the minimum wages fixed under the Act from time to time.
Under the Act, both the Central Government and the State Governments are the appropriate
Governments to fix, revise, review and enforce the payment of minimum wages to workers in
respect of 'scheduled employments' under their respective jurisdictions.
Minimum wage and an allowance linked to the cost of living index is to be paid in cash, though
payment of wages fully in kind or partly in kind may be allowed in certain cases. The minimum
rate of wages consists of a basic wage and a special allowance, known as 'Variable Dearness
Allowance (VDA)' linked to the Consumer Price Index Number. The allowance is revised twice a
year, once in April and then in October.

8. Workmen’s Compensation Act, 1923


The Act provides for payment of compensation to workmen and their dependents in case of injury
and accident (including certain occupational disease) arising out of and in the course of
employment and resulting in disablement or death. The Act also includes persons employed in
factories, mines, plantations, mechanically propelled vehicles, construction works and certain
other hazardous occupations.

The amount of compensation to be paid depends on the nature of the injury and the average
monthly wages and age of workmen. The minimum and maximum rates of compensation payable
for death (in such cases it is paid to the dependents of workmen) and for disability have been
fixed and is subject to revision from time to time.
9. Payment of Bonus Act, 1965
The Act was enacted to provide for the payment of bonus to persons employed in certain
establishments on the basis of profits or productivity and for the matters connected therewith.

The Act applies to:-


(i) every factory as defined under the Factories Act, 1948; and
(ii) every other establishment in which twenty or more persons are employed on any day
during an accounting year.
(iii) all the workers except apprentices.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 62


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Minimum bonus as per Act is 8.33% on Basic and DA and eligibility being–workers drawing salary
upto Rs.10,000/- p.m. (Basic & DA) and worked for minimum 30 days. There is a maximum ceiling
for the bonus– Rs. 3500 (Basic & DA)

10. Payment of Gratuity Act, 1972


The Act was enacted to provide for a scheme for the payment of gratuity to employees engaged in
factories, mines, oilfields, plantations, ports, railway companies, shops or other establishments
employing ten or more persons and for matters connected therewith or incidental thereto.

 Gratuity shall be payable to an employee on the termination of his employment after he has
rendered continuous service for not less than five years:- (i) on his superannuation; or (ii) on
his retirement or resignation; or (iii) on his death or disablement due to accident or disease,
provided that the completion of continuous service of five years shall not be necessary where
the termination of the employment of any employee is due to death or disablement.

 The employer shall pay gratuity to an employee at the rate of fifteen days' wages based on
the rate of wages last drawn by the employee concerned for every completed year of service
or part thereof in excess of six months.

11. The Fatal Accidents Act, 1855.


The Act provides for compensation to the families of employees who have been fatally injured by
accidents resulting from actionable wrong doings.

12. Prevention of Food Adulteration Act, 1954 and Prevention of Food Adulteration Rules 1955
To ensure non-violation of the provisions of this Act, the tea estate should have stringent quality
control measures for establishing that:
(a) The nature, substance or quality demanded by the purchaser is actually been delivered.
(b) The tea does not contain any other substance or the tea being supplied is not substituted
wholly or partly by any inferior or cheaper substance, which affects the substance or quality
thereof
(c) The preparation or packing of the tea has not been done in a manner that could
contaminate the tea and render it injurious to health.
Laws on Land and Land Revenue of the State where situated
Every state has laws relating to holding of land, land revenue and other issues related to land
holding which have to be abided by the Tea Estate and necessary payments, filing of returns etc.
have to be done.
13. Law relating to Agricultural Income Tax of the State where situated
Agricultural income tax is a state subject and the states have their own laws regarding tax to be
paid and its administration.

14. Law relating to irrigation and water cess of the State where situated
State laws on this have to be abided with and default in this regard can attract penal provisions.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 63


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

15. Any other state level Act, like the Assam Tea Plantations Provident Fund and Pension Fund
and Deposit Linked Insurance Fund Scheme (Amendment) Act, 2005
State Governments have special laws which relate to the plantations and these should be abided
by the planation industry. (Are these common for Planation Industry)

16. Central Excise Tariff Act, 1985.


While exemption from additional duty has been accorded to tea and tea wastes under the Act,
manufacture of tea is chargeable under the Central Excise Tariff Act, 1985.

17. CENVAT credit Rules.


Where an entity is taking credit in its books for central excise duty, service tax or VAT paid on input
material or service or capital goods purchased it has to abide the above mentioned rules.

18. State Level VAT Act and Central Sales Tax Act.
The States have their own ‘Value Added Tax’ Act and impose various rates of tax on sale or
transfer of tea whereas when the tea is sold or transferred to a place outside the boundary of the
state the provisions of the Central Sales Tax Act shall apply.

19. Income Tax Act, 1961.


The Provisions of the Income Tax Act and Rules apply to the Plantation Industry in same way as
these provisions apply to any other Industry but there are few special provisions for the Plantation
Industry which are mentioned below:
Rules 7A and 7B have been inserted in the Income Tax Rules 1962 by the Income Tax (Second
Amendment) Rules, 2001, w.e.f. 1-4-2002 (i.e. assessment years 2002-03 and onwards):
(a) Income from the manufacture of rubber
Rule 7A. (1) Income derived from the sale of centrifuged latex or cenex or latex based crepes
(such as pale latex crepe) or brown crepes (such as estate brown crepe, remilled crepe, smoked
blanket crepe or flat bark crepe) or technically specified block rubbers manufactured or processed
from field latex or coagulum obtained from rubber plants grown by the seller in India shall be
computed as if it were income derived from business, and thirty-five per cent of such income shall
be deemed to be income liable to tax.
(2) In computing such income, an allowance shall be made in respect of the cost of planting
rubber plants in replacement of plants that have died or become permanently useless in an area
already planted, if such area has not previously been abandoned, and for the purpose of
determining such cost, no deduction shall be made in respect of the amount of any subsidy which,
under the provisions of clause (31) of section 10, is not includible in the total income.
(b) Income from the manufacture of coffee
Rule 7B. [(1) Income derived from the sale of coffee grown and cured by the seller in India shall be
computed as if it were income derived from business, and twenty-five per cent of such income
shall be deemed to be income liable to tax.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 64


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(1A) Income derived from the sale of coffee grown, cured, roasted and grounded by the seller in
India, with or without mixing chicory or other flavouring ingredients, shall be computed as if it
were income derived from business, and forty per cent of such income shall be deemed to be
income liable to tax.
Explanation : For the purposes of sub-rules (1) and (1A) "curing" shall have the same meaning as
assigned to it in clause (d) of section 3 of the Coffee Act, 1942 (7 of 1942)
(2) In computing the incomes referred to in sub-rules (1) and (1A), an allowance shall be made in
respect of the cost of planting coffee plants in replacement of plants that have died or become
permanently useless in an area already planted, if such area has not previously been abandoned,
and for the purpose of determining such cost, no deduction shall be made in respect of the
amount of any subsidy which, under the provisions of clause (31) of section 10, is not includible in
the total income.

(c) Income from the manufacture of tea


Rule 8. (1) Income derived from the sale of tea grown and manufactured by the seller in India
shall be computed as if it were income derived from business, and forty per cent of such income
shall be deemed to be income liable to tax.

(2) In computing such income an allowance shall be made in respect of the cost of planting bushes
in replacement of bushes that have died or become permanently useless in an area already
planted, if such area has not previously been abandoned, and for the purpose of determining such
cost, no deduction shall be made in respect of the amount of any subsidy which, under the
provisions of clause (30) of section 10, is not includible in the total income.

(d) Section 10(30) of the Income Tax Act, 1961 exempts from income tax any subsidy received
from the Tea Board for replanting or replacement of tea bushes or for rejuvenation or
consolidation of areas used for cultivation of tea in India.

(e) Section 10(31) of the Income Tax Act, 1961 exempts from income tax any subsidy received by
planters who carries on the business of growing and manufacturing rubber, coffee,
cardamom or such other commodity in India. The amount of any subsidy would be as
received from or through the concerned Board (Tea/Rubber/Coffee Boards) under any such
scheme for replantation or replacement of rubber plants, coffee plants, cardamom plants or
plants for the growing of such other commodity or for rejuvenation or consolidation of areas
used for cultivation of rubber, coffee, cardamom or such other commodity as the Central
Government may, by notification in the Official Gazette, specify.

(f) Section 33AB (Tea/Coffee/Rubber Development Account) provides for deduction from
income of an amount equal to the least of the following:

(i) a sum equal to the amounts deposited with National Bank for Agriculture and Rural
Development (NABARD) or in a Deposit Account opened by the assessee, in accordance
with or for the purpose specified in a scheme approved by the Tea/ Coffee/Rubber Board

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 65


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
with the previous approval of the Central Government or

(ii) 40 percent of the profit of the business computed in accordance with the provisions of
the Act before making any deduction under section 33AB and before adjusting brought
forward business loss under section 72, subject to certain conditions specified in the Act.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 66


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 14: Special transactions peculiar to the industry

Regulation of Plantation Industry by Respective Boards The activities of plantation Industry are
regulated by the respective Boards with respect to rendering financial and technical assistance for
cultivation, manufacture, marketing; research and developmental activities for augmentation of
production and improvement of quality of the products. The functions of respective Boards are
discussed very briefly as under:
Tea Board of India
The Tea Board was set up under the provision of Tea Act 1953 and it started functioning in April
1954. The Tea Board of India is an autonomous body, functioning under the Ministry of Commerce
and Industry, Government of India. Its headquarters are in Kolkata with seventeen offices across
India. The primary functions of tea board include rendering financial and technical assistance for
cultivation, manufacture, marketing of tea; promoting tea exports; registering and licensing of
manufacturers, brokers, tea waste dealers and persons engaged in the business of blending tea,
aiding research and developmental activities for augmentation of tea production and
improvement of tea quality as well as encouraging and assisting small growers sector financially
and technically. Apart from various developmental and regulatory functions, the Tea Board of
India undertakes direct promotional activities, which include organizing joint participation in
international fairs and exhibitions, arranging buyer-seller meets and sending and hosting trade
delegations. The Board also undertakes various market development activities such as market
surveys, market analysis, tracking of consumer behaviour and dissemination of all relevant
information to exporters/importers.
Coffee Board
The Coffee Board is a statutory body constituted under Coffee Act 1942, functioning under the
Ministry of Commerce and Industry, Government of India. The core activities of Board are
primarily directed towards research & development, transfer of technology, quality
improvement, extending development support to growing sector, promotion of coffee in export
and domestic markets.
Rubber Board
The Rubber Board is a statutory body constituted by the Government of India, under the Rubber
Act 1947, for the overall development of the rubber industry in the country. Board functions
under the administrative control of the Ministry of Commerce and Industry. Board is assisting and
encouraging scientific, technical and economic research; supplying technical advice to rubber
growers; and training growers in improved methods of plantation and cultivation, improving the
marketing of rubber, collection of statistics from owners of estates, dealers and manufacturers,
securing better working conditions and the provision and improvement of amenities and
incentives to workers.
Cess on Tea, Coffee and Rubber
 Tea Cess is levied on all teas produced in India under Section 25(1) of the Tea Act, 1953 at the
rate decided by the Government from time to time. The Cess at present is collected by the
Central Excise Department and credited to the Consolidated Fund of India after deducting the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 67


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
expenses of collection.
 Coffee cess: Cess on Coffee was regulated by the Indian Coffee Cess Act, 1935, which was
repealed by the Coffee Act 1942.
 Rubber Cess: At present there is zero paise per kg as the rate of cess on rubber produced in
India or procured for export production by the Export Oriented Units (EOUs), Units in the
Export Processing Zones (EPZs) and Units in the Special Economic Zones (SEZs) and zero paise
per kg as the rate of cess on Natural Rubber produced in India and procured for export by the
exporters of Natural Rubber. The duty of excise levied under Sub-section (1) shall be collected
by the Board in accordance with rules made in this behalf either from the owner of the estate
on which the rubber is produced or from the manufacturer by whom such rubber is used or
from the exporter by whom such rubber is exported.
Welfare of Workforce engaged in Plantation
The Plantation Act 1951 makes the provisions of wholesome Drinking Water to workers by the
employers, provisions of latrines and urinals separately for female and male and these should be
manned in a clean and sanitary condition, provisions of medical facilities for the workers and their
families should be made readily available.
Also, it provides for setting up of canteens, crèches for the use of children who are below the age
of six years, recreational facilities, suitable accommodation and educational facilities for the
benefit of plantation workers in and around the work places in the plantation estate and
provisions of necessary housing facilities for every worker and his family residing in the plantation
estate.
Nurseries
Nurseries are established and maintained for raising various propagation materials for planting.
These include seedling stumps, budded stumps and advanced planting materials like polybag
plants, stumped budding and soil core plants. Mother plants or source bushes for the
multiplication of bud wood are also grown in nurseries. Raising of plants is easier and cheaper in
nurseries than in the main field. Moreover, nurseries offer an opportunity for selection of vigorous
and uniform plants. The following activities are involved in Nurseries:

1. Establishment of Nursery: Nursery is developed gradually. The mother plants planted for
vegetative and seed propagation. Seed propagated plants are Tea, Coffee, and Rubber etc.
Some important aspects of propagation are: Raising from seeds, Vegetative Propagation such
cutting, layering, division, separation, budding and grafting.
A number of structures may be necessary for raising a nursery such as Work shed, Polyhouse,
Store-cum-office, Fencing etc. Land preparation or the land development for nursery is very
important. In nursery, the land may be divided into minimum four parts viz. (a) area for
mother plant, (b) area for seed production, (c) area for raising seedlings and area for storing of
seedlings or vegetatively propagated perennial plants.
2. Management of Nursery: For rapid and economic production of good quality planting
materials, very efficient and careful management of the nursery is necessary. This would lead
to higher productivity. Unhealthy and weak seedlings are to be removed. The Management of

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 68


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Nursery involves the following activities:
(a) Seedbed and nursery beds
(b) Collection and planting of mother plants
(c) Storage of dried, cleaned soil and compost manure
(d) Production of seeds
(e) Storage of propagated plants in nursery beds
(f) Manuring
(g) Watering
(h) Drainage
(i) Plant protection
(j) Harvesting
(k) Packing and handling
(l) Storage
3. Cost of development of Nursery: cost of development of nursery depends on the products
for which it being developed. The cost of development is in respect of planting materials i.e.
cost of preparation of land for raising plants, cost of seeds, manuring, weeding, polythene
bags, budding, spraying, irrigation etc. Indirect costs like interest on borrowings, depreciation
of fixed assets etc. are also part of cost of development.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 69


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 15 Activities/ Services of the industry


Tea Tasting
Like many other agricultural product tea is not a uniform product. Tea has various characteristics
which are finally manifested in the liquor and flavor of the tea, giving rise to various grades with
varying demand and commanding a wide range of prices. The characteristics depend on the
geographical location of the tea estate, the manufacturing process and several other factors.
The ascertainment of the grade of the tea and consequently the prices is done through evaluation
of the characteristics of the tea by a process called “Tea Tasting”. Tea tasting has established
standard procedure but is subjective in nature due to the dependence on intangible
characteristics of ‘liquor’ and ‘flavor’. Tea tasting is done by trained professionals who possess a
natural talent of an encyclopedic palate memory so that the taster can compare the flavor with
that of a number of samples tasted over the years, which are not presently available. The natural
talent cultivated through years of training and experience gives the tea tasters a keen sense of
smell that make them proficient tea tasters. The tea tasting cannot be done in laboratories.
Coffee tasting
Coffee tasting or coffee cupping is done to determine the characteristics of a particular coffee
blend. A coffee taster judges coffee based on appearance, aroma, body, and flavour by first
smelling and then tasting the coffee. He or she will taste the coffee at various temperatures to
discover all the complexities of the blend or bean.
Marketing
Tea Marketing
Tea is mainly sold through Indian and International Tea Auction Centers although sale takes place
in other modes as well. The various modes of tea sales are:
1. Public auctions (Both physical and on-line auctions)
2. Direct domestic sale from Tea Estates
3. Direct sales through Exporters (C& F Agents)
4. On-line trading.
While the tea producers decide on the mode of sales, out of the above modes, sale through public
auction finds maximum favour among the tea producers.
Process of Sale through Public Auction
The process of sale through public auction starts with the arrival of the tea at a warehouse
registered with a particular Tea Auction Centre (through which the auction will take place) who
intimates the date of the arrival and the quantity of tea received to the registered brokers
(auctioneers) through issue of “Arrival and Weighment Report”. The Brokers then draw out
sample of size varying between 8 Kg. and 11 Kg. from the lot. The sample thus drawn is divided
into different sizes and is sent to the registered tea buyers along with the catalogues and valuation
reports. Where the registered buyer is a commission agent, the samples are again sent to the real
buyers. On the basis of the feedback from the buyers the broker prepares itself for the auction.
This process might take several weeks.
The tea lots are auctioned in a sequential order and the auction is held on different dates at

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 70


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
different auction centers. The buyers (or their commission agents) may bid jointly for the same lot
but the lot can be bought jointly by maximum of three buyers.
If a particular lot is not sold during a particular auction the lot can be presented again for sale
through auction but not before two weeks.
The sales proceed after deduction of any advance and/or commission shall be paid to the seller by
the end of two weeks from the date of the sale if the sale has taken place during first
presentation. However, if the sales take place during second presentation, the payment will be
made to the seller by the fifth week from the date of the first presentation.
Coffee Marketing
Prior to liberalization of economy in 1991, the Coffee Board of India was having the powers to
regulate the marketing of the entire coffee produce under a unique pooling system. However,
consequent to de-pooling in the early 1990s, the Coffee Board of India had withdrawn from the
direct marketing activities and now the Board is focusing in the areas of research, extension,
development and market development programmes.
Rubber Marketing
Rubber Board of India is rendering Marketing and Export Promotion Services to Rubber
Manufacturers with the aim to develop new markets for the products, maintain and improve
them for better marketing and export. The Board provides a wide range of services like Market
survey reports, Trade Directories and information, export promotion, export training etc. The
information provided by the Board is highly useful to improve the marketability of the products
and to increase exports in the country.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 71


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 16: Audit of Plantation Industry

Internal Control System


The basic nature of Plantation Industry and its unique features demand the existence of a strong
internal control and internal audit systems in Plantation Industry for the following reasons:
(i) The field productivity of the raw materials vis-à-vis the quantum of output is highly
dependent on the condition of the weather. The input-output ratio cannot be fixed
rigorously and at the same time, the total quantum of output of final product cannot also
be forecast with substantial accuracy many a times;
(ii) The total operation of the Estate is controlled by a few managerial staff as compared to the
vastness of the area of the estate and variety of operational functions involved;
(iii) Because of this vastness of the total area of any Estate being looked after by a small number
of managerial staff usually, it becomes very difficult to exercise personal managerial
supervision in all cases;
(iv) Sometimes, it becomes difficult to exercise the managerial supervision on the workers, to
the fullest extent considering the low ratio of managerial staff and the number of workers
and the Estate Management has to depend on the supervisory staff for most of the
operations.
In view of above factors, the existence of an integrated and well-organized Internal Audit System
is very important in Plantation Industry because a structured Internal Audit system will
continuously assess the existence and effectiveness of the internal control system in all the
operational areas. Internal Audit will point out any gap found in the Internal Control system in all
the operational areas and will also facilitate the continuous improvement in the Internal Control
System and procedures. To achieve these objectives, Internal Auditors have to take a pragmatic
and practical approach while framing the Internal Audit Programme.
Internal audit in Plantation Industry
The major Tea/Coffee/Rubber producing and manufacturing organizations in India are registered
under the Companies Act, 1956 (replaced by Companies Act 2013). Some estates work under the
legal systems of Partnership/ Proprietorship/ Trust/ Society. The Internal auditor’s audit plan
needs to cover all the tea estates, the corporate and registered office.
General Internal Audit Functions:
1. Internal audit shall start with understanding the legal structure and the organizational
structure of the Entity. It is useful to obtain a diagram of the organizational structure with the
authority-responsibility relationships embedded in it. If it is not readily available, the internal
auditor can draw one for himself which will be of immense help in conducting the audit.

2. Next step is to understand the internal control system (which encompasses the financial and
cost accounting system) existing in the entity and to what extent it is in place. A flow diagram
of the internal control system with sequence of the activities, the procedures to be followed,
generation of documents, maintenance of records, authorization at each stage and the flow of
information, may be developed for better understanding of the internal control system. With

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 72


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
the help of this diagram the internal auditor shall proceed to review the efficacy of the entity’s
policies, plans, systems and procedures, identify any sign of failure of the system and find ways
of improving the control mechanism to make it more efficient and cost effective.

3. The internal auditor having assessed and established the level of efficacy of the internal control
system shall proceed to measure the performance-efficiency through various parameters like
financial and other ratios.
4. The internal auditor shall review the existing system of identification of risks and their
mitigation and assess its efficacy.
5. The Internal auditor shall refer to the internal audit report of the previous year and also to the
report of the statutory auditor to find out areas in which greater emphasis needs to be given
during the current year’s audit.
Internal Audit Functions at Estates:
The Internal auditor should inter alia focus on the following aspects of the plantation activities
while planning and conducting the internal audit functions:

1. Administration of the landed property held by the estate: Many of the estates own land
measuring several acres and administration of the land is an important activity which involves
the following:
(a) Proper maintenance of records: The land held by an estate may be owned or taken on long
term lease from the State Government or others. In either case the legal documents needs to
be stored with utmost safety and security. A proper record documenting the important
information contained in these legal documents should be maintained along with details of
actions to be taken and the date of such action taken e.g. renewal of the lease agreement.
Entries in the record shall be signed by the person responsible for maintaining the record and
counter signed by the Estate Manager.
(b) Detailed map and record of the estate: At every estate a detailed map should be available
showing the location and measurement of the total area under control of the estate. The map
shall present the area under cultivation with identification (number or alpha-numeric) for the
various sections, area not under cultivation, area used for nurseries & other plantations, the
buildings, labour hutments and other structures, network of roads, culverts, bridges, water
bodies etc. This map should be reviewed from time to time and changes in character of land
should be incorporated. Record of changes made from time to time should be maintained with
signature of the persons involved and the Estate Manager. The various sections under
plantation shall have placards/boards mentioning the number assigned to that section in the
map for easy identification. Records shall also be available of the plantation, of the number of
tea plants (bushes) in each section with dates for original plantation and refilling if there has
been any.
(c) Regular inspection of the estate: This is of utmost importance to ensure that the area not
under cultivation is free from encroachment and precautionary measures can be taken for any
early signal of possible encroachment or illegal felling of tree (e.g. by construction of fences) or
natural disaster (e.g. by construction of embankment required to prevent erosion of soil or

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 73


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
overflow of water from a river or canal running through or in the vicinity of the estate). Record
for such inspection carried out should be maintained along with the report of the inspector
who conducted the inspection, action planned and action taken duly signed by the person who
conducted the inspection and the Estate Manager.
(d) Review of the land and its utilization: The Estate Manager along with concerned officials
should periodically review the following and keep record of the decisions taken and executed,
duly signed by the reviewer:

(i) Whether any litigation exists, to free any land from encumbrance, the status/progress of
the court case.
(ii) Whether any unutilized land is being vested to the State Government and if so, steps to be
taken to recover the land or to avail compensation as per law.
(iii) Scope for bringing more land under plantation or for setting up of seed nurseries or shade
tree nurseries with commercial prospect thus ensuring optimal utilization of the land and
steps to be taken in that direction.

(e) Land owned for cultivation attracts land revenue and other rates and taxes as per State laws
and requires submission of information/returns. This activity should be carefully monitored so
that these are done in timely manner and necessary and proper records are maintained.
1. Management of agricultural activity: Agricultural activity is the largest activity in an estate in
terms of involvement of time and other resources. Normally the land in an estate is segregated
into zones, areas and sections which are depicted clearly in the map/plan which helps better
administration. The management at the estates in consultation with the Corporate Office/Head
Office periodically reviews the programmes for production of tea/coffee/rubber which is aimed
at better compliance of the corporate policies that revolve around the primary objective of
maximization of the earning of the shareholders. The earnings from the plantation products
depend inter alia on the quantum of sales and the quality of the products sold. The quantity
and quality of the tea/coffee/rubber may also depend on the variety of seeds or clones planted
to grow the bushes/rubber trees. Any change in the programme leads to change in the timing
and the procedures to be adopted for activities like pruning/tapping and plucking/crop
collection, utilization of resources and ultimately the expenditure to be incurred. The major
activities involved are:
(a) Providing proper irrigation as per the garden inspection report and for that arrangements
have to be done. Where motor pumps with supply pipes and generator to run the pumps
(where connection for electricity is not available) are required, necessary arrangements for
the same either through new purchase or hiring, has to be made, if these are not already
available or are engaged elsewhere. Requisition for issue of pump, generator and HSD is to
be made under proper authorization. On receipt of the requisition the availability of pump
and generator shall be looked into by referring to the asset control register and if not
available requisition shall be given for procurement through hiring or purchase. In case of
hiring the capacity and the hiring charges shall be approved by the Estate Management.
(b) Treating each section with manure, timely and regularly, ascertainment of labour required for

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 74


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
that purpose and to plan for labour while intimating the requirement for manure to the
stores.
(c) Ascertaining the need for spraying pesticide and then to estimate the quantity required. To
estimate the number of manual spraying machines required and place requisition for the
same. To make assessment for labour required and arrangement for the labour.
(d) Ascertaining the sections where ‘weeding’ is required along with the manner of weeding
(manually or by spraying ‘weedicide’). Necessary arrangement for the weedicides, spraying
machine and the labour required for either manual weeding or by spraying ‘weedicide’ is to
be planned in advance and requisition/arrangement to be made.
(e) Determine the pruning/tapping policy for different sections, arrange for the number of
labour required and issue requisition for the implements.
(f) To decide on the policy for plucking during the different flushes and for different sections and
adherence to the same. The arrangement of labour in accordance with the plucking/ tapping
schedule is to be done. The quality of plucking (ideally two leaves and one bud is to be
plucked but during plucking some leaves immediately below the two leaves and the bud are
also torn off and if the proportion of such leaves is higher the quality of ‘made tea’
deteriorates and generates higher percentage of tea waste) and quantity of the plucked
leaves is to be monitored and necessary actions to enhance quantity and/or quality is to be
taken because this has a direct bearing on the quantity and quality of tea manufactured.
(g) Ensure proper care of the shade trees and to ascertain whether new shade trees are required
to be planted for which arrangement is to be made for saplings of shade trees which may
come from the shade tree nursery or may be purchased.
(h) Ensure that drains and slopes are present for proper drainage of excessive water and labour
required to make the drains or to do the sloping.
(i) Regularly review the policy for uprooting old plants and re-planting or fresh planting by
reclamation of unused/barren land. Once a section is identified for re-plantation or fresh
plantation the ground needs to be prepared which is an extensive activity and is followed by
planting and then nurturing the plants till they are matured enough to start plucking. The
whole activity needs to be properly planned and arrangement made for the resources
required.
(j) Any tea/coffee/rubber estate maintains a plant nursery where the tea/coffee/rubber plants
and the shade tree plants which are either from seeds or are clones developed from
research, are nurtured. The plant nursery needs manures and pesticides, supply of water,
gardening implements and labour.
(k) Where a section of the estate is not being used for growing any one of the plantation
products then it may be used for other crops like cinnamon, vanilla, banana etc. having
commercial value, the materials and labour utilized to maintain and the revenue earned
needs to be traced.
(l) Production and other quantitative and statistical records shall be analyzed to ascertain
whether the resources have been optimally utilized and cost effectiveness has been
achieved.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 75


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
2. Upkeep, repairs and maintenance of assets: An estate needs to make efforts for the upkeep of
the internal roads, culverts and bridges, all-around the estate, the labour hutments and the
plant nursery beside the repairs and maintenance of the Civil structures, electric installations,
machineries and motor vehicles. An estate can have an annual maintenance programme
(which might be periodical, based on hours/KMs run or some other appropriate aspect) or
contingent plan for maintenance might be made based on necessity. Plantation crops are
seasonal, for some time of the year, the production of tea/coffee/rubber and accordingly
manufacturing activities remain either low or nil. During this lean period keeping the plant and
machineries in working condition require special attention. When there is no production
overall repairs and maintenance is carried out. Repairs and maintenance may be done in-
house with material from the stores and using own labour. Alternatively, the work can be
assigned to external agencies. While every such work needs to be properly authorized, for in-
house job, requisition for issue of stores, implements etc. along with the labour engaged and
paid for, should be co-related with the work authorized. Where external agency is engaged, to
verify whether their selection has been done in accordance with the established procedure and
the management approved terms and conditions of such appointment, have been adhered.
The propriety of the expenditure incurred, the quantum of expenditure booked and paid for
needs to be examined. The maintenance activities are generally of the following types:
(a) The roads, culverts and bridges connecting every nook and corner of the estate are
subject to wear and tear and may also be damaged by unforeseen incidents.
(b) The labour hutments, arrangement for potable water and sanitation facility provided
to the labourers need to be maintained as per the established internal standards or
the requirement of legislation.
(c) To arrange for upkeep of the nurseries: the shades made of bamboo and polythene.
(d) The buildings within the estate like factory building, warehouse, garage, office
building, quarters of the staff and other civil constructions along with their electrical
and mechanical installations require regular repairs and maintenance.
(e) The mechanical and electrical tools and implements including motors, pumps and
generators used for various plantations, manufacturing and other activities need to be
repaired and properly maintained to keep these functional. Measuring equipments
like weighing scales need to be similarly maintained and also periodically calibrated by
accredited agencies.
(f) The machineries at the factory and the motor vehicles need regular repairs and
maintenance.
3. Materials Management: Procurement/Purchase of material whether centralized or local, their
storage and management, assumes high importance since the amount of fund involved is
considerable. The materials primarily required in an estate having both plantation and
manufacturing activity include:
(a) Samplings and seeds and shade tree samplings for plantation in the estate.
(d) Manure, pesticide, weedicide/herbicide and chemicals for direct application in the
estates.
(e) Fuel like petrol, HSD, Furnace oil, Coal and fire wood.
(f) Mechanical and electrical equipment/implements, their spares and spares for plant

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 76


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
and machinery used in agricultural and manufacturing activities and also for
household of the resident staffs and labour.
(g) Sundry consumable items used for production and manufacturing activities and also
for household of the resident staffs and labour.
(h) Food items provided to the staff and labour free of cost or at concessional rate.
(i) Medicine and medical consumables.
(j) Packing materials.

Check List
A. General understanding and evaluation
General understanding and evaluation of the existing accounting and control systems and
ascertaining their application on a continuous basis:
(i) Studying the organizational structure of the entity together with the authority-responsibility
relationships.
(ii) Studying the internal control manual and accounts manual (if any) and ascertain the existing
accounting and control systems: the flow of information, authorization procedure,
documentation of transactions, records maintained and reports/statements generated and
judge their efficacy.
(iii) Verify whether proper records required by the accounting and internal control system are
being maintained and whether the entries are being counter-checked and authorized.
(iv) Verify whether adequate and timely information is reaching the Management through
properly designed MIS system.
(v) Verify whether adequate and timely returns on revenue and capital expenditure incurred,
cash flow statements, are being sent to the Corporate Office.
(vi) Verify whether adequate security exists for the accounting and other data maintained
manually or through electronic systems, where the data is being maintained in standalone
computers whether proper backup is being kept.
(vii) Verify whether there is a policy for retention of record and their destruction beyond the
retention period and whether the same is being followed.
(viii) Verify whether there exists a mechanism for continual improvement in the functioning of
the different departments with specific performance indicators and whether these are being
reviewed periodically.
Verify whether regular meetings are being held between the departments and the management
to resolve doubts and differences and to improve the performance of the internal control
system. Whether actions are being taken on the decisions made in the meetings and being
followed up.

B. Land Matters:
i. Review the status of Land holdings of the Estate –
a. Whether free hold land; or
b. Grant obtained from Government for plantation.
ii. In case of Grant obtained from Government for plantation, to check whether it is

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 77


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
a) Simple Grant; or
b) Special Cultivation Grant;
iii. Whether the documents of freehold land and Grant in the form of Leasehold Land (Patta)
obtained from Government or copies thereof (where original documents are preserved at
H.O.) are available at the Estate;
iv. Review the status of payment of Land Rent or Leasehold Rent -whether payment of rent is
up-to-date;
v. To verify whether the statutory payments have been made and necessary
information/returns have been submitted timely to the authorities;
vi. Whether Grant Map produced by Govt. approved Surveyors from the Govt. Cadastral
Survey are available and boundaries are properly marked;
vii. To check whether the Estate lands are periodically surveyed by Government approved
Surveyors to update Estate’s maps showing boundaries, estate facilities and areas under
plantation (with area statement) - this is required to prevent encroachment and
unauthorized occupation of Estate’s land by outsiders as well as by the Estate workers;
viii. To verify whether legal documents are kept in safe and joint custody of the Estate
Manager and at least another person and whether record of legal documents is
maintained and entries updated with proper authorization;
ix. Record of regular inspection of the Estate is to be viewed and verified whether action
wherever necessary, has been taken on the basis of such inspection and also whether the
changes in the character of the land, wherever necessary, has been incorporated in the
map of the Estate under proper authorization;
x. Record of review of the status of the land and decisions taken on such review are to be
seen and steps taken for execution of the decision are to be verified.
C. Agricultural activity:
(i) To verify whether optimum utilization of the resources by minimizing wastage/idle time and
preventing pilferage/manipulation in payment, has been achieved;
(ii) Whether the programme and written instructions have been referred to.
(iii) Whether actual activity (as per the records like “Cultivation Book” and “Kamzari” register)
has been correlated with the consumption of material resources and labour payment made;
(iv) Are material consumption and labour efficiency comparable with the industry and
organization standard, with the previous periods and the budget/projection for the period.

Review the efficacy of the following activities:


I. Irrigation:
(i) Requirement of irrigation mentioning section of the garden and the area covered;
(ii) Actual running hours of the pump should be compared with the technical estimate of its
capacity to pump water;
(iii) Where generator used, capacity of the generator and actual running hours should be
compared with the HSD requisitioned for and issued from the stores and consumed;
(iv) If pump and/or generator is hired, the terms of hiring and approval from proper authority;
(v) Check fixed asset register for pump/generator owned and their utilization, necessitating
hiring;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 78


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(vi) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register.

II. Application of Agricultural Inputs:


(a) Manuring Application:
(i) Whether requirement for manuring is based on annual and contingent plans with written
instructions mentioning section of the garden and the area covered;
(ii) Whether quantity of manure requisitioned for has been issued by the store;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Review the report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work;
(v) Whether Section/ Field No. wise programme for ground application of manure/ fertilizer has
been drawn;
(vi) Whether soil testing has been carried out before preparing the Section / Field No. wise
manure application programme;
(vii) Whether record is maintained for actual application of manure incorporating following
information:
(i) Section/ Field No.;
(ii) Area & Hectare;
(iii) Date of application;
(iv) Names of the manure/ fertilizers applied;
(v) Quantum of application of each category of manure;
(vi) Manpower deployed.
(viii) Compare actual application with the programme;
(ix) Whether quantity of different manures applied as per application record with the quantity
issued on the respective dates as per Stores record;
(x) Whether number of man-days recorded in the application record with the corresponding
figure of daily deployment record under the head “Manure/ Fertilizer Application”;
(xi) Review the reasonability of man-days deployed with reference to the task fixed for manure
application;
(xii) Whether any foliar application programme has been drawn (for Tea cultivation only);
(xiii) Whether any permanent record for foliar application is maintained which should contain the
following information:
 Date
 Section/ Field No(s). where foliar applied
 Area
 Fertilizer used
 Dose
 Total quantity of each of the fertilizers used
 Total volume of diluted fertilizers (either in terms of 200 Ltrs Drums or in Ltrs.)
 No. of man-days used.
(xiv) Whether the above records have been verified with reference to basic records like Stores
Issue records, Daily Manpower Deployment records, etc.;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 79


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(xv) Whether Register is regularly checked and signed by the Asst. Manager – In-charge of
Cultivation;
(xvi) Whether any fertilizer issued from Stores but remained unused (may be in full quantity or
partially) either due to any disruption caused by rain or because of any other reasons, has
been returned to Stores at the end of the day and also it is recorded in the Application
Register.
In case of the Estates where any Sub-Store is not maintained for the Division(s), it should be
checked that the Application Register has the provision for recording the quantum of chemicals
which remain unused at the end of the day and it should also be checked and reconciled that the
same is applied on subsequent dates.
(b) Application of pesticide:
(i) Whether requirement of pesticides of different types is based on annual and contingent plans
and written instructions;
(ii) Quantity of pesticide requisitioned for and issued by the store;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work shall be scrutinized;
(v) Whether any annual budget is prepared for Pest Control of the Estate;
(vi) Whether budget is prepared in totality at least containing the following particulars:
a) Estimates of different insecticides/ pesticides to be used;
b) Cost of materials based on estimate of quantum of different insecticides to be applied;
c) Estimated Number of man-days to be required and total cost of manpower;
d) Other expenditure like cost of petrol to be used in Sprayers, expenditure on maintenance
of sprayers;
(vii) Whether any programme has been drawn for application of Pesticides specifically for
prophylactic spraying with special emphasis that -
a) Whether any calendar followed;
b) Whether No. of rounds for different chemicals to be sprayed mentioned;
(viii) Whether any Application Register is maintained for spraying of insecticides also in the same
line as mentioned in case of spraying of weedicides;
(ix) Verify from Application Record whether programme for prophylactic spraying has been
followed or not;
(x) Examine the expenditure on application of Insecticides to find out the quantity of chemicals
applied per Hectare vis-à-vis Cost per Hectare;
(xi) Check the actual expenditure with the budget and to report if any variation is found;
(xii) Carry out analysis of the comparative expenditure for a period of 3 / 4 years and report
thereon;
(xiii) Examine the garden records to find whether any loss of crop reported due to pest infestation;
(xiv) Check action taken for such pest infestation correlated with the quantum of application of
Pesticides;
(xv) Review the Stores record to find out whether any stock out situation occurred due to which
timely curative spraying could not be carried out owing to non-availability of Pesticides in the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 80


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Estate’s Stores;
(xvi) For Tea cultivation, to check whether Fungicides has been sprayed within 24 hours of hail
damage – if not, to check the reasons thereof and report.
(c) Weed Control:
(i) Whether the requirement of weeding is based on annual and contingent plans with written
instructions on manual weeding and application of weedicide;
(ii) Whether the quantity of pesticide requisitioned for and issued by the store are as per the
standards and any variation is duly authorized;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work shall be scrutinize;
(v) Review the budget to find out whether the Budget provides for the amount to be spent for
weed control and the same is trifurcated into the following categories:
(a) Manual weeding;
(b) Mechanical weeding like Sickling, Cheelhoeing;
(c) Chemical Weeding.
(vi) Whether the budget is prepared in totality at least containing the following particulars:
(a) Estimates of different chemicals to be used;
(b) Cost of materials based on estimate of quantum of different chemicals to be applied;
(c) Estimated Number of man-days to be required for the respective categories of weed
control, as mentioned above, and total cost of manpower;
(d) Other expenditure like cost of petrol to be used in Sprayers, Cost of maintenance of
mechanical implements etc.
(vii) Whether detailed programme has been chalked out for different types of weed control
depending upon different seasons of the year;
(viii) Review the programme for chemical weed control to see that separate spraying programme is
drawn for pre-emergent period of weeds and post-emergent period of weeds;
(ix) Whether the programme is drawn for blanket spraying of different varieties of weedicides like
Paraquat, 2-4-D Sodium Salt, Glyphosate, etc. specifying each section/ Field No. and number
of rounds to be sprayed on each section/ field;
(x) Check the actual expenditure with the budget and to report if any variation is found;
(xi) Compare the actual application of different chemicals with the budgeted quantity as per
application programme;
(xii) Whether any permanent record for spraying weedicides is maintained which should contain
the following information:
a) Date
b) Section/ Field No. where weedicides applied
c) Area
d) Names of weedicides/ herbicides used
e) Dose
f) Total quantity of each of the weedicides/ herbicides used
g) Total volume of diluted weedicides (either in terms of number of 200 Ltr Drums or in
terms of Ltrs.)

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 81


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
h) No. of man-days used.
(xiii) Check the quantity of chemicals shown as applied in the Application record with the Stores
record and also with reference to the man-days utilized as recorded in the Application
Register based on task fixed for spraying;
(xiv) Check the inventory of Sprayers;
(xv) Whether appropriate record is maintained for Sprayers incorporating therein ‘Issue of
Sprayers to the field workers and subsequent return to Field Office at the end of the day after
completion of spraying;
(xvi) Whether sprayers are returned by the workers to the Field Office after use and no Sprayers is
retained by them for next day’s use;
(xvii) Whether the Estate has adequate number of Sprayers, so that Spraying operation is not
hindered due to lack of Sprayers;
(xviii) Check the inventory of sprayers physically with reference to the record and to report if any
discrepancy is found;
(xix) Whether the inventory of sprayers of the estate includes considerable number of unusable
/defective Sprayers;
(xx) Examine the expenditure on the repair / rectification of sprayers caused by wear and tear due
to daily use and to review the Cost Benefit Analysis of purchasing new sprayers vis-à-vis
repairing the old Sprayers.
(xxi) Whether any weedicides issued from Stores remains unapplied (may be in full quantity or
partially) due to any disruption caused by rain or because of any other reasons, the same is
returned to Stores at the end of the day and recorded in the Application Register.
In case of the Estates where any Sub-Store is not maintained for the Division(s), it should be
checked that the Application Register has the provision for recording the quantum of chemicals
which remain unused at the end of the day and it should also be checked and reconciled that the
same is applied on subsequent dates.
(d) Pruning (applicable for Tea cultivation only):
(i) Whether the requirement of pruning of different types based on annual and contingent plans
and written instructions;
(ii) Whether the requisition is made for issue of implements and whether the same has been
returned to the stores;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized;
(v) Whether proper pruning programme mentioning Section/ Field Nos. and type of pruning to
be carried out for each section/ field No. is drawn specifying the time frame for
commencement and completion of the job;
(vi) Whether actual pruning has been carried out according the programme;
(vii) Check the actual deployment of man-days in pruning with reference to standard task fixed per
man-day for each type of pruning and total area pruned under each type of pruning.

(e) Other Cultivation Operations:


I. Fixation of Task for different agricultural operations:

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 82


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(i) Whether standard task has been fixed for all the major cultivation operations;
(ii) Examine the process of fixation of task;
(iii) Compare the standard task fixed for different operations with the task fixed for similar
operations in the neighboring Estates or the Estates in the same Circle or area;
(iv) Whether the payment of a part of wages is linked to fulfillment of task.
II. Other agricultural operations:
(i) Whether any programme is drawn for other agricultural operations like fencing, manual
weeding including Sickle weeding, infilling of Plants /shade plants, forking, Sulphur dusting
(for rubber plantation), or these operations are undertaken as and when needs arise;
(ii) Whether records are maintained for recording actual work done;
(iii) Whether the following information are recorded therein:
(a) Date,
(b) Area,
(c) Section No./ Field No.,
(d) Name of the operation,
(e) Quantum of work done viz. area covered, no. of plants infilled, length of the fencing done,
etc.
(iv) Whether above records are maintained for individual operations;
(v) Check the records with reference to the actual man-days deployment record and to see that
correlation can be done between volume of work done and number of man-days deployed.
(vi) Where crops other than tea/Coffee/rubber are being grown to fruitfully utilize the vacant
sections, the expenditure incurred needs to be compared with the revenue earned from such
activity to assess the benefit of such activity.
III. Fresh and Extension/ re-plantation:
(i) The section of the estate is selected as per Management decision and written instructions
have been issued;
(ii) Whether the requisition of stores, tools and implements and issue of the same has been in
accordance with written authorization;
(iii) Labour engagement has been done in accordance with the instructions (with subsequent
modifications if any) and matches with attendance and payment made;
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work shall be scrutinized;
(v) Whether all the costs incurred for uprooting of trees, shrubs, weeds etc., preparation of the
ground for new plantation, sowing new plants and their nurturing till they are matured for
plucking (normally upto three years) are being capitalized.
(vi) Whether the Company has any extension planting programme;
(vii) Whether the Estate has any land available for extension planting and the extension planting
programme has been prepared on the basis of the soil testing report of such available land;
(viii) Examine that the Estate has the long term uprooting and replanting programme;
(ix) The uprooting and replanting programme should be examined to find that –
(a) Selection of the section/ field for uprooting and re-plantation is made on the basis of yield
analysis reports of sections/ fields;
(b) Whether actual / potentially sick sections or fields are identified for uprooting / re-

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 83


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
plantation;
(x) Examine whether the detailed budget has been prepared (simultaneously sections/ field-
wise & year-wise) for extension planting/ re-plantation;
(xi) Whether the budget contains the following major elements of expenditure :-
(a) Land clearance (in case of extension) or uprooting ( in case of re-plantation ) expenditure;
(b) Land leveling for Cover Crop & Cover Crop expenditure;
(c) Land Survey Expenditure;
(d) Land preparation expenditure;
(e) Soil rehabilitation;
(f) Cost of planting material;
(g) Planting expenses;
(h) 4 years’ maintenance expenditure.
(xii) Examine the Estate’s plan for sourcing planting materials – whether to use Plant from own
nursery or to source Plants from external sources;
(xiii) In case the Estate plans for sourcing the planting materials from own nursery, to check
whether the plan and budget for building up the nursery within the Estate has been chalked
out for meeting current requirement as well as future requirement;
(xiv) Whether the extension planting/ uprooting and re-plantation programme is being
implemented as per plan;
(xv) Whether the detailed records are maintained in the Estate in respect of extension planting/
uprooting and re-plantation planting in respect of individual sections/ field Nos.;
(xvi) Whether the following details are maintained in the records:
(a) Area covered under extension planting;
(b) Area covered under uprooting and re-plantation;
(c) Date of commencement of uprooting and date of completion of uprooting;
(d) Date of commencement and completion respectively for Land Clearance/ Preparation for
Green Crop Cover;
(e) Green Crop cover used for soil rehabilitation;
(f) Date of commencement and completion of land preparation for planting;
(g) Date of commencement and completion of planting;
(h) Type of Plants used for planting;
(i) Spacing of Plants;
(j) No. of Plants planted (after physical verification)
(k) Date of survey after Planting.
(xvii)In case of re-plantation, the following points are required to be checked;
(xviii) Examine the expenditure on uprooting (in case of re-plantation) and compare the same
with the Budget;
(xix) Check the records maintained for uprooting Tea Bushes/ Coffee Plants/ Shed Trees and
Rubber Trees;
(xx) Measurement of quantity of timber & firewood obtained after lopping and chopping;
(xxi) Check the records for internal utilization of fire wood where fire wood are issued either as
fuel for production or for issue to labour as fuel;
(xxii) In case fire wood and timbers are sold, to check the process of selling, fixation of price and

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 84


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
realization of sale proceeds;
(xxiii) Examine the reconciliation between the generation of fire wood/ timber and use/ sale of
such fire wood/ timber;
(xxiv) Whether the Estate maintains record in respect of each section/ field newly planted or
replanted, the total actual expenditure incurred for planting/ replanting which includes all
items of expenses as mentioned in Budget including the expenditure on maintenance till
harvesting begins;
(xxv) Check the expenditure incurred on plantation/ re-plantation on the basis of such record with
reference to the Estate’s Accounts to compare between budget and actual expenditure;
(xxvi) Analyze the total cost per hectare for plantation/ re-plantation including expenditure on
maintenance in respect of individual section/ field and compare per Hectare Cost among
different sections/ field Nos.;
(xxvii)Examine that the Estate has complied with all necessary formalities for availing incentives
from Tea Board/ Rubber Board for extension plantation/ re-plantation;
(xxviii) Carry out year-wise Yield Analysis for sections/ fields which have come into bearing in last
5 to 7 years for comparison of yield among different sections and comparison of yields of the
same sections among the successive years;
(xxix) Compare the yields of those sections with average yield of the estate.

(f) Production and other records:


I. Weighing of Raw Materials at Field:
(a) Green Tea Leaves:
(i) Green leaf produced per hectare in respect of various sections of the estate, for the current
year are to be compared with the previous years and variance analyzed;
(ii) Whether green leaf production as per weighment records is properly authorized and are to be
compared with the quantum of leaves as per the “Crop Book”, the factory “Green leaf
weighment register” and the “Excise records”;
(iii) The quantum of manure, pesticide and weedicide issued per hectare is to be compared with
the previous years and variance analyzed;
(iv) The various categories of labour hours utilized per hectare for manuring, applying pesticide,
weeding, ground preparation etc. are to be compared with the previous year;
(v) Check how many times i.e. sessions, green leaves collected are weighed in the field;
(vi) Whether Green Leaves plucked are weighed at the field itself or brought to factory for
weighing;
(vii) Check the system of weighing Green Leaves – whether green leaves plucked by individual
pluckers are recorded manually in a register or the weight is recorded through computerized
logger where individual pluckers swipe the magnetic cards given to them;
(viii) In case of weighing of green leaves at the field, it should be checked whether it is carried out
under the supervision of any managerial staff or any other senior supervisory staff;
(ix) In case of recording the weight of green leaves manually in the green leaf register, it should be
checked how the deduction of tare weight i.e. the weight of green leaf in the basket or nylon
bag is made from the gross weight;
(x) In case of manual recording the weights of Green Leaf, it should be checked whether the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 85


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
weights of green leaf plucked by each worker in each session recorded separately ;
(xi) Separate recording is required to keep a check on the chances of manipulation and also to
keep a track of attendance of each worker in each session;
(xii) In case of weighing green leaf through computerized logger, the process of adjustment for
tare weight should be checked – it should be reviewed that whether any responsible
management staff is authorized for adjustment of the logger for deduction of tare weight and
it should also be checked whether there is any Pass-ward protection for such adjustment in
order to ward off any subsequent unauthorized adjustment;
(xiii) Internal Auditor should carry out surprise check while the process of weighing green leaves
is in progress at the field;
(xiv) Check how many number of sessions i.e. twice or thrice, green leaves are weighed in a day;
(xv) Whether any Slip indicating the total weight of green leaves collected in a session at each
point of weighing is prepared for sending the green leaves from field to factory;
(xvi) Whether the Estate has system of preparing Green Leaf Challan accompanying each vehicle
coming to factory from the field;
(xvii) Check whether there is any system of weighing green leaf at factory at the time of receiving
from the field;
(xviii) If the Green Leaf is weighed at factory, the weight according to green leaf slip prepared at
field is required to be compared with the weight of green leaf recorded in course of weighing
at factory;
(xix) Comparison should be made between the total of the quantity of green leaves as mentioned
in the Pay Sheet against individual pluckers and weight of green leaf plucked and paid by Cash
i.e. extra plucking and the total quantity of green leaves recorded in the green leaf register.
Discrepancy, if any found, should be analyzed and reported;
(xx) Whether the quantity of green leaf is recorded in the Raw Material Register maintained at the
factory for the purpose of Excise, on the basis of the weighing done at the factory or on the
basis of weighing done at the field;
(xxi) Whether there is a system of inspecting the Fine Leaf Count of the green leaf plucked by each
plucker every day and whether there is any system of recording the same;
(xxii) Whether the payment of incentives for additional quantity plucked above the standard task
fixed is linked to fine leaf count.
(b) Coffee Seeds:
i) Whether Coffee Seeds picked are weighed at the field itself or brought to factory for weighing;
ii) Check the system of weighing Coffee Seeds – whether Coffee Seeds picked by individual workers
are recorded manually in the Register or the weight is recorded through computerized Logger
where individual workers swipes magnetic cards given to them;
iii) Where Coffee Seeds picked are weighed at the field itself, it should be checked whether it is
carried out under the supervision of any Management Staff or any senior supervisory staff;
iv) In case of recording the weight of Coffee Seeds manually in the Register in respect of individual
workers, the process of deduction of tare weight from the gross weight should be checked;
v) In case of weighing Coffee Seeds through Computerized Logger, the process of adjustment of
tare weight should be checked;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 86


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
vi) Internal Audit should carry out surprise check while the process of weighing the Coffee Seeds
peaking is in progress in the field;
vii) Whether any Slip indicating total Coffee Seeds collected at the field is prepared for sending the
Coffee Seeds from field to Pulp house;
viii) Whether there is any system of weighing Coffee Seeds at Pulp house at the time of receiving
from the field;
ix) If there is a system of weighing Coffee Seeds at Pulp house, the weight of Coffee Seeds as per
the Slip prepared at the field and the weight of Coffee Seeds recorded at factory should be
compared and reasons for variation, if any, should be analyzed;
x) Comparison should be made between total quantity of Coffee Seeds, as mentioned in the Pay
Sheet against individual workers and the weight of the Coffee Seeds as per Slips prepared at the
field vis-à-vis weight recorded at the Pulp house. Discrepancy, if any, found should be reported.

(c) Field Latex:


(i) Whether Field Latex is weighed at the field itself or brought to factory for weighing;
(ii) Check the system of weighing Field Latex at the field – whether Field Latex collected by
individual Tappers are recorded manually in the register or through Computerized Logger
where individual Tappers swipes magnetic cards given to them;
(iii) Whether weighing Field Latex at the field is carried out under the supervision of any
managerial staff or any other senior supervisory staff; the system of collection of samples
from the Field Latex collected by individual Tappers to compute the Dry Rubber Content
(DRC) percentage and system of keeping the record thereof;
(iv) In case of weighing Field Latex through Computerized Logger, the process of adjustment of
tare weight should be checked;
(v) Internal Auditor should carry out surprise check while the process of weighing Field Latex is
in progress at the field;
(vi) Compare the weight of Field Latex recorded in the register maintained at field with the
corresponding weight recorded at factory;
(vii) Check the process of collection of sample of daily receipt of Field Latex at the factory for
computation of DRC percentage and to review the system of keeping record thereof.
II. Yield Record Vis-a-Vis Examination of Vacancy Percentage:
(i) Whether the sections/ field No. wise yield records are maintained in respect of every year;
(ii) Examine the yield trend of the Estate as a whole vis-à-vis individual Section/ Field Nos. for a
span of 10 to 15 years’ period;
(iii) Compare the current year’s yield with past years;
(iv) Identify the perennially low yielding sections as compared to overall yield of the garden;
(v) Carry out analysis of section-wise pruning style-wise yield record ( in case of Tea) and to
report on sections which are constantly low yielding sections irrespective of pruning style;
(vi) Carry out study of sectional yield records with reference to the corresponding age of the
sections or field No. and to report on sections where yield is lower than the Estate’s average
in spite of their younger age;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 87


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(vii) Compare the Estate’s average yield with the average yield of the Circle/ District/ Region to
which the Estate belong;
(viii) Whether section/ field No. wise vacancy record is maintained;
(ix) Examine the section/ field no.-wise vacancy percentage with reference to the corresponding
yield of the sections/ field;
(x) Examine whether the vacancy has any bearing on the yield;
(xi) Report specifically where comparatively young sections/ fields have higher vacancy
percentage than the garden average vacancy percentage and having yield lower than the
yield of older section/ fields;
(xii) Review the actions taken for reduction of the vacancy – infilling programme and actual
implementation to such infilling programme;
(xiii) Review the action Plan of the Estate Management for improvement of yield and to report on
the actions taken by the Estate Management with reference to Plan of action;

(g) Upkeep, repairs and maintenance:


(a) Upkeep of nursery:
(i) Annual and contingent plans and corresponding instructions (with subsequent modifications
if any) are to be looked into.
(ii) Material issued from the stores like manure, polythene sheets, bamboo etc. are to be as per
requisition and in accordance with written authorization.
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register.
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized.
(v) Review the budget for requirement of plants in next 3 years for planting and infilling;
(vi) Examine the Estate’s plan for meeting the future requirement of plants – whether through
purchase of plants from external nursery or exclusively from own nursery or partially from
external sources and partially from own nursery;
(vii) Examine the Estate’s plan for raising the nursery with reference to its budgeted consumption
of plants;
(viii) In case of Tea plantation, to check whether the Estate has also the plan for Shade Nursery –
whether the Estate’s requirement of shade plants are planned to meet from the Estate’s own
Shade Plant Nursery;
(ix) Check the Estate’s plan for the type of nursery to be raised – whether fully clone or fully
seedlings or partially clone and partially seedling;
(x) Examine the budget for nursery expenditure – whether all materials ( both in terms of
physical quantity and cost) and labour cost ( in terms of man-days and corresponding wage
cost ) are estimated;
(xi) Whether the cost of man-days required for maintenance of the nursery till the plants become
mature for planting is also included in the budget;
(xii) Whether the budget has been framed in detail on the basis of standard consumption of item
of expenses i.e. different materials and labour required at different operations for raising the
nursery and its maintenance;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 88


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(xiii) Whether separate budget is prepared for each block of nursery depending on the years of
maturity of the plants for planting;
(xiv) Examine that in each budget, year of commencement, size of the nursery beds, number of
plants planned to be raised are clearly mentioned;
(xv) Compare the budgeted cost per plant with the prevailing market price for outright purchase
of plants;
(xvi) Check whether the Estate maintains separate register both in respect of Plant Nursery and
Shade Plant Nursery ( in case of Tea and Coffee Plantation ) wherein the following details are
maintained:
a) Year of Commencement of the nursery;
b) Projected year of plantation;
c) Bed Number;
d) Bed size;
e) Variety of seeds ( in case of seedling nursery ) used/ clones (in case of clonal nursery)
raised;
f) Total weight of seeds purchased / used and approximate total number of seeds set in
polythene sleeves – for seedling nursery;
g) For clonal nursery – No. of cuttings set into rooting beds;
h) No. of rooted cuttings transferred to soil filled polythene sleeves or the number of
cuttings put into soil filled polythene sleeves;
i) No. of matured plants reared as per physical count of plants carried out before
commencement of planting / infilling;
j) Date-wise utilization of number of plants in different sections or Field Nos.;
k) Physical balance available at the end of the year or after plantation is complete;
(xvii)Check whether separate records of expenses incurred in respect of each nursery are
maintained;
(xviii) To check that all expenses incurred on inputs required for rearing the nursery, fertilizers and
insecticides used for the nursery and the man-days utilized for different operations pertaining
to the nursery are recorded in the Cost records chronologically indicating physical quantity
utilized and the corresponding expenditure;
(xix) Check that all input materials like Bamboo, Polythene sleeves/ polythene bags, Thatch, etc.
and other materials like chemicals/ fertilizers issued from Stores are issued through proper
issue requisition slips and that the respective nursery where those will be utilized are also
mentioned in the Requisition;
(xx) Check that all man-days deployed for the preparation and maintenance/ upkeep of nursery
are properly documented in the daily man-days deployment record and the corresponding
figures are also recorded in the Nursery Register;
(xxi) Check that all expenses incurred in respect of nursery are booked in a separate Account
Head in the Estate Accounts on the basis of actual quantity of material and man-days used;
(xxii) Check that the cost of inputs and labour cost recorded in the Nursery Register are
periodically reconciled with the accounting records;
(xxiii) Whether the physical count of plants are carried out in the nursery periodically before
commencement of planting/ infilling and that a final physical verification is also carried out at

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 89


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
the end of financial year for each nursery;
(xxiv) Whether every periodical verification of plants in the nursery are authenticated by the
managerial personnel of the Estate;
(xxv) Compare the actual utilization of inputs and man-days with the budgeted quantities of the
respective materials and man-days required for nursery operation;
(xxvi) Cross-check the physical utilization of number of polythene sleeves or bags consumed (to
be computed on the basis of standard quantity of sleeves available per Kg. of the polythene
sleeves / bags of the respective gauge consumed) with the total number of seedlings or
number of clones set in polythene sleeves/ bags as recorded in the Nursery Register.
(xxvii) Examine the computation of cost per plant on the basis of the nursery cost records;
(xxviii)Examine the computation of survival or success percentage on the basis of results of
physical verification;
(xxix) Examine whether such survival or success percentage remains within the normal limit;
(xxx) Compare the survival or success percentage of nursery in respect of different years;
(xxxi) Whether the cost per plant is computed on the basis of actual number of plants survived
i.e. on the basis of cumulative figure of the total number of plants utilized and the number of
plants physically available in the nursery at the end of the year;
(xxxii) Check the utilization of plants and shade plants ( in case of Tea & Coffee plantation only ) as
recorded in the nursery register with the Estate’s periodical report on plantation and infilling;
(xxxiii)Whether the nursery reconciliation statement prepared by the Estate indicating the
following information:
a) No. of plants/seeds rooted in the Polythene Sleeves;
b) No. of good plants available for planting as per physical verification carried out before
commencement of planting;
c) No. of plants utilized for planting / infilling;
d) No. of plants available physically at the end of the year;
e) No. of plants damaged in course of planting
(xxxiv) Check the percentage of damage of plants over the total number of good plants available,
whether such percentage is within normal limit;
(xxxv) Examine the method of charging the nursery expenditure in the Accounts – it should be
ensured that the expenditure of nursery is not charged to the Revenue Expenditure until
the plants are utilized in planting/ infilling and proper charging in the Accounts shall be
made on the basis of actual utilization of Plants reared for the purpose of planting/ infilling
of the respective areas;
(xxxvi)Whether the cost of abnormal damage in course of planting are charged separately in the
Accounts and cost of plants are computed considering the cost of damaged plants within the
normal limit;
(xxxvii)Examine the method of valuation of closing stock of plants.
(h) Upkeep of roads, culverts and bridges:
(i) Annual and contingent plans and corresponding instructions (with subsequent modifications
if any) are to be looked into;
(ii) Material issued from the stores as per requisition is to be in accordance with written
authorization;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 90


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Where external agencies are engaged, their engagement (terms and conditions) are to be
authorized by the Management and payment is to be as per the Management approval;
(v) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized.

(i) Upkeep of the labour hutments, potable water supply and sanitation facility:
(i) Annual and contingent plans and corresponding instructions (with subsequent modifications
if any) are to be looked into;
(ii) Material issued from the stores as per requisition is to be in accordance with written
authorization;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register;
(iv) Where external agencies are engaged, their engagement (terms and conditions) is to be
authorized by the Management and payment is as per the Management approval;
(v) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized.
(j) Upkeep of tools and implements:
(i) Annual and contingent plans and corresponding instructions (with subsequent modifications
if any) are to be looked into;
(ii) Material issued from stores like machine oil, grease etc. is to be as per the bill of material for
routine repairs & maintenance and should have been authorized in other cases;
(iii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity;
(iv) Where external agencies are engaged, their engagement (terms and conditions) is authorized
by the Management and payment is as per the Management approval;
(vi) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized.

(k) CTC Roller Sharpening in Tea Estates:


In Tea Estates, a substantial expenditure is incurred on sharpening of CTC rollers as the pairs of
CTC Rollers are regularly replaced for sharpening. Unless the garden has their own full-fledged
infrastructure of machine shop for sharpening, the full job of sharpening of CTC Rollers are mostly
done through outside workshops. For movement of CTC rollers as well as passing of the
workshop’s bills for payment, the following points should be looked into in course of Internal
Audit:
(i) Whether the garden maintains a CTC Sharpening Register (Roller pair-wise and segment
wise) – in other words, whether separate pages are earmarked in the register for each set
of segments and pair of roller in respect of sharpening of CTC Rollers from outside
workshop;
(ii) Whether separate pre-printed challan book is used in respect of movement of the CTC
Rollers for sharpening through outside workshop;
(iii) Whether on the face of the book copy of the Gate Pass or the Challan used for movement
of CTC Segments, the date of receipt are recorded;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 91


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iv) Whether the satisfactory completion of sharpening or repair of CTC Segments are
certified by a responsible executive of the Estate;
(v) Check the bills for CTC sharpening are correlated with the respective challan/gate pass
used for movement of CTC for sharpening and also with the entries in CTC Sharpening
Register before the bills are passed for payment. It should also be checked that the person
certifying completion of job and the person authorizing for bills for payment are not the
same person;
(vi) Whether the bill nos. are recorded against the respective entries in the CTC Sharpening
Register after the bills are passed for payment.
(l) Maintenance of drainage system etc.:
(i) Whether the Estate has the system of drawing the programme for upkeep and development
of its drainage system in the lean/ Dry season;
(ii) Review the implementation of the drainage programme;
(iii) Check the records maintained for measurement of actual work done in respect of the
drainage programme (Section/ Field No -wise, date) with reference to the actual man-days
deployed as per deployment record vis-à-vis task fixed for different types of drains;
(iv) Whether the Estate’s drainage system are periodically (i.e. once in 2 years or 3 years) are
examined by the TRA experts;
(v) Whether the updated land drainage map are available at the garden;
(vi) Labour and implements issued for maintenance of drainage are to be compared with the
requirement of such activities as per the garden inspection report and written instructions.

(m) Vehicle Log Book:


In the plantation industry use of vehicle(primarily tractor with carrier) for movement of pump,
generator, manure, weedicide, green leaves plucked, Coffee seed, latex and for various other
activities is used.
(i) Whether the Log Books are properly and regularly maintained in respect of each of the
vehicles used by the Estate containing the following information:
(a) Date;
(b) Destination or nature of job done(for tractors, Trucks);
(c) KM run for each destination/ job in case of all vehicles other than tractor (opening &
closing Milo-Meter reading to be recorded) or hour run in case of Tractors (starting time &
closing time to be recorded );
(d) Fuel issued;
(e) Signature of the user.

(ii) Whether the Milo-Meters of the vehicles (Hour- Meter in respect of the Tractors) in respect
of each of the vehicle is operational;
(iii) Check the quantity of fuel issued as shown in the Log Book with the corresponding issue
records of the Stores;
(iv) Whether the fuel consumption report is prepared for each month containing the following
information:
(a) Name of the vehicle;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 92


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(b) KM/ Hour run during the month;
(c) Fuel consumed;
(d) KM/ Hour run per Litre;
(v) Comparison of yearly fuel consumption figures (in terms of KM/ hour run per Ltr) in respect
of each vehicle for a period of 3 /4 years.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 93


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 17 Audit of Special Areas with reference to peculiar transactions

A. DEPLOYMENT:
As the Plantation Industry is highly labour intensive, wages and other allied costs pertaining to
labour accounts for anywhere between 55% and 60% of the total cost of operation. Besides this,
the Plantation Industry is governed by a number of labour related legislations and is under the
surveillance of intense Government inspection also. Therefore, planning & utilization of labour in
plantation industry warrants a hardcore management for optimization of cost of operation which
in turn requires the existence of a strong internal control system for the issues relating to
manpower deployment. Therefore, while carrying out internal audit in Plantation Industry, due
importance has to be given to the labour related areas.
I. Daily Deployment Planning:
 Whether the Estate plans for deployment for the next day in all operations classified into
the following categories:
i) Field operations;
ii) Factory operations;
iii) Establishment including different types of repair/maintenance, hospital &
sanitation, transport and other miscellaneous areas;
 Review the format used for planning - whether it is drawn to plan deployment of both
permanent and casual daily rated workers in various field as well as non-field operations
in detail on daily basis;

 Whether the list of operations included in the daily planning is exhaustive i.e. no
operation is left out from the list;

 Whether the Estate is first planning deployment of its permanent strength in all the
operations and thereafter planning the deployment of casual workers in each operation to
meet the shortfall, if any, so as to match the manpower required to carry out the planned
operations for the day;

 Whether before estimating the manpower requirement for deployment planning both for
permanent and casual man-days, the Estate has quantified total job content (may be in
terms of area or any other physical measure, as applicable) in respect of each of section
No. / field Nos. where the specific field operations are planned to be carried out and such
section No. / field Nos. are mentioned in the deployment plan;

 Whether different operations planned to be carried out in different sections /field has
been quantified with reference to individual section no/ field no;

 Whether the Estate has fixed any standard task per man-day for each field operation
either in terms of area to be covered or in terms of quantum of work to be done; for
example, for Pruning operation, task may be fixed on the basis of number of bushes to be
pruned by each worker in a day depending upon the type of pruning i.e. MP (Medium

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 94


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Pruning), LP (Light Pruning), DS (Deep Skiff) etc.; for spraying of herbicides/ insecticides,
task may be fixed on the basis of number of drums; for manual weeding, task may be fixed
per man-day on the basis of area etc.;

 For spraying, it should be checked whether separate task has been fixed for blanket
spraying and spot spraying;

 To check while planning for deployment in different field operations the standard task
fixed for each such operations are applied on the quantum of job estimated in respect of
each individual cultivation and manufacturing operation for manpower deployment
planning;

 Whether the records for daily deployment planning are kept as permanent record for the
purpose of future reference.

II. Actual Deployment:


 Check the system of recording daily deployment of the workers in different operations –
whether it is recorded by the supervisory staff manually in a rough book at the time of
recording attendance or it is recorded separately from the Attendance Record after actual
allocation of the workers among different operations;

 Review the system of recording daily deployment of workers where attendance is


recorded through a computerized system i.e. through swiping the ID Cards of the
individual workers or through a biometric system– whether deployment in different
operations i.e. Cost Centers are recorded at the time of attendance recording or it is
recorded manually following the same system as mentioned previously;

 Check the system of maintenance of final deployment record whether through


computerized system or manually;

 In case of recording deployment of workers by the supervisory staff manually, then check
the system of recording data of deployment from the rough book to the final record;

 Review the process of reconciliation between the rough book and the final record of
deployment –whether the reconciliation is done daily/ weekly or monthly (the most
preferred system is daily reconciliation);

 In case the initial recording of daily deployment is done through a computerized system,
the program used for the system should be checked and the process of uploading the data
from initial record to final record should also be examined;

 Whether the total number of workers, as per the final daily deployment record, is
reconciled with the daily attendance record maintained for the purpose of calculation of
wages;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 95


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check that the system used for recording deployment of workers allows for identification
and quantification of the following three individual categories of workers deployed in
different operations/ cost centers:
(i) Permanent;
(ii) Casual paid through Wages Book;
(iii) Casual workers paid directly through Cash Vouchers.

 To verify the deployment records with reference to the attendance record, different
agricultural input application register and other cultivation records;
 Study the actual pattern of deployment of labour– both permanent and casual in different
cultivation operations, manufacturing, plucking/ tapping/ picking, stripping & gleaning of
Coffee Seeds and other operations including establishments. The study should be carried
out with the periodicity of monthly/ quarterly and yearly - both in terms of absolute
numbers and percentage component of deployment in each operation as well as the
percentage of deployment under main group heads with reference to the total manpower
deployed;
 Compare the deployment figures under audit with the respective figures of deployment
for the previous 3 /4 years both in terms of absolute numbers as well as in terms of
percentage component. In course of this comparison, the base may be taken any of the
suitable parameters as denominator like the total area under cultivation, total yield of
crop or simple absolute numbers depending on the type of operations/ area of
deployment;
 Whether actual manpower deployed in each operation is compared daily with the
manpower planned and reason for variation, if any, between the two are analyzed for
fixing the base of planning for next day;
 Review the deployment (both in terms of absolute number and percentage component of
the total deployment) in different non-productive/ indirect cost centers like Fencing,
Cleaning Jungle around the field, Chowkidar or Field Guards, Water Carriers to the field,
Cleaning factory, Repairs & Maintenance of Building/ Machinery/Vehicles, Roads &
bridges, Transport, Labour Welfare, Hospital & Sanitation and Establishment;
 Compare the deployment figures of the non-productive operations/ indirect cost centers
with deployment figures of the respective areas for the previous 2 / 3 years in order to
check the trend of deployment in these operations and also to review the reasons for
variation, if any;
 Whether regular reconciliations are carried out between the total wages as per final
deployment book and the wages as per monthly Accounts;
 Check the deployment of casual workers paid through Cash Vouchers – whether proper
record is maintained for such deployment and whether such deployment is pre-approved
by the Manager of the Estate;
 Check the deployment of such workers with reference to different agricultural input
register and other cultivation records;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 96


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(a) Tea - Plucking Activity:
(i) Whether the requirement of plucking of different types based on annual and contingent
plans and written instructions.
(ii) Whether optimum number of labour are engaged and whether payment made is
commensurate with the actual labour employed for the activity as per “Kamzari” register.
(iii) Where payment is not made on the basis of time (hours/days) but on the basis of quantity of
leaves plucked (as per the green-leaf weighment register), then the report at the factory on
the quantity and quality of leaves received from individual labour needs to compared with
the amount paid.
(iv) Report by the authorized person on actual performance of the work is to be scrutinized.
(v) Check the number of rounds plucked and days of round in different periods of the season and
make a comparative analysis of figures for consecutive 2 –3 years including the year under
audit in respect of total number of rounds plucked and average days of round for the year as a
whole;
(vi) Examine the percentage of plucking man-days over the total man-days deployed for the full
season and make a comparative analysis in respect of deployment figures for plucking for
consecutive 2 – 3 years with reference to the respective total quantity of green leaf
harvested,
(vii) Make a year to year comparison in respect of average number of pluckers per hectare plucked
and examine the pluckers’ productivity – overall productivity, productivity of permanent and
casual workers separately – comparative analysis of figures for 2 – 3 years;
(viii) Carry out a comparative analysis for the percentage component of permanent and casual
workers in the total plucking man-days for consecutive 2 – 3 years and their impact on
average pluckers productivity;
(ix) Compare the overall pluckers’ productivity for 2 – 3 years consecutive years with reference
to land productivity of the respective years;
(x) Check the minimum task fixed for different periods/ months in the season and examine
whether fixation of task for plucking is guided by any Wage Agreement or it is fixed by the
Estate Management;
(xi) Compare the fixed task with the average pluckers’ productivity of the respective months of
the season – whether the task fixed was lenient;
(xii) Whether there is any system of monitoring individual pluckers’ productivity and if any action
is taken in respect of the workers whose productivity is consistently below par.
(xiii) Examine the rate of incentives paid to the Pluckers for plucking above the minimum task fixed
.Whether the rate of incentives is fixed according to any industry-wise agreement or it is fixed
by the Estate Management according to their own scheme;
(xiv) Where the incentive is fixed by the Estate management at a rate higher than the rate fixed
through industry-wise agreement , to check that this has the approval of the corporate

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 97


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
management;
(xv) Examine the impact of incentive on Wage Cost of plucking per Kg. of green leaf where the
incentive is paid according to the Estate’s own scheme as compared to the rate of incentive as
fixed by industry-wise agreement; (should be under HR or incentive scheme)
(b) Coffee - Picking of Coffee Seeds:
(i) Check the average number of workers deployed in picking coffee seeds per hectare –
comparison among different months of the season and also comparison among yearly figures
for consecutive 2 – 3 years;
(ii) Examine the percentage of picking man-days over the total man-days – comparison among
monthly figures for different months of the season and also the yearly figures of the year
under audit with that of previous 2 – 3 years;
(iii) Check the percentage component of man-days of permanent workers and casual workers
respectively of the total man-days deployed in picking – comparison among figures for
different months of the season as well as among yearly figures of the year under audit and of
the previous 2 – 3 years;
(iv) Check the computation of average productivity (in terms of weight of Coffee seeds picked per
man-day).
(v) Examine the comparative figures of productivity of labour deployed in picking for
consecutive 2 – 3 years including the year under audit – overall productivity, productivity of
permanent and casual workers separately;
(vi) Compare the figures of overall labour productivity with reference to land productivity of the
respective years for consecutive 2 – 3 years;

(c) Rubber - Tapping Activity:


(i) Check the daily minimum task fixed for tapping i.e. the number of trees to be tapped per day
and examine whether the minimum task fixed by the Estate is at par with the industry-wise
agreement with the workers’ union or otherwise. If minimum task fixed is lower than the
industry norm, to check whether the approval from the Corporate is available;
(ii) Examine the average number of trees tapped per Tapper per day for different individual
months of the season and for the total season as well and to compare the average figure
with the minimum task;
(iii) Examine the average productivity of tappers per month (i.e. weight of field latex in terms of
DRC, tapped per tapper) up to the month of September;
(iv) Compare the figures of productivity among different months and also with the respective
months of previous 2 – 3 years;
(v) Carry out the comparison of overall labour productivity with reference to the land
productivity of the respective years for consecutive 2 – 3 years including the year under
audit;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 98


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(vi) Whether there is any system of monitoring the productivity of individual tappers and
examine the action taken in respect of tappers whose productivity are consistently below
par;
(vii) Check the rate of incentives paid to the Tappers and whether such rate is at par with the
industry-wise agreement. In case the rate of incentive fixed by the Estate Management is
higher than the rate fixed for the industry as a whole then to examine the approval of
Corporate Management;
(viii) Examine the impact of incentive on wage cost of tapping per Kg of field latex (in terms of
DRC) where incentive is paid according to estate’s own scheme as compared to the rate of
incentive fixed through industry-wise agreement.
B. Purchase of Raw-materials:
Under the present circumstances due to all-round cost escalation in different manufacturing
processes, labour cost in particular, break-even point is attainable at a much higher production
level than it was previously. As a result, most of the manufacturers make an effort to increase
their production capacity by processing raw-materials e.g. green tea leaves, field latex, etc.
sourced from external producers in addition to processing of raw-materials cultivated in their own
estate. Therefore, it is imperative to have a strong internal control over the whole process of
procurement of raw-materials including fixation of price, quality control, receipt of actual quantity
of green leaf in the factory, etc. In order to exercise such internal control, following points are
required to be covered by Internal Auditor:
(a) Green Leaf:
 Review the method of selection of sources of supply – whether local small growers of green
leaves are tapped for selection of sources or local market (i.e. Mundis) are explored for
sourcing green leaf as and when requirement arises;
 Where local small growers are selected as sources of green leaf, it should be checked
whether a long term rate contract with an assured quantity of green leaf to be purchased is
made or the Purchase Price varies depending upon the demand and supply in the local
market;
 Whether it is a rate contract or contract with variable price, the method of fixation of price
should be examined to check that how it is co-related with the prevailing market price;
 Whether regular feedback on trend of prices of green leaves is obtained from the local
market and record is maintained for that;
 In case of open market purchase from the local market, i.e. Mundis, the method of
purchase should be examined to ensure that purchases are made at the best price and price
paid is linked to Fine Leaf Count of the consignment;
 In case of fixed price contract , it should be examined that overall price paid over the full
season does not exceed the prevailing market price;
 Check the system of weighment of Bought Leaf – whether the Estate has its own
weighment system where every consignment is weighed and recorded. Where the factory
of the Estate has not its own Weigh Bridge, it should be checked how weighment is done

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 99


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
for each consignment – whether it is done in nearby Weigh Bridge or the Suppliers’ certify
the weight;
 When the supplier certifies the weight, it should be checked how such weight is certified by
the supplier is verified as to its correctness;
 Check the method of deduction of Tare Weight i.e. both weight of the vehicle and weights
of the bags containing the green leaves from Gross Weight to arrive at the Net Weight of
the consignment;
 Verify that weighing of purchased Green Leaves is carried out in presence of Managerial
personnel of the estate;
 Check the methods of recording the weights of consignments of purchased green leaves
received – whether permanent record in the form of a Register is maintained containing
following information:
(i) Name of the Supplier;
(ii) Challan No. & Date;
(iii) ‘In’ & ‘Out’ time of the vehicle;
(iv) Vehicle No. carrying the Green Leaf;
(v) Gross Weight;
(vi) Tare Weight;
(vii) Net Weight;
(viii) Fine Leaf Count
 Whether each entry in the register is verified and authenticated by Managerial personnel
of the estate;
 Examine the Register to cross-check the entries therein with the Raw Material Register
maintained in the factory for the purpose of Excise records and also with the Log Book
maintained for Withering Trough;
 Whether there is a system of keeping record for ‘Exit’ & ‘Entry’ of the vehicles carrying of
Bought Leaf at the gate of the factory and examine the Gate Entry Register with the Register
maintained for recording the weights of the consignments of purchased green leaf.
(b) Field Latex:
There are a number of rubber estates who purchase either Field Latex or Single Centrifuged Latex
to convert the same into Double Centrifuged Latex i.e. Cenex to increase both the utilization of
their production capacity and the profitability. In order to exert control over these purchases of
raw-material, the following points need to be taken care of in course of Internal Audit:

 Review the system of selection of local growers from whom the Field Latex or Single
Centrifuged Latex is purchased and examine the method of fixation of Price – whether it is
a rate contract for a particular period or linked to prevailing Market Price;
 Where local small growers are selected as source of Field Latex, it should be checked
whether a long-term rate contract with an assured quantity of Field Latex to be purchased
is made or the purchase price is fixed depending upon the demand and supply situation in
the local market;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 100


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 The contracts with the suppliers are required to be checked to ensure that the price
contracted to be paid to the suppliers is paid for the Dry Rubber Content (DRC) of the gross
quantity received;
 Check that the records maintained relating to receipt of consignments contain the following
information:
a) Date of receipt;
b) Name of the supplier;
c) Challan No.;
d) Gross Quantity and Net Quantity of receipts for each consignment;
e) DRC percentage;
f) Quantity of DRC;
 Whether separate Registers are maintained for receipt of Field Latex and Single
Centrifuged Latex and check the system followed for weighing the receipt of consignments
of the Latex;
 Whether the consignment-wise DRC percentage is tested at the Estate’s Laboratory and the
same is properly recorded both in Laboratory and the register maintained for receipt of
consignments;
 Examine the registers for receipt of the consignments of purchased Latex with reference to
the Laboratory record and check that each entry in the above registers are regularly
vouched and signed by the Estate’s Managerial personnel;
 Examine the records pertaining to the consignment-wise measurement of DRC percentage
maintained at the Factory;
 Verify the bills raised by the suppliers with reference to the registers maintained for receipt
of consignments.

Slaughter Tapping:
When the economic life of any Rubber Tree in a specific field no. ends, Slaughter Tapping is
resorted to extract Latex to the extent possible from those trees. Thereafter these rubber trees
are felled and sold as timber. Generally, Slaughter Tapping activity is outsourced to the
contractors who pay fixed price for the rubber trees handed over to them for Slaughter Tapping.
In turn, the Latex extracted from those trees is bought back by the Estate at a price fixed for the
Field Latex. For applying internal control, the following issues should be given special attention:

 Examine system followed for selection of the contractor and fixation of price to be paid by
the contractor – whether it is fixed through open bidding system or through negotiation
with the contractor;
 Whether system followed by the company ensures realization of best price for handing
over the trees for Slaughter Tapping;
 Examine the relevant contracts regarding terms for payment of sale proceeds by the
contractors;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 101


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the terms of payments are complied with by the contractors ,whether the sale
proceeds are realized from the contractors before commencement of the Slaughter
Tapping;
 To examine the process of fixation of price for buy-back of field latex collected through
Slaughter Tapping – whether it is a fixed price or prices are linked to the prevailing market
price for purchase of field latex. In case of fixed price, it should be examined that overall
price paid does not exceed the prevailing market price;
 Whether the proper records are maintained for receipt of field latex through Slaughter
Tapping from the contractors (in the same line as in the case of purchase of Field Latex);
 Examine the records maintained at Laboratory for measurement of DRC percentage of daily
receipt of field latex through Slaughter Tapping;
 Verify the payments made to the Contractors for field latex with reference to the records
maintained for receipts of daily consignments of field latex through Slaughter Tapping as
well as with the relevant Laboratory records for DRC percentage.

C. Production:
(a) Tea manufacturing:
Tea:
 Whether the Green Leaves received from field are again independently weighed in the
factory or the field weight is taken as weight of raw material;
 Check the system of weighing green leaves at Factory – whether there is a Weigh Bridge or
green leaves are weighed batch by batch in the Weighing Scale;
 Check the records kept at factory in respect of weights of green leaves taken, compare the
weight of green leaves as per field records with the corresponding weight as per factory
records;
 whether the weights of green leaves are recorded daily in the raw material register on the
basis of field weighment or on the basis of factory weighment;
 Examine the system of weighing Black Tea at the Drier Mouth Register – whether manually
or through Batch Weighing Machine;
 Where the weight of finished product i.e. Black Tea is measured at the Drier Mouth through
Batch Weighing Machine, following points are required to be examined:
a) Whether Drier Mouth weighing is done after screening of bolder particles of Black Tea
in the Pre-sorter or weighing is done including the bolder particles which are
subsequently screened in the pre-sorter for reprocessing;
b) The system of preserving the data of weights recorded in the Batch Weighing Machine
– whether any print of the weights recorded is possible to be taken or the weight is
recorded in the Drier Mouth Register only viewing the weights at the Monitor of the
Computer;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 102


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
c) Where print is taken, the print of the weights recorded are possible to be taken only
at the completion of manufacturing for the day or any interim print is possible to be
taken;
 Where the weight of Black Tea is measured at the Drier Mouth manually, the following
points are required to be checked:
a) Whether any permanent record in the form of register is maintained for recording (i.e.
Rough Drier Mouth Register ) for recording each actual weighment;
b) Whether the tare weight of the container used for collecting and weighing is
deducted from the gross weight using the actual weight of the containers or a
standard weight is taken for such deduction;
c) Comparison between the standard weight and actual weight of the containers used;
d) Whether Drier Mouth weighing is done after screening of bolder particles of Black Tea
in the Pre-sorter or weighing is done including the bolder particles which are
subsequently screened in the pre-sorter for reprocessing;
 Compare the final entries in the Drier Mouth Register with the data of reading recorded in
Batch Weighing Machine or with the noting in Rough Drier Mouth Register (in case of
manual weighing);
 Examine the system of keeping records of weights of bolder grades of Black Tea pre-sorted
at Drier Mouth for further processing – whether actual weight is recorded or estimated
weight is kept;
 Examine the system of reprocessing the bolder grades after screening in the pre-sorter
and breaking in the Ball Breaker - whether those black tea are reprocessed mixing with
green leaves in Rotorvane or those are reprocessed exclusively;
 Where the weight at the drier mouth is recorded after screening of the extra bolder
grades, it needs to be ensured that the weight of such tea after reprocessing is included in
the final weight of the tea manufactured;
 Where the weight at the Drier Mouth is recorded before the bolder tea particles are
screened for reprocessing, it is required to be ensured that the weight of reprocessed
Black Tea is not again included in the final weight of Tea manufactured;
 Whether Log Book is maintained for recording daily total factory running hours containing
the following information:
a) Time of starting and finishing the processing of green leaves at the factory;
b) In case of any interruption/ stoppage of running of the factory, period of
interruption/ stoppage; and
c) Reasons for interruption in running of the factory;
 Whether separate Log Books are maintained for the following individual production
centers:
a) Withering Trough;
b) Rolling Room – both for Orthodox manufacturing and CTC manufacturing;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 103


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
c) Fermenting;
d) Drying;
e) Sorting
f) In case of green tea manufacturing for Roaster, Roller Boiler and Drier;
 Whether such Log Books contain the following information:
(a) For Withering Trough – Date, Trough No., Time of first charging of green leaves and
time of taking out the last batch of weathered green leaf, total quantity of green
leaves charged for withering in the respective trough, withered leaf taken out in
each batch and total quantity of withered leaf taken out; percentage of withering
for each day;

(b) Rolling Room –


For orthodox manufacturing –
i) Date,
ii) Rolling table- wise running time i.e. starting time and closing time,
iii) Vibro-shifter running time,
iv) Shifter running time;
v) Progressive cumulative quantity of withered leaf rolled.
For CTC manufacturing (CTC machine-wise) -
i) Shift wise running hour,
ii) Total progressive cumulative running time of each set of roller
iii) Progressive Date
iv) Cumulative quantity of withered green leaf cut by each set of roller,
v) Any change in the set of roller.

Note: It is required to be checked that for each stage of cut, Sl. No. of roller set used is
mentioned and when there is any change of roller set, Sl. No. of rollers replaced is also
mentioned.
(c) Fermenting Trough
For each fermenting trough –
(i) Date,
(ii) Starting and finishing time of the Fermenting Trough;
(iii) Total quantity of Leaf fermented in the Trough for the day.
(d) Drying Room:
For each drier –
(i) Date;
(ii) Starting and finishing time for each batch;
(iii) Weight of output for each batch i.e. Drier Mouth Weight for the batch;
(iv) Total running time during the day;
(v) Total quantity of Black Tea manufactured for the day;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 104


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(e) Sorting Room:
(i) Date;
(ii) Starting & Finishing Time;
(iii) Total time of operation during the day;
(iv) Total quantity of tea sorted during the day.
 Check the productivity of different production centers at the peak season and whether
there is any bottle-neck in the capacity or productivity of any production center which
hinders the overall productivity of the factory;
 If there is any interruption in the operation of any of the above production centers, the
period of stoppage of production and reason thereof are mentioned in the respective Log
Book;
 Examine the records pertaining to sorting and packing;
 Check the accumulated stock of unsorted or unpacked stock of tea on different days
during the season to review the day-wise percentage of unsorted and unpacked tea and
to find the reason when such percentages cross the normal limit;
 Examine the gap between manufacturing, sorting, packing and dispatch;
 Check the Invoice Register and examine the system of control exercised over the marking
of Invoice No. on tea bags;
 Review the system of dispatch of tea including the system of internal control over the
loading of tea in the vehicle;
 Check the weight as per Way Bridge at the time of tea dispatch and cross-check it from
Packing Register and report if there is any abnormal variation;
 Whether periodical (i.e. fortnightly or monthly) physical verification of finished tea is
undertaken by the Estate Management and whether documentary evidence for such
physical verification is maintained;
 Examine the frequency of declaration of excess weight found on physical verification of
finished tea, in the Excise records;
 Examine the records for stock of finished tea – unsorted finished tea, sorted but unpacked
finished tea and packed tea;
 Review the system and status of store-keeping of finished tea;
 Carry out physical verification of stock of finished tea in course of internal audit;
 Check that bags/ chests packed tea marked with Invoice Nos. are kept in a separate
bonded area;
 Compare the recovery percentage of different months and also to compare the total
recovery percentage during the year with previous 3 / 4 year, report if any abnormal
recovery percentage is observed on any day;
 Check the percentage of orthodox and CTC tea manufactured to total production and
compare the same with the budget fixed by the Corporate;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 105


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Study the percentage of primary and secondary grades of the total quantity of tea
manufactured and to compare the same with the company’s manufacturing policy, in case
percentage of production of secondary grades is observed to be high report it to
management;
 Examine the percentage of Tea Waste generated at the end of the season and make a
comparative analysis of percentage of primary and secondary grades as well as Tea
Wastes for 3 / 4 years figures;
 Whether the grade-wise packing register maintained by the estate and check the dispatch
records with reference to the packing register;
 Whether the purchased green leaf is processed separately and separate records thereof
are maintained and examine the records pertaining the processing of purchased green
leaf including checking of the system of weighing Black Tea at the Drier Mouth in respect
of purchased green leaf making a distinction with the Black Tea processed out of own leaf
only.
(b) Coffee:
 Whether Green Coffee Seeds picked daily from the field are again weighed at the Pulp
House;
 Check the record kept at the factory in respect of weight of Green Coffee Seeds and
compare the field weight and the weight taken at the Pulp House for Green Coffee Seeds;
 Whether separate records for weight of Green Coffee Seeds are kept at the Pulp House in
respect of ripe seeds and green seeds are kept;
 Examine the record kept in respect of weight of dry coffee seeds – whether parched and
cherry are weighed separately;
 Check the records for dispatch of dry coffee seeds for grinding, fuel consumption at Pulp
House for coffee drying and final out-turn report in respect of clean coffee received out of
the dry coffee seeds sent for grinding;
 Compare the percentage of Cherry and perched coffee respectively in the clean coffee
received;
 Compare the figures of consecutive 2 – 3 years in respect of final out-turn percentage of
clean coffee as well as percentage of perched and cherry in different areas.
(c) Rubber:
 Examine the system of weighing the receipts of field latex at the factory and records
thereof and compare between the weight of field latex as per the field record and that as
per factory record;
 Examine the records maintained for measurement of DRC percentage for daily receipts of
field latex at the factory;
 Check the method of measuring the quantity of field latex at the receiving tanks at the
centrifuging process – whether the method of Dip Stick measurement or any other
method of volumetric measurement deployed;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 106


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check the system of daily receipt of Crumb or Cup-lumps at factory -- including system of
weighting at factory, records of factory weighment, comparison between factory
weighment and field weighment records;
 Whether Log Books are maintained for different machines/ production centers e.g. –
Machine Production Centre
(i) Centrifuge – Centrifuged latex (or Cenex) processing;
(ii) Skim Crepe Milling
(iii) Skim Crepe Press Skim Crepe Processing

(iv) Crumb Milling


(v) Crumb Press Crumb production – Estate Brown Crepe (EBC)
(vi) Crumb Drier
 Examine the system of maintenance of those Log Books including examination of entries
made therein and check whether the following basic information are recorded in those
Log Books:
(a) Total Hour run every day i.e. record of starting time and finishing time;
(b) Idle time, if any;
(c) Reason for idle time;
 Whether the Log Book maintained for the Drier for production of Crumb (Estate Brown
Crepe) contain the following information:
(a) Consumption of HSD indicating Opening Stock, Receipt during the month, Closing
Stock;
(b) Consumption of Castor Oil ( in the same line as in the case of HSD);
(c) No. of bales produced;
(d) Batch No. of bales;
(e) Diesel consumption per bale during the month;
 Compare the consumption of HSD for Drier among different months of the same year and
also of the current year with that of previous 2 / 3 years;
 Whether the Log Book maintained for Skim Crepe Press contains the following additional
information:
(a) Record for each day’s run;
(b) No. of bales produced;
(c) Batch No. of bales;
(d) Weight of total production during the day.
 Check the production records as to the following aspects:
(i) Whether Dip Stick measurement is taken at the Cenex Storage Tank at the end of every
day after completion of production;
(ii) When production in shift is prevalent, whether Deep Stick measurement is taken at the
Cenex Storage Tank at the end of each shift;
(iii) Recording of the Deep Stick measurement of storage tank for Cenex;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 107


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iv) Maintenance of records for DRC percentage of Cenex i.e. final centrifuged latex;
(v) Records maintained for daily production of Cenex;
(vi) Method of weighing production of Crumb (EBC), Skim Crepe and Smoked Rubber Sheets,
etc.;
(vii) Records maintained for the weights of the finished products, as mentioned above.
 Check the method of computation of monthly and yearly production of Cenex and Skim Crepe
and the Processing Loss;
 Compare the cumulative daily production recorded with the final monthly production
computed in respect of Cenex;
 Check the monthly reconciliation of Opening/ Closing Stock, production and dispatch in
respect of Cenex and Skim Crepe;
 Check the monthly reconciliation among the receipt of field latex, production of Cenex, Skim
Crepe and manufacturing loss and compare the percentage of manufacturing loss in respect
of Latex centrifuging among different periods – say, among different months of the same year
and among consecutive 3 / 4 years;
 Examine the Stock Register maintained for finished products like Skim Crepe, Crumb (EBC),
Smoked Rubber Sheets, etc.;
 Examine the system of checking and recording DRC percentage of each consignment of Cenex
dispatched;
 Check the record for dispatch register of finished products with the corresponding challans
and invoices ;
 Check the system of verification of WIP and finished goods at the end of each month.
D. Sale
(a) Tea & Coffee:
I. Domestic Sale – Auction Sale & Private Sale:
 Examine the routes selected for domestic sale – whether 100% Auction sales or 100% private
sales or partially Auction sale and partially private sale;
 In case of auction sale, study the average realization for different grades in each sale;
 Whether the organization has identified any benchmark garden(s) in the Circle to which the
Estate belongs for comparing its performance as to the average price realization in each
auction sale;
 Compare the auction average in each sale with that of the benchmark garden(s), as identified
find the reasons for variation and to report to the management of the variations;
 Compare the sales average for each auction sale with the respective average of the Circles to
which the Estate belongs;
 Examine the garden’s batting order in the perspective of the current year’s auction sale and
compare the current years’ batting order with that of the previous year;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 108


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check the out-lot quantities in respect of different auction sale Nos. with reference to the
corresponding Invoice Nos.;
 Examine the subsequent disposal action of such out-lot quantities – whether through private
sale or again put to auction and the ultimate price realization of such out-lot quantities and
compare the same with the comparable price realization of the auctions from which such
quantities have been withdrawn;
 Examine the basis of allocation of quantities between auction sale and private sale;
 To compare between the net price realization in private sale and the price realization in
auction sale in respect of comparable quantities of tea after considering all comparable sales
related expenses of private sale and auction sale respectively (i.e. Broker’s Commission,
Selling Agents Commission, Warehousing Charges, Transportation charges, etc.);
 Test check the auction sale with reference to all basic documents like Auctioneers Sales
Statement, Delivery Order, etc.;
 Examine the Crop Book with reference to basic documents like Garden’s Invoice, etc.;
 Examine the private sale with reference to the related basic documents like Contract
agreement, sales bills, etc.
 Verify the Broker’s Account Sale with the Broker’s Sales Advice;
 Cross-verify the Auction sales with the Estate’s Invoices;
 Examine the realization of sales proceeds – both in respect of private sale and auction sale
and check that sales proceeds have been realized according to the terms of agreement in
respect of private sale;
 If any deduction is made from the Sale proceeds of auction sales verify all supporting
documents for deductions ;
 In respect of consignment sale, to compare the consignment price with the actual price
realization vis-à-vis contemporary auction average and examine the Profit Volume Ratio on
the basis of net realization after considering all expenses incurred at sale point;
 Examine the Debtors Ledger – whether any amount remains outstanding beyond the credit
period allowed as per terms of corresponding sales agreement;
 In respect of auction sale, to check whether any quantity was lifted by the buyer after the
stipulated period and all recoverable expenses like Warehousing Charges, etc. have been
realized from such buyers.
II. Export Sale:
 Examine the process of fixation of price in respect of export sale and export contract
regarding terms of price, approval of samples;
 Compare the export price realization with the comparable price realization in the domestic
auction;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 109


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the process of booking foreign exchange – whether judicious decision has been taken
between the option of Forwarding Booking and Spot Booking considering the condition in
foreign currency market;
 Verify the actual exports with reference to the export contracts, invoices, shipping documents,
etc.;
 In respect of SAS (subject to approval of Sample) contract, to check whether any sales have
been cancelled due to rejection of sample;
 Whether any export has been rejected due to variation between the initial sample taken
immediately on packing and the corresponding large out-turn sample taken on reaching the
consignment at the port of dispatch;
 Whether all shipping documents are deposited with the Bank for negotiation of documents,
without any delay;
 Scrutinize the realization of sale proceeds in respect of total export sale – to check whether
any delay in realization has occurred due to defect in shipping documents or for any other
reasons;
 Whether all formalities are complied with for availing applicable export benefits. If any export
benefit has been denied find out the reasons thereof and corrective actions have been taken
in such cases;
 Whether the organization has their own Department for handling shipping of the export or
the services of any Clearing & Forwarding Agent is hired for handling the export;
 Where the services of any Clearing & Forwarding Agent is hired, to examine the process of
selection of agents - to check whether the background and experience of the Clearing &
Forwarding Agent has been scrutinized before selection;
 Examine the process of fixation of the rates of services and other expenses payable to the
Clearing & Forwarding Agent – whether current market rate for such services are checked
through obtaining competitive quotations from different agents having experience of handling
Tea/ Coffee export;
 Examine the export contract as regard Freight & Insurance – whether it is a c.i.f. contract or
f.o.b. contract;
 Where the contract is a c.i.f. contract, to examine the selection of the shipping Company vis-à-
vis fixation of freight rates;
 Whether the shipping Company has the experience of handling Tea Cargo and proper
Insurance coverage has been obtained for the Cargo.
(b) Rubber:
 Whether statutory requirement of the Rubber Board as well as VAT Act of the respective State
are properly complied with;
 Review the profile of the customers for different grades of rubber like Cenex, Crumb (Indian
Standard Natural Rubber or INR), Skim Crepe, Sheet Rubber, etc.;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 110


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check the broadness of the customer-base for each grade of rubber sold;
 Examine the process of fixation of Sales Price and extent of control of the Company over the
fixation of Sales price .Whether the cost of production is considered while fixation of price;
 Review the process of preparation of Invoice and dispatch documents .Check entries in the
Sales Register with reference to Sales Invoice & Challans, customers’ Purchase Orders and
Dispatch Register;
 Whether the realization of Sale Proceeds are with reference to terms of payment specified in
the customers’ Purchase Orders;
 Review the Debtors Ledger – whether any amount remains outstanding beyond the
contractual credit period.
E. Tea Waste:
 Whether the Tea Board License for holding the stock of tea waste is renewed regularly;
 Whether the stock of tea waste is denatured at the end of the season or sold;
 In case tea waste is denatured, to examine whether necessary Excise formalities have been
complied with;
 Where tea waste is sold, to check whether it is ascertained before sale that the buyers have
proper Tea Board License for purchasing tea waste;
 Whether necessary formalities as per Central Excise Act has been complied with before
commencing the process of sale and dispatch of the tea waste from the Tea Estate;
 Examine the method of fixation of selling price – whether through competitive bidding or
through negotiation with a particular buyer and check the records pertaining to sale of Tea
Waste.
F. SCRAP:
In course of operation of any Estate whether engaged in Tea plantation, Coffee plantation or
Rubber plantation, a substantial quantum of scrap of different items like, damaged / broken
machine spares ,vehicle spares, CTC segments, replaced bearings etc. are generated which has a
considerable realizable value. Therefore, it is important to exert proper internal control over the
method of collection of scrap, stores keeping of these scrap materials, maintaining records of
these stock and the system and method followed for scrap disposal.
(a) Scrap Records:
 Whether the Estate maintains item-wise and category-wise Scrap Register in respect of
different types of Scrap generated out of different operations in the estate;
 Whether the scrap generated in the Estate are accounted for and recorded mandatorily
under the following broad categories:
a) Replaced and worn-out Bearings;
b) Scrapped CTC segments;
c) Other replaced and worn-out machinery parts;
d) Worn-out agricultural implements;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 111


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
e) Scrapped Machinery items;
f) Replaced Electrical items;
g) Metal & Plastic Containers of Weedicides, Insecticides and Foliar Nutrients applied;
h) Plastic Bag of Manures;
i) Food Stuff Gunny Bags;
j) Replaced Vehicle parts, tyres & tubes.
 Whether the instructions have been issued to the Stores Clerk that no electrical items,
bearings, machinery parts, vehicle parts ,tyres & tubes, etc. will be issued unless the worn-
out/ damaged materials against which the fresh items are being issued from Stores are
returned to the Stores;
 Whether the Machinery spares, vehicle spares, worn-out agricultural implements, etc. are
recorded in the Scrap Register immediately on return of those items and other scrap items
like Food Stuff Gunny Bags, Metal/ Plastic Containers, etc. are regularly recorded in the Scrap
Register;
 Cross-check the entries in the Scrap Register as to the generation of Scrap of machinery
Spares and the purchase and fitting of any new set of segments in the CTC machine with the
corresponding entry in the Scrap Register;
 To reconcile the generation of Food Stuff Gunny Bags, Metal & Plastic Containers for different
types of chemicals used with the Stores record of issue/ consumption of those items;
 In case of repair of machinery, vehicles, etc. from external workshops, to check the return of
scrapped spare-parts with the bills for new spares and other items for which payments are
made;
 If any Scrap material is used for internal consumption in the Estate, it should be checked that
no such Scrap material is issued without proper Requisition Slip authorized by the Estate
Management;
 Examine the Scrap Records that all disposals of scrap are properly recorded in the Scrap Stock
Register.
(b) Physical Stock of Scrap – its Maintenance and Security:
 Check condition of maintenance of physical stock of scrap and security of such stock, in
particular the scrap with high realizable value, e.g. Stainless Steel CTC Segments, Brass &
other Cast Metal broken spares, broken Bearings, etc.;
 Whether separate Scrap Store is maintained. Examine the system security of the Scrap Stores
–whether it is kept under lock & key so that there is no or little possibility of pilferage;
 Whether costly spare-parts are kept in loose condition or in properly secured packing box/
gunny bags;
 Check security of the Scrap Store Whether periodical physical verification of the accumulated
Scrap is conducted by the Estate Management and such physical verifications are properly
documented;
 Internal Audit, in course of their audit in the Estate, should carry out the physical verification
of Scrap on test basis.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 112


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(c) Disposal:
 Examine the procedure for Scrap disposal and process of selection of Scrap buyers – whether
through advertisement in local newspaper or through website or through contacting local
traders who are known to be dealing with scrap materials (mode of selection should depend
upon the volume and value of scrap considering the cost of advertisement vis-à-vis benefit of
realization of higher price through competitive bidding);
 How the rates of sale of scrap items have been fixed – whether through competitive bidding
or at a negotiated price with the buyers;
 Whether Rate Contracts which is valid for a certain period are entered into with the scrap
buyers or rates are decided every time scraps are disposed (again, feasibility of entering into
Rate Contract is required to be judged on the basis of volume and value of Scrap generated
and frequency of disposal also );
 Whether Earnest Money Deposits are obtained from the Scrap buyers;
 Check the method of collection of the money realizable through Scrap disposal – whether by
Cash or Demand Draft/ Pay Order or through Cheque. It is required to be ensured that no
scrap material is allowed to leave the premises of the Estate without prior receipt of the
amount realizable i.e. value of Scrap including Sales Tax, if any chargeable;
 In case of payment by Cheque, it is required to be ensured that Scrap material is not released
before encashment of the cheque;
 Whether Gate Passes have been prepared for taking out the Scrap materials from the
premises of the Estate and proper Invoices are prepared for sale of Scrap and applicable VAT/
Sales Tax have been charged in the Invoice;
 Check the quantity of Scrap materials mentioned in the Invoices with reference to the Scrap
Stock records;
 Whether the measurement of quantity of different items of scrap actually sold and lifting of
such scrap have been carried out in presence of any responsible Management staff.
G. Warehousing and Storage:
This area includes the physical safeguarding of assets from theft and sabotage as well as logistics
over shipping and receiving. Internal auditor has to check:
 Examine the process of selection of warehouses and fixation of warehousing charges, whether
the aspects of safety and proper storage facilities have been taken into consideration before
selection of the warehouses;
 Whether the warehouse is easily accessible by unauthorized personnel;
 Whether the inventory items are in a controlled environment that would allow proper
safeguarding from theft, sabotage or damage such as a fire sprinkler if activated;
 Whether the insurance coverage over inventory value is adequate;
 Whether there are written shipping and receiving policies and are they adhered to;
 Whether the company is using bar coding and cycle counts to organize the warehouses.
Whether obsolete inventory is eliminated to free up space in the ware house.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 113


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether selected warehouses are registered with the respective Auction Committees and
warehousing charges payable as per contract with the warehouse owners are at par with the
relevant guidelines issued by the respective Auction Committees;
 Whether in the contracts with the warehouse owners, following salient points are covered :
i) Proper safety and storage of Tea/ Coffee in the warehouses;
ii) Responsibility and liability of the warehouse owners in case of any damage of the stock of
Tea/ Coffee stored and mode of recovery of cost of damage from the warehouse owner;
iii) Documentation i.e. preparation of Arrival Weighment Report (AWR) , amendment of
AWRs on short receipt at the warehouses;
iv) Terms of payment;
 To verify that AWRs are prepared promptly on the basis of Garden’s Invoice and copies of
AWRs are sent to the Auction Committee, Brokers and manufacturer;
(v) Stock of made tea/coffee received at the warehouse shall be verified by referring to the
weighment Report and corresponding entry in the registers at the warehouse.
(vi) The quantity received at the warehouse as per the weighment register and the quantity as
per the corresponding delivery orders shall be compared and any shortage in weight shall
be reconciled under proper authorization.

 If any discrepancy is found on actual weighment at the warehouses after arrival of the
consignments from the Tea/ Coffee Estates , AWRs are amended promptly and copies of AWRs
are sent to Auction Committee, Brokers and manufacturer;
 Whether Arrival Weighment Register is verified regularly with deliveries shown in formal
Delivery Orders issued by the Brokers and/ or authorized Delivery Orders issued by the Sales
Dept.;
 Whether warehouse records relating to Brokers’ samples, floor sweeping and other losses are
verified regularly with reference to the Warehouse Register;
 Physical stock shall be verified periodically with the stock records and any difference after
adjustment for samples issued to brokers, recovery from floor sweeping and other losses shall
be explained and adjustment made in the stock records;
 Whether Brokers’ Damage Report are received timely;
 Check that the calculations in the Service Bills raised by warehouse owners in respect of
chargeable rent/ handling charges, warehousing charges are verified with reference to the
Delivery Orders issued by the Sales Dept;
 To check that the adjustments for warehousing charges by the brokers from A/c Sales ,
wherever made, are properly reconciled with the respective Service Bills of the Warehousing
owners;
 Verify the amount of warehouse charges, handling charges etc. by referring to the delivery
orders.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 114


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Where the stock has been hypothecated, the hypothecation statements shall be verified.
 Verify whether the necessary licenses as required by various authorities have been taken and
are in force.
H. Transportation Contract:
 Whether the entity under audit has any laid down procedure for selection of transporters and
method followed for selection is in conformity with the laid down policy and procedure;
 Examine the method of selection of transporters – whether through open tender or through
limited enquiry;
 Where the selection is made through limited enquiry, to check the data-base used for making
such enquiry and basis of choosing the data-base;
 Where the transporters are selected through open tender, to examine whether all the criteria
for selection and conditions for minimum eligibility are clearly specified in the tender
documents;
 Whether while selecting the transporters, their extent of experience of handling finished
products of respective plantation industry, i.e. Tea, Rubber or Coffee is given the prime
importance;
 Examine the credentials of the selected transporters and to check that their credentials are
conformed to the eligibility criteria fixed for the purpose;
 To check that the rates are fixed for Full Load / Part Lorry Load/ Small consignments and
Tankers (for transporting Latex) for different destinations;
 Examine the method of fixation of the rates of transportation and check that the fixed rates
are at par with the prevailing market rates;
 Examine the terms of contract with the transporters and to check that the following points
are specifically covered in those contracts;
(a) Rates of carriage of finished products and other stores materials for all known
destinations;
(b) Other related expenses like, loading/unloading, detention charges, incidental charges
etc.;
(c) Price variation clause in case of increase/ decrease of fuel price;
(d) Maximum allowable delivery time between two destinations for different types of
consignments;
(e) Incentive/ Penalty Clause applicable in case of early / delayed delivery;
(f) Time limit for placement of Lorries on receipt of requisitions by the transporters;
(g) Method of billing in case of consignments of weight less than full Lorry Load;
(h) Mode of certification of weight of consignments at the loading point;
(i) Preparation of Consignments Notes;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 115


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(j) Transporters’ liability in respect of shortage / pilferage/ damages of the consignments in
course of transportation;
(k) Consignee’s right and mode of recovery of cost of consignments in case of short-delivery
or partial damage or total loss in course of transportation, subject to realization of claims
on insurance company;
(l) Carriers’ Risk in course of transportation of finished goods and other stores;
(m) Documentation required to be done by the transporters for processing the Insurance
Claims by the Consignee in case of any accident, theft, pilferage in transit or for any other
claim;
(n) Precautionary measures to be taken by the carrier for protection, safety and security of
the consignments;
(o) Proportionate extra freight to be paid in case of any unavoidable de-tour due to
dislocation of traffic because of any natural calamities or diversion of lorries from one
warehouse to another or from one destination to another;
(p) Recovery of Cost of consignments from transporters in case of short /damaged delivery,
where the amount of loss is below the minimum amount qualified for claims on Insurers;
(q) Documents to be attached as supporting with the transporters’ bills;
(r) Terms of payment;
(s) Risk Purchase Clause – in case of transporters’ failure to place lorries/ tankers;
(t) Validity of the Contract
 Whether before obtaining offers from transporters, all the known destinations i.e. Estates,
warehouses, auction centres, regular customers’ places, ports (for export) are taken into
consideration and offers are obtained for all such destinations;
 Examine that for the convenience of logistics and selection of transports, destinations are
grouped into several routes and for each route/ destination more than one transporters are
empanelled to keep alternative sources;
 While fixing the rates, other incidental charges are included in the rates or those charges are
separately reimbursable – to check whether any Cost-Benefit Analysis has been made
between the two options before choosing the basis of rates fixed;
 Whether security deposits (either in the form of Cash or Bank Guarantee) have been
obtained from the transporters for the period of validity of contracts and the amount of
security deposit covers the average value of a single consignment handled by each
transporter;
 Whether there is a system prevalent in the estates, of checking at the loading point that the
vehicles / staff of transporters have necessary permits (Inter-State Permit/ State Permit or any
other permit, as applicable) along with other relevant transit documents;
 Whether the loads at different loading points on the same route are clubbed together to
make a full truckload (normally 9 MT) as far as practicable, where a single consignment from
one loading point cannot make the full truckload;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 116


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the formula incorporated in the transportation contracts for escalation/ de-
escalation of transportation rates on price increase/ decrease of fuel – whether it is at par
with norms used in the industry;
 Whether there is system of placing the transport requisition on the transporters in writing and
whether those requisitions are preserved for a certain period of time;
 Whether any cross-reference is kept on the requisitions regarding the date and time of
placement of lorries in order to assess the performance of the transporters;
 Whether the movement of vehicles and transportation of materials are planned in such a way
that movement of materials from/ to the destinations on the same route can be combined in
a single vehicle, within the limit of maximum lorry load;
 Examine the system of verifying the transporters’ bills with reference to the documents
relating to receipt of materials, like copies of delivery challis acknowledged by the recipients
of materials with the noting of date and time of delivery, consignment notes, AWRs etc.;
 Check that gross weight and tare weights are clearly mentioned in the consignment notes;
 Scrutinize the bills passed for payment on test check basis –
(i) Whether the standard practice of verification of bills has been followed,
(ii) Whether the cost of short receipts/ damages of goods in transit have been deducted from
the transporters’ bills, subject to realization of Insurance Claims,
(iii) whether the penalty has been deducted from bills in case of delivery beyond the maximum
delivery period stipulated in contracts for respective destinations,
(iv) Whether any additional amount has been allowed beyond the terms of contract.
 In case of occurrence of any accident, high jacking, theft or damage in transit, to check
whether the following documents have been furnished by the transporters –
i) Copy of final Police Investigation Report of the concerned Police Station;
ii) Photographs, if any, taken at the site of accident or theft;
iii) Copy of the Consignment Note;
iv) Damage Certificate/ Non-delivery Certificate from the consignee about the consignment;
 Whether the services of all the selected transporters are available equitably (provided there is
no difference in rates );
 Whether the organization follows the system of continuous performance evaluation of the
transporters on the following service levels:-
i) Placement of Lorries;
ii) Transit time;
iii) Claim Ratio (shortages and damages).
I. Insurance :
 Examine the Insurance Policy coverage taken ;
 Whether the Company is over or under insured. There is risk for being under insured or a
wasting of funds if the company is over insured;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 117


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the insurance policies cover all locations under the ownership of the organizations
for which risks are required to be covered;
 Cross-check the sums insured under different policies with books of Accounts and other
relevant operational records;
 Whether the policies are renewed in time;
 Whether the insurance policies along with the endorsements are being kept in safe custody;
 Whether the following risks at least have been covered under the policies taken –
(i) Money Insurance Policy - Cash in Safe wherever the cash is kept in safe;
- Cash in Transit covering all points of movement.

(ii) Standard Fire & Special - Buildings, i.e. Bungalows, Labour Quarters, Factory
Peril Policy covering Building, Office Building, Stores & other
Flood & Earthquake constructions.
- Plant & Machinery
- Furniture & Fixture including Office equipments,
Computers, etc.
- Inventory of Raw-materials, Finished products &
Stores materials.

(iii) Burglary Insurance - Inventory

(iv) Crop Insurance - Crop at field against natural calamities like hail, flood
as well as finished crop in transit.

(v) Elephant Damage - Estate Buildings*

(vi) Fidelity Insurance - In respect of personnel handling cash


* This is required for Tea Estates in North-East & Dooars where impact of damages to labour
quarters and other constructions by elephant herd is significant.
 In respect of Crop Insurance Policy for crop-in-transit or Marine Policy, it should be examined
whether the policy taken is for a fixed annual value with the coverage of a maximum value of
individual consignment or the sum insured is based on declaration of details of consignments
in each month during the validity period of insurance policy;
 Internal Auditor has to evaluate the insurance on property and equipment compared to their
value.
 Internal Auditor has to physically determine if property and equipment are still in the
company's possession.
 Whenever any asset is disposed off or any new asset (high value asset in particular) is
acquired, the same is excluded from or included in the sum insured;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 118


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the claims made on the Insurance Company – whether the claims have been made
promptly after the occurrence of any event covered under the risks insured; if not, to review
the reasons;
 Examine the records maintained in respect of insurance claims – whether any comprehensive
record is maintained which facilitates smooth follow-up of insurance claims;
 Check the status of settlement of claims –
(i) Whether regular follow-up is made with Insurance companies regarding survey of loss/
damage;
(ii) Whether follow-up is made with Insurance for settlement of claims where survey is
complete;
 Review the reasons for old claims remaining unsettled for a substantial period of time and to
report thereon;
 Where the claims have been short-settled for a substantial amount or have been turned
down, to examine the reasons for short settlement or denial.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 119


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 18 Audit of Functional Areas

I. Administration Department
Before the internal audit is taken up it is necessary to obtain and examine the organizational chart
to find out how the company is organized, who reports to whom and the geographical location of
the company spread over various places including marketing offices, delivery points, loading
points, quality control etc. The general system of administrative set up is required to be
understood by the internal auditor for the effective understanding and functioning. In many
companies administration department may be combined with HR or accounts depending upon
the size of the organization. The checklist given below is based on the assumption of a separate
Administration department:
 Define the audit objective and scope of the work
 For each administrative process, study the SOPs, schedule of authorities etc.
 Decide the sample size and obtain sample data as an audit evidence
 Observe the variations with respect to the SOPs
 Assess the risks and value impact on the organization
 Arrive at the audit findings and conclusions
 Areas to be checked in administration
 Office routine procedures for authorization and approval
 Office maintenance and utilities
 Office rental agreements and compliance
 Health, safety and environmental aspects
 Administrative purchases and policies thereof
 The total administrative expenses analysis v/s budgets
 Administration expenses as a percentage of total cost of sales and the trend over a period of
time
 MIS generated periodically on the administrative matters
 The Budgetary Control in operation in the Company and the Comparison of Administrative
budget broken down for various administrative functions like Recruitment, HR Training,
Watch and ward, Safety, Health, Environment, Office and General maintenance etc to Actual
expenditure and deviation reports for management action, if any.
 Check the administrative offices located at various parts and their linking with the cost
centre, if any, for Control purpose through collection of a system on administrative costs.
Beside general administrative functions, administration of Insurance policies, legal compliance,
monitoring of subsidies received from Boards are required to be carried out.

(i) Allocation of responsibilities among the supervisory staffs and reports submitted by them
shall be referred to, to assess their performance and actions taken on the reports submitted.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 120


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(ii) Whether meetings at regular intervals have been held by committees and sub-committees
formed to look into various functions and activities and whether decisions taken in those
meetings, as documented in the minutes, have been executed.
(iii) Frequency of meetings between the Estate Management and the Corporate Office to assess
and improve the performance at the Estate and the quality of the output should be viewed
along with the ‘action taken’ report.
(iv) The frequency of visits by officials from the Corporate Office and the reports submitted by
them should be viewed to verify the actions taken.
II. HRD and Personnel Department
Human Resource Management: Human Resources Management covers a wide variety of
workforce activities, including labour law issues, compensation and benefit plan design,
employee hiring and termination procedures and the handling or administrating of many
corporate policies. This function consists of Recruitment and training, Complying with the laws
related to staff/labour, Payroll functions and Staff Welfare which are to be reviewed as detailed
below:
Recruitment and training:
(a) Recruitment, record maintenance and training:
Ascertaining the requirement of various types of work-force, skilled, semi-skilled and unskilled in
consultation with the management, selection, recruitment, maintenance of details of each
staff/labour and training of the personnel.

(i) Verify the records to find out whether periodical meetings have been conducted to ascertain
the need for additional work-force.
(ii) Verify the records to ascertain whether the selection process as necessitated by law or
company’s policy has been followed. Verify whether recruitment has been done following the
statutory requirement and company policy
 Whether there are written procedures on interviewing candidates;
 Whether best practices are used in the hiring process;
 Whether the HR staff is adequately trained, there are certain positions that need
certification and special training.
 Administrative policy of the company and its adherence and the treatment to be given to
the new employees with reference to the benefits including the permissible benefits.
 Induction Programmes to the new entrants of the Organization and Training Programmes
(including quiz, elocution competitions etc) to the employees on a continuous orientation
scheme.
(iii) Verify whether detailed records of the employees are being maintained on a regular basis;
(iv) Verify whether the need for training has been ascertained periodically and whether training
has been done in-house or elsewhere. Whether the training procedure has been designed to
meet the requirement of the company and approved by proper authority, in-house training

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 121


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
has been imparted by authorized persons and for training outside the training programme
and the institute has been approved by the authorized persons.
Review the system for complying with the provisions of various laws applicable to the entity,
whether proper steps are being taken, whether proper records/registers are being maintained,
statutory payments are being made and returns are being submitted in time to avoid penal
provisions.
 Whether there is a code of conduct or business ethics policy;
 Whether company is in compliance with Labour laws. Whether the company has concerns
with safety issues of worker?
 Whether the company has a sexual harassment policy.
 Whether there are termination procedures, including the use of a checklist, to avoid missing
a step such as terminating access to the company’s network.
Wages:
Checking of Attendance Record, Wage Sheets, Wage Disbursements, etc:
 Check the mode of Wage Administration – whether fully computerized or partially
computerized or fully manual. Where the Wage Administration is managed through
computerized system, Internal Auditor should study and examine the total computer program
in order to ensure that there is proper internal control and check at each and every step of
the program and all the related module like Master Roll, Attendance Recording System, Pay
Roll Accounting, Computation of leave with wages, Sick Leave Recording, etc. are properly
inter-linked;
 To check whether the Estate maintains a Master Roll of all the workers which should contain
the following information:
(i) Employee Code;
(ii) PF Sl. No.;
(iii) Name;
(iv) Date of Birth;
(v) Date of Joining;
(vi) Grade/ Category;
(vii) Scale of Pay;
 Check the details recorded in Master Roll with reference to the basic records like employee/
workers’ personal information file, declaration to PF authority in respect of date of joining &
date of birth of individual workers, etc.
 Examine that the Muster Roll is updated regularly in respect of Superannuation, Resignation,
Death or Termination of employment;
 Examine the procedure for revision of the Muster Roll and to check that any amendment in
the Muster Roll is properly authorized by the Estate Management;
 Whether Pay Roll is linked to Muster Roll (in case of computerized system);

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 122


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Cross-check the number of workers as per Muster Roll with the number as per Pay Roll vis-à-
vis number of workers in the list prepared for actuarial valuation of Gratuity liability – to
report, if any discrepancy found among these three records;
 Ensure that the Muster Roll does not contain the name of any superannuated or deceased
employee or the name of any employee who have left the service;
 Examine all cases of new appointment of workers –
 whether those appointments are replacements for the superannuated workers /
workers who have left service or these appointments results in increase in permanent
workforce;
 where new appointed have resulted in increase in the number of permanent
workforce to check whether such appointments have been made with the approval of
the Corporate Management;
 whether such new appointments impacts the Land-Labour Ratio adversely i.e. beyond
the norm of the industry;
 Examine the system of recording attendance for staff/ sub-staff and workers – whether it is
recorded through computerized system i.e. swapping the magnetic ID Cards or through
biometric system or the attendance is recorded manually;
 Where the attendance recording system is computerized – to check whether the attendance
of all the workers i.e. field workers, factory workers and workers deployed in miscellaneous
other work ( i.e. Establishment, transport, transport, etc.) and also staff and sub-staff are
recorded through computerized system;
 In case of computerized attendance recording system, Internal Auditor should witness and
observe live attendance recording in order to find whether there is proper Internal Control in
the system;
 Check the system of uploading the data of attendance daily (particularly for the field workers)
into the computerized system used for daily deployment recording and wage computation;
 In case of computerized attendance recording system, to check whether the attendance of
field workers (i.e. workers engaged in plucking, tapping, picking of Coffee Seeds and other
field operations) are recorded directly in the field itself through Logger or attendance are
recorded in the Field Office first and then workers are sent to the field;
 Where attendance is recorded directly in the field itself, Internal Audit should witness and
observe the recording system of attendance at the field;
 In case of recording attendance of workers & sub-staff manually, to examine the system and
method followed for recording the attendance at different points of deployment i.e. field,
factory, office, bungalows, workshop, etc.
 Scrutiny the primary attendance record i.e. Pocket Book used by the field staff for recording
the attendance of field workers and cross-check the same with the final attendance record
maintained at the Estate Office for wage calculation. For workers engaged in plucking,
tapping or peaking Coffee Seeds, to check the primary attendance record with the record

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 123


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
maintained for daily harvesting by individual workers which is also used for computation of
incentive for fulfillment of target;
 Whether the attendance are recorded by the concerned field / factory/ office staff specifically
assigned with the responsibility for this purpose;
Casual Worker
 Check the method of recording the attendance of casual workers i.e. whether through
computerized system or manually.
 If the attendance of casual workers is recorded through computerized system, as in the case
of permanent workers, following points need to be checked:
 The system followed for issue of Magnetic ID Cards to the workers, system of allotment of
Employee Code to the workers, maintenance of basic employment data;
 System followed for keeping control over the issue of Cards – whether it is issued daily and
returned at the end of the day or it is issued at the beginning of harvesting season and taken
back at the end of harvesting season, etc.
 Check the system of recording attendance of casual workers who are paid through Cash
Vouchers instead of Wage Book;
 Scrutiny the attendance record of the field staff, factory staff and office staff - where it is
maintained manually in the form of Attendance Register, whether attendance register is
signed by the respective staff himself or any Management personnel records their daily
attendance in the Attendance Register - to check that the above system is followed properly;
 Whether there is any alteration in the attendance record subsequent to the primary
recording;
 Examine such cases of alterations in the attendance record to find whether there is any
unauthorized alteration;
 Check that total attendance of permanent and casual workers together for a day as per Pay
Roll is tallied with the total man-days as per the deployment record for the same day;
 Verify the total number of workers present as per daily attendance record with the total
number of workers attended as per final deployment book vis-à-vis field record i.e. Rough
Deployment Book;
 Check the wage sheets with the daily attendance record where attendance is recorded
manually;
 In case of computerized record, to check the program used for computation of wages and
linking of attendance record with the Wage Sheet preparation;
 Check the computation of wages in the Wage Sheet with reference to other basic records like
Estate record for respective workers/ sub-staffs’ grade/ category, corresponding wage rate &
other allowances payable as per Industry-wise agreement;
 Verify the wage payment vouchers for disbursement of wages to casual/ contractual workers
who are directly paid through Cash Vouchers instead of Wage Sheets with reference to the
basic records maintained for recording their attendance;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 124


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 While checking the records in respect of payment of wages to the Tappers in Rubber
plantation, the following points are required to be checked:
1. Records for daily collection of Field Latex (In terms of DRC) by individual workers;
2. Classification of the field where deployed;
3. Piece Rate payable per Kg. of field latex collected, depending on the classification of the
field in terms of yield per hectare;
 Where the workers are paid on the basis of piece rate for plucking Green Leaf or picking
Coffee Seeds, the following areas are required to be checked while checking the records of
payment of wages;
1. Records maintained for harvesting by individual workers – control system followed for such
recording;
2. Piece Rate paid to individual workers in terms of agreement with the workers;
 Check the system and procedures followed for recording of harvesting by individual workers
daily – whether such recording is carried out in the presence of any Management Staff or any
other responsible senior staff members of the Estate. This checking is required to be carried
out for all the three types of plantations, i.e. Tea, Rubber and Coffee;
 Examine the computation of incentives to the workers engaged in plucking, tapping or picking
of Coffee Seeds with reference to the records maintained for their daily harvesting, the
minimum target for incentive earning fixed for different periods of harvesting season and
industry-wise agreement on rate of incentives payable;
 Check computation of various deductions made in the Wage Sheets from the wages like
Contribution to PF, Contribution to Deposit Linked Insurance (DLI), recovery of cost of
electricity provided to workers’ houses, recovery of price of food stuff issued to workers,
recovery of advances paid to staff/ sub-staff and workers, etc.;
 Examine the procedure followed for disbursement of wages – whether disbursement of wages
are made from the Estate Office itself or wages are disbursed from different points i.e. Field
workers at the field, factory workers at the factory and the workers and Sub-staff deployed in
the Office.
 In case disbursement of wages are decentralized, to check that disbursement of wages at each
point are made under the supervision of senior staff/ management staff;
 Examine the process of identification of the workers at the time of disbursement of wages –
to check the method of obtaining acknowledgement of workers/ sub-staff for disbursement of
wages;
 Check the Wage Sheet in respect of computation of Wages for paid holidays – whether the
wages has been paid to any worker/ employee who is absent from work for a long period or
the worker who was not present both days preceding and succeeding to the holiday:
 Check the procedure followed for recovery of price of food stuff issued to workers – whether
the cost deducted from the Wages through Wage Sheet or the Cost is collected at the time of
issue of ration articles;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 125


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Where the cost of food stuff is deducted from wages through Wage Sheet, to check the
computation of deduction with reference to the attendance record, dependant’s muster and
the industry norm for per head issue quantity.
Cash Plucking (i.e. plucking on piece rate basis) – for Tea cultivation only:
 Check the timing and the sections where cash plucking was resorted to during the season;
 Examine the reason behind resorting to cash plucking – whether the plucking round was
behind the schedule or it was resorted to after a long holiday when the leaf became longer;
 Whether cash plucking and plucking during normal working hour is simultaneously carried out
– if that practice is carried out, to report whether any adverse effect of cash plucking on
plucking during normal working hours has been observed;
 Examine the system of field supervision of cash plucking;
 Whether permanent workers are deployed for cash plucking or cash plucking is carried out
with the help of casual workers only;
 Examine the records maintained in respect of cash plucking e.g. date and time of plucking,
section / field no, name of the workers deployed, weight of green leaf plucked by individual
workers etc;
 Examine the per Kg. rate paid for cash plucking and compare the same with the average
plucking cost;
 Examine the system of disbursement of wages for cash plucking to the workers;
Leave with Wages:
 Examine the mode of computation of wages for the paid leave – whether through a
computerized system or manually;
 To check the method and system of recording leave earned by each worker, staff and sub-
staff;
 In case of computerized system followed for both recording the leave earned and the
computation of wages of earned leave, to check the programme used for this purpose;
 In case of manual recording of leave earned, to check the leave record with reference to basic
attendance record/ wages sheet/ pay sheet;
 In case of manual computation of wages for the earned leave, to check the computation;
 Check the record for payment/ disbursement of wages for earned leave.
Record for Absenteeism of Workers:
 Whether any worker-wise record is maintained in order to find the number of days absent by
each worker over a particular period – say month or year;
 Whether any percentage of absenteeism for a specified period – say, month or year, is
computed for individual workers’ absenteeism as well as for total absenteeism;
 Whether any permanent record is maintained for percentage of absenteeism;
 Internal Audit should make a comparative study of the absenteeism percentage – both
worker-wise and total workforce-wise among different periods of the same year as well as

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 126


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
with past years to see the trend of absenteeism and discuss with the Estate Management
regarding the action taken for improvement of status of absenteeism.
System of payment of Overtime Wages:
 Whether any overtime work is carried out in the estate;
 Whether the estate follows the practice of obtaining approval before the OT work is
undertaken or post-facto approval is taken after the OT work is done;
 Examine the method followed for recording Overtime Hours worked by the workers – whether
manual or through computerized recording system;
 Check the Overtime Work Register maintained in the factory where manual system is followed
for recording overtime work;
 Where the attendance for overtime work is recorded manually, to check whether ‘In’/ ‘Out’
timing is recorded, whether Overtime Hours is recorded for individual worker-wise and day-
wise;
 Whether the job/ operation/ function where the respective workers are deployed, is also
recorded;
 Whether OT Register is regularly checked by the Managerial personnel, who is In-charge of
the factory operation;
 Whether any blank space is kept in the OT Register between the last entry in a particular Page
and the approval signature by the Estate Manager. The checking is required to ward off
possibility of any unauthorized entry in the blank space;
 In respect of overtime work on any day in the factory, to carry out a comparative study –
which is more cost effective – working of an extra shift or working OT hours;
 In case computerized system is followed for recording OT work, to scrutiny the system
whether all necessary information, as mentioned above, are recorded in the system;
 Where computerized system is followed for recording OT work, to check the system of
recording the attendance of OT hours;
 Examine the system of recording the Overtime work in areas other than manufacturing, like
Hospital, Bungalows, Vehicle running & maintenance, Office and Estate premises, etc and also
to examine the method of obtaining approval for OT work in those areas;
 Where the record for attendance of OT work is maintained manually, it should be checked
whether there is any unauthorized alteration in the OT work record;
 Check the computations of the OT wage payment sheets with reference to the OT work
attendance record and rate of wages of the respective workers/ employees.
Pay roll functions:
Maintenance of proper record of attendance, hours worked (normal and overtime), production
achieved etc. to ascertain the salary/wages and bonus payable, maintenance of record of leave,
maintenance of record of payments and deductions made from the amount payable. Internal
auditor has to ascertain that controls are in place to prevent fictitious employees, unauthorized
rates or bonuses.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 127


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

 Whether internal controls exist to prevent creation of fictitious employees or inappropriate


and unauthorized pay rates.
 Whether adequate automated computer controls exist to prevent payroll errors such as
having minimums and maximums on cheque amounts.
 Whether Human Resources have the knowledge and experience to keep in compliance with
labour laws.
 How bonuses and commissions are paid. Whether the payment of Bonus is in accordance with
the decision of the Board of Directors.
 Check salary charts with the payments in cash book / bank book or journal.
 Check attendance with time card or master register maintained by the company.
 Check overtime (OT) payments with the relevant registers and company’s rules.
 Check incentive payments with its basics. Ad hoc incentives should be listed out.
 Whether the employees are paid for leaves on which they have worked as per their
agreement.
 Tally the staff advances accounts with their salary accounts and see that the adjustments have
been made on time.
 Check increments with approvals / relevant agreements, if any.
 If the payroll function is outsourced then the third party administration is to be reviewed.
 Review the employee payroll process to check whether taxes is calculated and deducted as
per applicable income tax limits.
(i) Whether payment to labourers, permanent or casual, has been made on the basis of
attendance, except where the piece-rate wages with or without minimum wages is the
basis of payment, after any deduction for Provident Fund, unpaid leave etc., whether
leave register has been verified for earned leave and maternity leave and maternity
register has been referred to, to identify false entry and whether the entry for earned and
maternity leave have been made under proper authorization.
(ii) Whether proper identification of the labourers have been made at the time of payment of
wages.
(iii) Whether the salary sheets on the basis of which payment is to be made to the executives
and office staffs has been prepared correctly (as per the attendance record and
calculation has been done by taking the correct scale of pay) after proper deductions for
absence without leave, PF, ESI, P. Tax, TDS etc.
(iv) Correlation of deductions made shall be done with the leave register and attendance
record, Provident Fund ledger and Employee State Insurance records (for PF and ESI
deduction) and tax returns (For Tax deductions).
(v) Payments made for overtime, earned leave encashment, workmen’s compensation etc.
shall be verified with the corresponding records for ascertaining the correctness of the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 128


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
amount and whether proper authorization for such entitlement exists.
(vi) Verify whether any inclusion/exclusion in the names, increments etc. are properly
authorized, inclusion/exclusion compares with the appointment and resignation or
termination respectively and increment has been correctly calculated.
LABOUR WELFARE FUNCTION:
Providing welfare as mandated by the statutes and as required by the Company policy namely
providing proper housing, medical facilities, ration of food-grains and health care items and
providing crèche etc.
(i) Whether the right quantity of grains, tea and other things like healthcare items, fuel etc., to
be distributed as weekly ration has been issued from the stores and the undistributed
quantity returned to the stores, whether distribution is being made as per entitlement (on
the basis of type of labour i.e. permanent or casual and the attendance during the week), at
the designated day every week, whether proper identification of the beneficiary is being
done at the time of distribution, the amount to be recovered from the beneficiaries on
distribution is being properly recovered and whether the recovered amount has been
deposited in cash.
(ii) Whether proper housing, sanitation, water supply (both drinking and for other purposes) and
lighting are being provided to the resident staffs and labourers as per the statutory
requirement and company’s policy, whether there is a system of periodical supervision by the
managerial staffs and report of such supervision is being maintained properly.
(iii) Whether the hospital (if any) are being properly maintained with proper stock of medicines
and consumables, proper equipments, proper staff, whether a record of patient attended,
treatment made and medicine issued is being kept, whether any patient had to be referred to
another hospital for treatment, whether payment being made for his/her treatment is to be
borne by the management and if so, whether correct amount is being paid under proper
authorization, whether a system of monitoring by the managerial staffs is in place and report
of such monitoring is being kept.
(iv) Where a crèche exists, whether it is being maintained properly with items necessary for
keeping children of the labourers and whether a stock register is maintained for these items,
whether proper staff has been engaged, whether record of the children being attended to is
being maintained and whether a system of monitoring by the managerial staffs is in place.

Miscellaneous Labour Welfare Expenses:


 Examine the nature of expenditure on different labour ;
 Whether the nature of welfare expenditure incurred in the Estate is at par with the norms of
the Industry;
 Whether such labour welfare expenses are provided in the Budget;
 Make a comparison between the Budget and actual examine to find out whether any Labour
Welfare Expenses has been incurred extraneous to the Budget, whether such expenditure is
incurred with the approval of the Corporate Management;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 129


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 To check To carry out the study of the trend of expenditure under individual head of labour
welfare expenditure for a period of consecutive 3/ 4 years.
Distribution of firewood and other form of fuel to Staff & Workers:
 Examine the system followed for procurement of firewood including selection of vendors,
fixation of rate & quantity of purchase;
 Check the documents pertaining to purchase and procurement of firewood and records
pertaining to receipt and issue of firewood in the concerned Stores record;
 Examine the system of measurement of the receipt quantity including certification thereof;
 Check that a permanent record i.e. Register is maintained for distribution of firewood
incorporating the following information:
1) House No./ Family Code;
2) Entitlement;
3) Date of distribution;
4) Period to which the issue of firewood pertains;
5) Actual quantity of issue;
6) Acknowledgement of the recipients.
 Where the total entitlement for a particular year/ period is issued in installments, to check
whether the acknowledgement of recipients are obtained for each installment.
 To check that Firewood Issue Register is regularly examined by the Labour Welfare Officer;
i) Check the stock record of the firewood;
ii) Where issue of firewood is made from uprooted tea bushes and shed trees, the following
points need to be checked:
a) Whether the job of uprooting will be done by the Estate’s own worker or the job is
being entrusted to any contractor;
b) Where the job is contracted out ,fixation of norms for conversion of lopped and
chopped tea bushes/ shed trees to standard stack (colloquially called as ‘Pills’ in
Assam and West Bengal tea gardens);
c) Records for section-wise daily generation of timber for issue as Firewood;
d) System of checking such record by Estate’s Managerial personnel regarding
authenticity of records;
e) Physical supervision of the operation;
f) Checking of bills of the contractors;
g) Reconciliation of the bills submitted by the contractors with the Estate record for
generation of firewood from uprooting vis-a-vis the records for issue of firewood;
iii) Where LPG cylinders are issued to the staff and sub-staff as fuel, the following points are
required to be examined:
1) Check the number of consumers with the Pay Roll for staff and sub-staff;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 130


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
2) Check the receipts for Security Deposit with the Gas Supply Agency and records thereof;
3) Check the issue of Gas Cylinders with reference to per employee entitlement as per
Industry norms;
4) Maintenance of permanent record for issue of Gas cylinders and checking of the record
with reference to the accounting record i.e. payment vouchers in respect of bills of Gas
Supply Agency;
5) Ensure that in the issue record, the name of the employees to whom the cylinders are
issued are recorded and acknowledgement of the recipients are obtained;
6) It should be ensured that the records for issue is maintained in such a way that total
receipt of cylinders by individual employees during a year can be easily determined.
Distribution of Labour Welfare Items like Umbrella, Blankets, Chappal and other protective
clothing:
 Examine the system of procurement and fixation of rates for purchase, whether samples of the
respective items to be purchased are obtained from the prospective vendors before fixation of
rates;
 Whether competitive offers are obtained for fixation of rates of procurement;
 Check that the approved samples are preserved in Stores and actual supply made is checked
with reference to the approved sample;
 Check the records for issue/distribution of these items contain the following information:
1) Worker Code No.;
2) Name of the Worker;
3) Period to which the issue is related;
4) Acknowledgement of the recipients;
 Examine the stock record with the basic records of receipts and issue of these items and carry
out physical verification of these items with reference to the stock record;
Daily Issue of Black Tea for the purpose of preparation of Liquid Tea at the field: (in case Tea
Plantation only):
 Check the system followed for daily issue of black tea from factory for the purpose of serving
Liquid Tea at the field;
 Whether any per head consumption is fixed for issue of such tea;
 Whether there is any co-relation between the quantity of issue in a day and the number of
workers present in the field for that day;
 Whether any separate stock is maintained in the Stores for issue of ration of black tea to the
workers, staff and sub-staff or the issue is directly made from the factory;
 Check the system of keeping records for daily issue of black tea for distribution of Liquid Tea;
 In case any separate inventory of black tea is maintained at the Stores for this purpose, to
check whether any record is maintained at the Stores for such stock of black tea;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 131


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 In case any separate inventory of black tea is maintained at the Stores for this purpose, to
check whether any record is maintained at the Stores for such stock of black tea;
 Where the issue is made directly from factory, to check the Excise records for such issue to
quantify the volume of black tea issued for the purpose of distribution of Liquid Tea during a
year and to study the percentage of such issue with reference to the total quantity of tea
manufactured;
 Examine the quantum of quota of black tea to be issued to each permanent worker, staff and
sub-staff;
 Compare the quota of actual quantity issued with the entitlement fixed by industry-wise
agreement with the Workers’ Union for the respective region, if any;
 Whether the quantum of issue per worker for married and unmarried employees are same;
 Whether any black tea is issued to adolescent workers and if any such issue is made, whether
the same is allowed as per the agreement with the Workers’ Union, as mentioned above;
 To check the issue of black tea to the temporary workers – it should be examined whether this
issue is made according to the guidelines of the Industry Association in respect of each of the
workers and minimum number of days worked in a month;
 Check issue quantities recorded in the Stores Records with reference to the records maintained
for issue of black tea to individual workers, staff and sub-staff;
 Examine the quantum of issue of black tea from Stores for other miscellaneous labour welfare
purposes;
 Whether such issues are made with the approval of the Estate Manager;
 Compute the total quantity of issue of black tea for miscellaneous purposes during a year as a
percentage of total quantity of tea manufactured during the year – to compare this figure with
the corresponding figures of previous 3 / 4 years;
 Carry out the physical verification of the stock of black tea kept in the Stores for this purpose
and compare the same with the balance as per the stock record, as mentioned above;
 Where the issue is made directly from the factory, to scrutinize factory Excise records for such
issue and to compare the factory records with the records maintained for issue of black tea to
individual workers, staff and sub-staff;
 In case of direct issue of black tea from factory, to examine the system of handling unissued tea
at the end of the day and keeping records for stock of such unissued tea;
FOOD STUFF (Ration)
For Internal Audit of Food Stuff (Ration), the following points/ parameters are required to be
reviewed/ checked:
a) Receipt:
 Whether action for procurement of ration is taken at HO level or at estate level – in case,
procurement is made locally, method of selection of source of purchase and fixation of price
needs to be examined;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 132


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether there is system of weighment at the Estate at the time of receipt of food- stuff
consignments and of comparing the results of such weighment with the weights mentioned in
the corresponding invoices;
 In case of short receipt, the system of dealing with such short receipts;
 Existence of any system of checking of quality of food stuff – whether those are fit for human
consumption;
 Procedure for dealing with the complaints regarding receipt of substandard quality of
consignment or receipt of any water-soaked or otherwise damaged consignments;
 System of checking the Invoices for supplies of food stuff with reference to the receipted Stores
Challans;
 Whether the weight of empty food stuff sacks/ bags are periodically checked on sample basis
to check the correctness of deduction of tare weight in the Suppliers’ Challans;
 System of payment to the suppliers of food staff – whether payments are made at the Estate’s
level or at H.O. level;
 In case payments to the suppliers are made at H.O. level, system of bill passing as well as the
system of preservation of the records for the passed bills at the Estate for future reference in
case of any dispute, needs to be reviewed;
b) Issue:
 System of preparation of Ration Issue Register – whether it is computerized or prepared
manually;
 In case of Ration Issue Register processed through computerized program, it should be checked
whether such program has provision for auto-correction and up-gradation in case of any birth,
death of the dependant linking the same with Dependants’ Muster – whether the names of
the dependants will get automatically deleted once he/ she attains the maximum age of
entitlement of ration;
 In case of computerized Ration Issue Register – to examine whether the program used for
processing the Issue Register is directly linked to the program used for processing the Wages
Sheets;
 In case of Ration Issue Register prepared manually, to examine the system followed for
ensuring the correctness of the register. The internal auditor should test check the register
substantially;
 Check the procedure of deduction from weekly entitlement of ration due to absenteeism –
whether it is in line with the Industry’s standard guidelines;
 Whether the quantity of issue of food stuff per head is in line with the norms fixed for the
Industry;
 Check the system of issue of food stuff for miscellaneous purpose i.e. Hospital, etc.;
 Compare the Ration Issue Register with the Census Book as regards the number of
dependents shown in the census book against the number of dependents entitled to ration as
per Ration Issue Book in respect of each worker - to report if any discrepancy is found;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 133


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the system of updating Ration Issue Register as to the death and birth of the
recipients of ration with reference to the Estate’s Hospital records/ certificates;
 Whether there is a system of due authorization by the Garden Management before any
modification of the number of dependents in the Ration Issue Register;
 In case of computerized Ration Issue Register, administrative level of access to the main
database and also the system of password protection of such database should be reviewed in
order to prevent any unauthorized modification of the database;
 In case of issue of ration to workers’ dependent children above 16 years, whether school going
certificates have been obtained from the respective Head of the Institution;
 Whether any ration is issued to workers’ dependent children above the age of 18 years;
 Whether the working spouse have been segregated from the list of dependents in order to
prevent the double issue of ration;
 System of recovery of sale proceeds of ration to workers – whether through direct deduction
from weekly/ fortnightly wages or recovery in the form of cash at the time of issue of ration;
 In case of recovery of cash, whether such recovered amounts are timely deposited to the
Estate’s Cash;
 In case of deduction from wages in respect of sale value of ration, it should be checked the
amount credited in the Accounts Book are tallied with primary records I.e. computation as per
Ration Issue Register;
 Check the system of obtaining acknowledgement in the Ration Issue Register for issue of
ration.
c) Inventory of Food Stuff:
 Checking the inventory records with primary documents of receipts and issue;
 Whether there is system of regular physical verification of stock of food stuff (fortnightly/
monthly) and system of keeping records thereof;
 Review of the system of recording handling loss in the stock record – whether it is recorded
after each issue i.e. weekly/ fortnightly and whether such recording is made on the basis of
physical verification of stock or on an estimated basis;
 Comparative analysis of handling loss percentage for past 3/4 years to review the trend –in
case of abnormally high percentage( more than 0.5%)the reasons should be assessed;
 Review the system of adjustment of value of handling loss in the Accounts;
 Physical verification of food stuff is required to be carried out by the Internal Auditors in
course of Internal Audit in order to check the correctness of the records;
 Internal Audit should review and make comments on the storage facility of the food stuff as to
quality of storage facility as well as space;
 Review the holding of stock of foodstuff in terms of number of days’ consumption - stock
holding should not be more than the quantity required for one issue.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 134


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
CENSUS:
 Check the census records maintained by the Estate;
 Review the system of maintenance of census records – whether through computerized system
or in the form of permanent register maintained manually;
 Check that the census records contain the following information:
i) Name & of the workers,
ii) Sex,
iii) Age,
iv) Family/ Employee Code,
v) No. of dependants,
vi) Name of the dependants,
vii) Age of the dependants,
viii) Relationship of the dependants with the worker.
 Whether the census is conducted every year and every inclusion/ exclusion of the members of
the family of a worker due to death, birth or exodus from the garden is documented and
authenticated by the Garden Management with reference to the Hospital records /estate’s
personnel record;
 Whether the census records also contain labour house No. in which the labour and workers
are residing, so that the same can be co-related with the census records;
 In case of non-resident workers , whether details of the dependents included in the census
records are made on the basis of certificate issued by the Gram Panchayat or other appropriate
authority;
 Check that the workers’ family code is also incorporated in the Census Register, check that the
date of birth for dependents as per Census Register matches with the records as per
Dependants Muster;
 Compute the Land-Labour Ratio and compare the same with reference to the norms of the
Industry;
 Compare the Land-Labour Ratio for the current year with the same for the last 3 / 4 years and
to find whether any change in the ratio has taken place;
 In case of any change in the Land-Labour Ratio, to examine whether this change has created
any excess permanent labour force as compared to the norms of the Industry and to find out
the reasons for such change.
MEDICAL BENEFIT & EXPENDITURE:
Estate Hospital:
(i) Record Keeping:
 Whether the Garden’s Indoor Patient Register are maintained in compliance with the
provisions of Plantation Labour Act;
 Check the Hospital’s Indoor Patient Register with reference to Sick Leave Register and Garden’s
Dependents Muster in order to ascertain that no outsiders are admitted unauthorized in the
Hospital;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 135


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the Inpatient Registers are updated regularly;
 Whether permanent record is maintained for daily expenses on foods and provisions
consumed for in the Indoor patients of the estate hospital;
 Examine the following aspects of such Daily Expense Register –
a) Details of expenses are recorded therein ,
b) Whether this Daily Expense Registers are checked and signed regularly by the hospital
medical officer;
c) Whether daily expenses are commensurate with the numbers of inpatients.
d) In case, there is any per Head Budget for the daily expenses on food and provisions it
should be examined that the actual expenses remain within such budget;
 Test check daily purchases with the diet chart prescribed by the hospital medical officer and
examine that the registers are checked and signed regularly by the hospital medical officer.
(ii) Medicine Stock Register/Drug Register:
 Whether the medicine Stock Register/ Drug Registers are updated regularly and every Receipt/
Issue and balance after every transaction are recorded therein;
 Whether any Sub-Stock Register is maintained at Out-patient Dept (OPD);
 Examine the Sub-Stock Register maintained at OPD – whether the receipt from main stock and
issue of medicines to the patients are recorded daily indicating the medicines issued to the
individual patients;
 To reconcile issue of medicines shown in the Drug Register or in the Sub-Stock Register for OPD
(wherever maintained) with the medicines prescribed as per the Treatment Register
maintained at OPD on test basis;
 Whether a separate register is maintained at the Hospital for receipt and utilization of the
medicines and other medical assistance received by the Estate Hospital free of cost under any
Government Scheme;
 Examine the medicine stock register – whether this is regular checked and signed by the
Medical Officer;
 Conduct a physical check for medicine stock both of the main stock and stock at OPD with
reference to medicine stock registers and report if any discrepancy is found.
(iii) Record for Treatment at Out Patient Dept. (OPD):
 Whether the register specified under the Plantation Labour Act for the treatment of Garden
workers and their dependents in the Hospital OPD is maintained properly;
 Examine this register with reference to Garden Muster Roll for permanent/ casual muster and
dependent muster;
 Whether any person other than staff and workers and their dependants is given treatment – if
any person other than the staff/ workers and their dependants is given treatment, it should be
checked how the cost of treatment is recovered.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 136


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iv) Stock Register for Hospital Instrument, Linen, Utensils, etc.:
 Whether for items other than medicines i.e. for Linen, medical equipments/ gadgets etc. a
Stock Register is maintained and also updated regularly;
 Conduct a physical check of those items with reference to such register and report, if any,
discrepancy is found;
(v) Treatment at External Hospitals:
 Whether any record is maintained for referral cases to external hospitals like district hospitals,
specialty hospitals etc.
 Examine how many such cases have been referred to external hospitals , total expenditure
incurred on treatment and reasons for referring to external hospital;
 Examine how frequently the cases are referred to external hospitals;
 Review the mode of payment to such external hospitals- whether direct payment to hospitals
or reimbursement to the employees and record maintained for those payments in order to
keep control on such expenditure;
 Whether any limit of expenditure is fixed beyond which the workers have to bear the extra
expenses;
Hiring of Vehicles for carrying patients:
In the estates where any ambulance is not maintained or when the estate ambulance is not
available for any reason, vehicles are hired for transporting patients out of the estates to nearby
town either for pathological tests or for check up by specialist doctors at hospitals or in other
specified clinic. In that case, following aspects are required to be examined by Internal Audit to
keep control over such hiring of vehicles:
a) Fixation of rates for hire charges;
b) Records maintained for recording the particulars of hiring of vehicles i.e. date, destination,
number & names of the patients, name of the provider of the vehicle, vehicle no, bill no &
amount of hire charges etc.;
c) Reasons for hiring – whether justified or not;
d) Certification of the bills by the medical officer;
Bonus:
 Cross-check the names appearing in the Bonus Register with the names appearing in the Pay
Roll for the period to which such computation of Bonus is related;
 Where the Bonus is computed through computerized system, to check the computer program
used for computation of Bonus as regards linking of the Bonus Sheet with the Wage Sheet and
the formula followed for computation of Bonus;
 Check that the agreed percentage of Bonus is used for computation of Bonus;
 Where the computation of Bonus is done manually, to check the Bonus Sheet with the Wage
Sheet of the corresponding period, percentage of bonus used and the computation of Bonus;
 Check the records for disbursement of Bonus including records of acknowledgement of the
receipt of Bonus and same procedure is followed for disbursement of Bonus as is followed for
Wage.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 137


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Unpaid Wages & Bonus:
 Whether any wages which remains unpaid at the end of the day of wage payment, the
undistributed amount is refunded to the Estate’s Cash after completion of disbursement of
wages;
 Whether any record is kept for the unpaid wages for the respective days of wage payment;
 Check that disbursement of unpaid wages are made through the Unpaid Wages Register only
and the respective workers’ acknowledgement for receipt of wages is obtained in that Unpaid
Wage Register;
 Check that in respect of unpaid Bonus, the same procedure as in case of unpaid wages is
followed;
 Scrutinize the Accounting records in order to cross-check the amount of unpaid wages on a
particular day with the corresponding entry in the Accounting Records.
Maternity Leave:
 Whether the maternity leave record is maintained in compliance with the provisions of
Plantation Labour Act and that in the register at least the following information are available
against each beneficiary worker:-
a) Date of expected confinement ,
b) Date of commencement of absence from work ,
c) Amount of maternity benefit paid to individual worker ,
d) In whose presence the amount is paid etc.;
 Check that no beneficiary worker gets more than 12 weeks’ benefit;
 Reconciliation of amount of payment shown in accounting record and amount of payment
according to maternity leave register.
Sick Leave:
 Whether the Sick Leave Register is maintained in the hospital according to relevant provisions
of Plantation Labour Act;
 Test check the Sick Leave Register with respect to hospital records;
 Whether the Sick Allowances are paid complying with the rules of the respective State made
under The Plantation Labour Act;
 Check that while paying sick allowances first day of sickness is excluded;
 Check the sick allowance payment register and reconcile the same with the accounting
records.
PAYMENT OF GRATUITY:
 Review the status of unpaid Gratuity to the retired employees/ dependants of expired
employees – to check the reasons for Gratuity remaining unpaid;
 Whether notices are sent to the retired employees or to the nominee of expired employee for
payment of Gratuity copying with the Payment of Gratuity Act within the time stipulated in the
Act;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 138


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the Gratuity Register is maintained properly and all payments are recorded up to date
therein;
 Check the mode of payment – whether by cheque or by cash - in case of payment by cash, to
check whether the disbursements are made after proper verification of identity of the payee;
 In case of death , whether copies of succession certificate have been obtained before
disbursement of gratuity;
 Whether monthly returns are submitted in time;
 Review the system of obtaining the nomination forms from the employees.
III. Materials Management:
Materials Management function includes various sub-functions like purchase, storage and
management of the stored items, which is to be reviewed, as detailed below:

Purchase – General:
Internal Audit of Purchase function requires the following aspects to be covered:
 To begin with it should be checked that the business entity to be audited has any well defined
Purchase Policy covering all items of purchase including capital items ,items to be purchased
locally at the estate level , different types contract to be awarded in connection with the
operation of the estate etc.;
 The Purchase Policy of the business entity is required to be reviewed in order to ensure that
the same is adhered to while making purchase –both at H.O. and Estate level;
 Whether there is clear demarcation of broad group of items which are to be procured at H.O.
level and items which are to be procured at Estate level;
 Whether there is any system of placing indents/ Purchase Requisition on Purchase Dept. being
approved by appropriate level of authority and purchasing actions are taken only on the basis
of such indents;
 It should be examined that –
(i) The Policy and procedures for selection of vendors, placement of orders and monitoring
the movement, inspection, receipt and return of goods is to be reviewed for improvement
of the same or to remove any deficiency. Normally there are separate procedures for local
and centralized purchases;
(ii) Where a purchase committee exists, whether meeting of the committee has taken place
at regular intervals and recommendations have been acted upon;
(iii) Whether the established system for purchase has been adhered to for placing orders etc.;
(iv) Whether documentation of the actions taken has been done, as per the existing system of
record maintenance;
(v) On receipt of the purchased item, whether entry has been made in the stores ledger, after
proper inspection and the invoice has been sent to the finance department for payment.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 139


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
a) Whether procurement of major items like agricultural inputs i.e. manures, weedicides,
pesticides, different types of micro-nutrients, different chemicals required for rubber
processing, packing materials, major machinery spares, etc. are centralized at H.O. or
decentralized at Estate level;
b) Whether any item-wise/ product-wise approved Vendors’ Lists are prepared and
methodology followed for preparing such Vendors’ Lists. It should be seen that such
Vendors’ Lists are broad-based;
c) Whether agricultural inputs, major rubber processing chemicals and other branded
items including spare-parts of different machines, vehicles , electrical goods are
procured directly from the respective manufacturers of such items or from their
authorized dealers – to check that list of authorized dealers are maintained;
 To examine the pending Purchase Indents in order to find whether there is any abnormal gap
between placement of indents and initiation of Purchase Procurement action and to report the
reasons for indents pending for abnormally long time;
 In case of policy of decentralized purchase, method of selection of sources at the Estate level
needs to be examined – whether any policy or procedure has been formulated by the
Corporate for preparation of list of vendors at Estate level in order to maintain internal control
over the purchases;
 Reviewing the system of deciding the specification/ brands of different items to be purchased
– both at H.O. level and Estate level;
 For purchase of HSD, Insecticides, Weedicides, Chemicals used in rubber manufacturing
process, consumable stores of bulk consumption, to check whether any minimum and
maximum stock level is fixed and maintained;
 Whether the vendors’ lists are reviewed from time to time with a view to inducting new
sources of purchases i.e. specifically manufacturers or their authorized distributors/dealers
and deleting the non-performing/ redundant sources;
 Whether enquiries are sent to multiple sources to ensure competitive prices;
 To check that in the enquiries sent to prospective vendors, detail specification, name of the
manufacturers or Brand name (in case of purchase of branded items) of the item(s) to be
procured are specifically mentioned;
 It should also be examined that in the enquiries, following commercial points are also included:
1) Last date of submission of offer;
2) Schedule of delivery;
3) Taxes & duties - to be indicated by the vendor;
4) Terms of payment;
5) Warranty Clause;
6) Penalty Clause;
 Examine the method of fixation of price for all major items or items of regular purchase –
whether on the basis of last purchase rate or rate contract based on one-time quotations or on

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 140


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
the basis of quotations obtained at the time of purchase or on the basis of manufacturers’
price list;
 Where the same branded items like electrical & mechanical items, insecticides, different
consumable stores, etc. are purchased frequently from the local Dealers/ Distributors of the
manufacturers and P.O.s are placed on the basis of manufacturers’ Price Lists, it should be
checked that copies of the manufacturers’ Price Lists prevailing at the time of purchase are
available with the Estate;
 Whether offers regarding discount available on manufacturer’s Price List have been obtained
from the Dealers/ Distributors;
 In case of procurement of any item of a particular brand in bulk, it should also be checked
whether availability of multiple sources are explored and offers are obtained from them;
 Whether the organization being audited follows the system of referring to the last rate of
purchase before finalizing the current purchase price;
 Whether the organization being audited has the system of checking the current market rate
where any item is procured at an old rate for a considerable period of time – say, for a period
of more than a year;
 Whether Purchase Orders are numbered manually or numbers are generated through
computer or pre-numbered Purchase Order Forms are used;
 If P.Os are prepared manually and P.O. forms are not pre-numbered, a register is maintained for
recording the particulars of all the P.Os chronologically and P.O. Nos. are assigned
chronologically;
 To examine that P.Os placed on vendors include in addition to rates, standard terms like rates of
taxes, point of delivery, delivery schedule, terms of payment, LD Clause (wherever
possible),freight, Insurance, mode of transport, price variation clause ( if any), advance (if any),
inspection clause (if required), guarantee/warranty (in case of machinery spares, etc.), earliest
date of manufacturing and minimum shelf life of pesticides, weedicides, chemicals, etc. and in
case of rate contract, validity period of such rate contract;
 Where the purchases are made on the basis of manufacturer’s Price List, to check whether the
rate of discount is clearly mentioned in the Purchase Orders; it should also be checked whether
the prices mentioned in the P.O. are inclusive of VAT, and if not, whether rate of VAT is
mentioned;
 Whether the validity of rate contracts are mentioned in the P.Os. in case of purchases made on
the basis of rate contracts;
 Whether any purchase has been made at a price more than rates approved by Head Office;
 Review the cases of purchases made without obtaining any quotation or Price List;
 Whether the same item has been purchased at different rates from different vendors at the
same point of time or within short span of time without any valid reason;
 Scrutinize the cases of procurement of materials from single sources and report on the reasons
thereof including the methodology followed for ensuring the reasonableness of the prices;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 141


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether multiple P.Os have been placed on the same vendor for the same item within a short
span of time and to examine the reason thereof;
 Examine the pending Purchase Orders for reporting the cases of overdue orders along with the
reasons thereof; to examine the system of monitoring the status of completion of supply
against individual purchase order;
 Whether P.Os have been placed on the vendor for item (s) even before completion of delivery
against earlier P.Os placed on the same vendor for the same item (s);
 Whether the delivery of materials have been made by the suppliers as stipulated in the
respective POs in general; it should also be examined that whether any delay in delivery has
caused urgent purchase of materials at higher price to meet the shortfall caused by such delay
or any loss of crop in case of delay in delivery of agricultural inputs like insecticides and
manure in particular;
 Make a sample checking of actual delivery of materials with reference to terms and conditions
of the respective Purchase Orders and whether Liquidated Damages, if applicable, have been
recovered from the vendors;
 Whether the materials procured on the basis of urgent indents have been consumed
immediately on receipt of the same;
 Make a sample checking of the Purchase Orders for finding whether the procurement actions
are in compliance with the formulated Purchase Policy;
 Check the cases of local purchases whether such purchases are made in line with the policy
and procedure formulated by the Corporate for such purchases;
 Whether any purchase have been made on the basis of verbal order; In case any purchase is
made on verbal order, circumstances under which such purchase has been made should be
examined;
 Examine that materials required to be purchased from H.O. only as per Company’s policy has
not been purchased locally; in case such items are purchased locally due to any exigency, to
examine that such purchases are made on obtaining approval from H.O. and cost of
procurement is not higher than the H.O. approved rates;
 Compare the consumption pattern of agricultural inputs ,chemicals, packing materials,
consumable stores with the quantum of purchase in order to find out whether any excess
procurement is made which may result in carrying a dead stock or blockage of working capital;
 Review the policy and procedure for handling the vendors whose performance is
unsatisfactory or who have failed to perform.
Stores function:
(i) The Policy and procedures for stores management shall be reviewed;
(ii) Whether issues have been made only on the basis of properly authorized (as per established
policy) requisitions and the issues have been properly receipted. Similarly whether receipts
have been done after proper inspection and authorization. Whether the tools and
implements issued for a particular work has been returned in good condition and recorded
in the stores ledger, needs to be verified and any delay in returning shall be enquired into;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 142


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iii) Whether the minimum and maximum stock levels are regularly monitored to prevent stock
out or excess stocking;
(iv) Whether orders have been placed for the economic order quantity, unless an order for a
higher or lower quantity has been authorized with proper justification;
(v) Whether the storage space is optimally utilized and the stores are systematically organized
with items and their locations identified by unique codes (may be alpha-numeric), which are
also mentioned in the stores ledger for their easy identification;
(vi) Whether a priced stores ledger is maintained at the stores and updated after every
movement;
(vii) Whether the utilities for measurement (weighing scales etc.) are maintained properly and
calibrated at regular intervals by accredited agencies;
(viii) Whether proper house-keeping is being done (to maintain cleanliness, sufficient lighting
and ventilation, proper protection of the stored items from moisture, heat etc., easy
accessibility of the stored items, minimizing the chances of poisonous reptiles and insects
entering the stores, regular inspection for out-of-date items and their removal from the
storage space with proper authorization and recording in the stores ledger and spoilage,
leakage etc. are being properly reported and recorded in the stores ledger);
(ix) Whether periodical physical verification of stock is being made and adjustment for shortage
and excess has been done under proper authorization;
(x) Whether slow and non-moving items are being periodically identified and treated in
accordance with an established policy or under proper authorization;
(xi) Whether fire fighting arrangement exists and is effective;
(xii) Whether sufficient security is provided against theft (like restricting entry to the storage
area and placement of security guards);
(xiii) Stock of tea plants and shade tree plants are kept at the nursery. Record of samplings
purchased, died, issued and balance shall be verified. The purchase and issues shown in
these records shall be verified by cross-reference with purchase records and utilization at
various sections and if an abnormal number of tea plants have died, justification shall be
obtained and steps taken;
(xiv) Stock of green leaves: Although the green leaves do not remain in stock for long, the
weighment record at the garden, the quantity received at the factory, the quantity sold,
quantity issued for production should be reconciled;
(xv) Stock of tea waste and scrap: Review the management control and verify whether the
control procedures have been complied with.

Inventory Control:
To examine the system maintenance of inventory records – whether it is fully computerized or
maintained manually or partially computerized and partially manual. In case the system of
maintenance of inventory records in computerized form, computerized system and the computer
program followed need to be examined whether proper internal control exists;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 143


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the method of receipts of materials at Stores –
(i) Whether the copy of the relevant Purchase Order reaches Stores before receipt of material
or the Stores receives the material even without obtaining concerned Purchase Order;
(ii) Whether every receipt of material is recorded in a Log Sheet or in a Daily Material Inward
Register or logged in the computer in case of computerized system before preparation of
the receipt documents;
(iii) Examine that the quantity of each receipt of material ( be it number, volume or weight ) is
verified as mentioned in the Supply Challan or Invoice before accepting the material;
(iv) Whether there is a system of inspection before accepting the material at Stores;
(v) Whether the suppliers’ challans / Invoices are treated as document for receipt of material
or there is a system of preparation of Goods Receipt Note (GRN);
(vi) Where there is no system of preparation of GRN, it is required to be verified that the copies
of suppliers challan/ Invoices are chronologically filed and chronologically assigned serial
number (according to the date of receipt) and linked to the Material Log Sheet/ Inward
Register;
(vii) In case of short receipt of material, it should be checked that the suppliers’ challan/
Invoices are corrected immediately;
(viii) whether receipt of materials are recorded in the respective copies of Purchase Orders
received by the Stores before receipt of the material to keep a track over the status
execution of orders or the status of supply is monitored through the computerized system
used;
 In case of chemicals, it should be checked that the date of expiry of the materials supplied
are examined at the time of receipt of material;
 Check the methods of dealing with the supply of defective materials – whether the materials
is returned accompanied by the suppliers challan/ invoice or the challan/ invoices are kept on
‘HOLD’ till the defective/ rejected materials are replaced by the suppliers;
 Check that all materials are issued against properly authorized Stores Issue Requisition(SIR);
 Whether separate Stores Issue Requisitions (SIR) are prepared for materials to be used by
different Cost Centers like Field/ Factory/ Laboratory/ Office/ Hospital/Repair & Maintenance
(Electrical, Mechanical, Civil separately), Vehicles, Capital, etc.
 Whether all Issue Requisitions are checked by the respective Asst. Manager in Charge and
sanctioned by the Manager of the Estate;
 Check that all SIRs are pre-numbered and examine the method of control over the issue of
SIR books to different Cost Centers and ensure that all unused SIR books are kept in safe
custody;
 To check that records for issue of blank SIR books with a specified range of pre-printed serial
numbers to respective Cost Centers are kept;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 144


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether there is a system of maintaining the Bin Cards or quantitative Stores Ledger in the
Stores either through manual system or through computerized system and ensure that all
receipts and issue documents are promptly recorded in the respective Bin Card/ Quantitative
Stores Ledger;
 Verify the postings/ entry in the Bin Card/ Quantitative Stores Ledger with reference to the
receipt and issue documents;
 Whether there is any backlog in postings/ entry in the Bin Card/ Quantitative Stores Ledger;
 Check the methods of valuation used for valuation of receipts and issues in the Valued Stores
Ledger in order to ensure that all related cost of procurements are considered in the cost;
 Whether the receipts of all direct materials and packing materials are valued net of VAT paid
where input credit on VAT is available;
 Physical verification of Stores and stock are carried out in a phased manner covering all the
materials;
 Check the frequency of physical verification of high value materials like agricultural inputs,
chemicals, machinery spares, etc.;
 Check that the shortage/ excess found in course of physical verification are properly
reconciled and recorded in the Stores record;
 Examine the Bin Cards for verification of utilization/rate of consumption of different stores;
 Examine whether there is any system of regular review of the stock holding of different
materials to ensure that neither there is any over-stocking nor there is any Stock-out
situation, particularly of agricultural inputs, production chemicals, etc.;
 Whether there is any proper system of regular assessment of status of slow-moving/ non-
moving items;
 Review that regular check is maintained on the expiry dates of shelf life of insecticides,
weedicides and other chemicals;
 Whether unconsumed agricultural inputs returned to the Stores from Field at the end of the
day are recorded in the Bin Card/ Quantity Stores Ledger;
 Whether any Sub-Store is maintained in the Division/ Factory for materials consumed at
those point or materials are issued from the main Stores only;
 In case any Sub-Store is maintained, to check the records of receipt and issue of materials at
Sub-Store and reconcile the same with the records at the main Stores;
 To examine the state of the physical stores keeping of different items in the Stores – whether
there is any possibility of damage to different items of stores either due to moisture from the
floor (particularly in case of fertilizer) or from seepage of water through the roof, etc;
 Examine the lay-out of the Stores – whether different class of materials are kept properly
segregated with proper identification;
 Check the system and procedures followed for the security of the Stores;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 145


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the system and method of measurement followed for issue of different materials,
particularly of chemicals, petrol, HSD, etc.
Coal – for manufacturing of Tea:
 Check the Stores record pertaining to receipt, issue and stock of coal;
 Whether periodic physical verification of the Stock of Coal is carried out;
 Whether calorific value of each consignments of coal received is tested for comparison with
the calorific value of the grade of coal to be supplied as per the corresponding Purchase
Orders;
 Examine the average consumption of Coal per Kg. of Made Tea and to make a comparative
study for consecutive 2 – 3 years including the year under audit;
 Whether any quantity of Coal has been required to be written off due to poor quality due to
high mud content or due to containing stones.
Gas – for manufacturing of Tea only:
 Whether any record is maintained for daily consumption of Gas in the factory for running
the Drier and for heating air for Withering Trough;
 Compare the consumption of Gas as shown in the monthly bills sent by Gas supply agencies
with the consumption record maintained in the factory, if any;
 Analyze the comparative figure for consumption of Gas per Kg. of Made Tea for consecutive
2 -3 years;
IV. Finance & Accounts Function
At the outset, it is required to be examined both at Estate and Corporate Office whether
accounting records are processed and maintained through computerized system or partially
computerized system or fully manual. Depending on the extent of computerization, the
methodology and extent of checking by Internal Auditor have been decided.
In the organization where the total accounts and finance function are fully computerized i.e. from
originating stage of processing payment vouchers (be it through Cash or Bank) and the vouchers
for booking of expenditure or the liability for expenditure to the end i.e. maintenance of various
records and various reports, Internal Audit function begins with the examination of the
computerized system and the program used for this purpose and for this, the following aspects
are required to be checked:
 Whether Internal control exists at all stages;
 Check the program used, modules for Finance and Accounts function is inter-linked to other
modules used for Manpower deployment record, Wage administration, Inventory
management, Sales invoicing including record for dispatch of finished goods, Purchase etc.;
 To check that there is no provision for unauthorized manual intervention in the system;
 Check the security of the system.
Budgetary control system:
(i) Whether a budgetary control system is being followed, if so, the budgets (including cash
budget) and forecasts prepared for the year is to be reviewed by comparing with the previous

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 146


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
year;
(ii) Whether there has been any variation between the budgeted and forecasted amount and
actual amount;
(iii) Whether the variance has been analyzed in depth and sanction has been obtained for the
variance.
Working Capital management:
The operating cycle of Tea /Coffee/ Rubber plantation and manufacturing is larger than many
other industries, thus requiring large working capital. This working capital is primarily funded by
the revenue receipts, working capital/short term loans, and delaying payment to sundry creditors
and other liabilities. In this context the internal auditor needs to check:
(i) Fund from various sources are readily available: The fund released from the Corporate/Head
office is credited to the bank instantly, the recovery in cash from the labourers on issue of
ration etc. at subsidized rate, cash from retail sales counter at the estate and other cash
receipts are deposited to central cash on the same day and the cheques/drafts are deposited
to the bank without delay;
(ii) Any receivable which has become due but not received shall be stringently followed up;
(iii) Any fund locked in the form of a deposit, which is no longer necessary or an investment
which is not earning at the desired rate, shall be withdrawn;
(iv) Maximum time available for payment, without attracting any interest or penalty for delayed
payment, shall be availed before payment is made;
(v) Yearly cash budget shall be supplemented with monthly cash budgets to assess the
requirement of fund and the sources of the fund, making advance provision for any shortfall;
(vi) Whether the issues related to fund management are being properly administered by the
Management.
Cash Receipts and Cash Management:
Internal auditor has to check whether good cash receipts systems, policies and procedures existed
in the company. Ineffective cash management, including billing and collection, affects cash flows
and can impact a company’s overall productivity. The late billing of customers and slow pays will
extend interest free loans to customers. Poor procedures to reconcile aging accounts and overdue
collection allow bad debts to increase. Poor internal control of cash/cheque receipts and payment
may lead to various types of fraud.
Administration of cash and cheques:
(i) Verify the system of administration of cash and records maintained to form an opinion on
their efficacy;
(ii) Check whether there is a policy for cash retention (fixed amount or based on requirement
arising from time to time) and whether the amount of cash in the cash box in excess of the
maximum retention amount has been deposited into the bank in the following day;
(iii) Whether fidelity insurance and a cash-in-transit insurance have been taken and are in force;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 147


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(iv) Whether the cash is counted at the end of every day and check whether cash in hand is kept
in a safe or in locked drawer in order to minimize the risk of loss due to theft from robbery or
employees;
(v) Where there is a system of imprest cash examine the imprest cash book;
(vi) Whether Cash receipt are deposited in the bank the daily;
(vii) Whether excess cash was not lying in a non-interest-bearing account;
(viii) Check that the entries in Cash & Bank Book always remain updated;
(ix) Whether any payment to the suppliers of materials and other services, contractors, are made
directly without routing through Creditors Ledger;
(x) Whether the cheque books are kept under proper custody, proper record is being kept of the
cheques issued and periodical reconciliation of the cheques issued is being done;
(xi) Check who are the authorized signatories for the bank accounts;
(xii) Whether two person signatures are necessary for cheque payment;
(xiii) Whether cheques are numerically sequenced to account for internal checks and control;
(xiv) Whether signature plates and electronic signature methods safeguarded from unauthorized
access.
(xv) Have old signature plates been disposed of properly;
(xvi) Electronic signature plates need to be secured and a proper segregation of duties
established between cheques preparer and printer;
(xvii) Whether cheques drawn were sent to the parties or lying with company;
(xviii) Whether there are an excessive number of bank accounts due to the lack of closing
procedures.
Cash Vouching:
 Check that no payment is made without the approval of the authority/ authorities and who is /
are authorized for approval of such expenditure;
 Examine the system of numbering the Payment Vouchers in order to ensure existence of
proper internal control system;
 Examine the authenticity and propriety of the expenditure with the supporting documents;
 In case of Cash payments, to check that proper acknowledgements are obtained from the
Payees on the Payment Vouchers.
Physical Verification of Cash:
 Carry out the surprise check of cash by the Internal Auditor;
 Examine that regular cash verification is carried out by the Management, at least once or twice
in a week;
 Whether proper record of physical cash verification is maintained;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 148


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the records of cash verification bears the signature of the person dealing with Cash
and the Manager of the Estate.
Bank Reconciliation Statement (BRS):
 Whether there is any backlog in the preparation of Bank Reconciliation system - if any backlog
is found in the preparation of BRS, to examine the reason for delay;
 Check that the original copy of the Bank Statements are always available at the Estate;
 Where Bank Statements are down-loaded (in case where e-banking system is in existence), to
check that regular confirmation of balance is obtained from the Bank;
 Examine the Bank Reconciliation Statements, whether any un-reconciled Debit or Credit
balance appears in the BRS -if any such entry appears, such cases are required to be examined
and it would be checked whether those cases have been properly taken up and followed up
with the Bank;
 Any Cheque which has been issued but has become stale, does not appear in the BRS;
 If there is any case where any Cheque/ Draft or any other negotiable instrument has been
deposited with the Bank for realization but remains unrealized for a considerable period of
time, say for a month, to examine whether such cases are followed up properly with the Bank.
System of Booking Liability and Processing the Bills for Payment:
 Check the system of making payment to the suppliers/ service providers/ workshops, etc. –
whether payment is made directly charging the respective head of accounts or payments are
made after booking the liability for payment;
 Check the system of booking liabilities for payment on account of Purchase of goods and other
services - it should be examined whether the cost of purchase of goods / services are booked in
the Accounts on the basis of the basic documents pertaining to receipt of goods in the Stores (
i.e. Suppliers’ challans or GRNs ) or on receipt of services or on the basis of bills only after
those are submitted by the Vendors;
 Where cost of purchase and other services are booked in the Accounts on the basis of the
Suppliers’ / Service provider’s bills instead of basic documents relating to procurement of such
goods and services, it should be examined how this is tackled in case of delay in receiving such
bills;
 Check the treatment of taxes, duties and other elements of expenditure like freight, Insurance,
octroi, loading/ unloading charges , etc in accounting of the liability for purchase cost of goods
and services;
 Check the system of booking liability for payment in the Creditors Sub-ledger – whether
simultaneously with the booking of corresponding expenditure in the Accounts or after receipt
of bills from the Vendors;
 Where the liabilities are booked in the Creditors Ledger only after bills are submitted by the
vendors, the system followed for cross-checking the liability booked in the main accounts and
the liability booked in the Creditors Sub-ledger is required to be examined;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 149


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the Creditors Ledger, all the unpaid bills can be identified from the Creditors’ Ledger
or Liability Register at any point of time;
 Whether the ‘Inward Bill Register’ containing the following information in respect of bills
submitted by the suppliers, different workshops & other service providers are maintained:
(i) Sl. No.,
(ii) Date of receipt of the bill,
(iii) Name of the supplier/Service Provider/Workshop,
(iv) Bill No. & Date,
(v) Amount,
(vi) Purchase Order/ Works Order No.,
(vii) Amount for which the bill is finally passed;
(viii) Date of passing the bill;
(ix) Date of booking liability.
 In case, where computerized system is in use, to check that all such bills are logged into the
system for recording of ‘Inward Bills’ and the computerized system also contain the
information referred to the preceding Para;
 To check that for future reference and internal control as well, there is a system of tagging
the incoming bills either with the corresponding entries in the Inward Bill Register or with
the reference of logging bills into the computerized system;
 Check the system of receiving bills – whether the bills are received by any Management staff;
 Whether all bills are recorded in ‘Incoming Bill Register’ or logged into the system (in case of
computerized system in use;
 Examine the system followed by the estate to ensure that liabilities are provided in Creditors
Ledger in respect of all incoming bills;
 Examine the system of verifying the suppliers’ bills with reference to the documents relating
to the receipts of materials which may be either the Excise Invoice/ original Challan endorsed
by the Stores personnel acknowledging the receipt of material or Goods Receipt Note (GRN)
prepared by Stores and also with the corresponding Purchase Order;
 It should be ensured that there is necessary internal control in the procedure followed for
verifying the bills, so that multiple bills cannot be processed for payment against a single
receipt;
 While processing the bills for payment, whether there is a system of checking that all the
terms & conditions of the Purchase Order has been adhered to;
 Whether at the time of passing the bills, relevant statutory requirements pertaining to State
VAT, Income Tax, Service Tax and other statutory requirements, if any applicable, are
complied with;
 In respect of Service Contracts of Annual Maintenance for different machines or other
facilities, it should be examined that while processing the bills of Service providers for
payment necessary certification of fulfillment of terms of contract is checked;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 150


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the bills submitted by the Contractors are processed for payment on the basis of
progress of work as measured and certified in the Joint Measurement Sheet/ Measurement
Book maintained by the estate for recording the quantum of job done by the Contractors in
respect of individual contracts;
 To ensure that the person who verifies the vendors’ bills put his initial on the bills as a proof
of verification of the bills;
 Whether there is a system of authorizing the payment of the passed bills by local authority
empowered by the Corporate Management for the purpose;
 Whether any advance paid to the vendors/contractors/service providers is adjusted against
the liability for payment according to the terms of relevant Purchase Order / Contract and
there is sufficient internal control procedure in this regard;
 Check the system of preserving the bills processed but unpaid and also to review the system
of exerting control over the bills against which payments have been made;
 Examine the system of processing any duplicate bill for payment where the original bill is lost
or misplaced - to ensure that necessary internal check is exercised to ward off the chance of
any double payment – to check there is a system of obtaining an undertaking from the
concerned vendor for indemnifying in case any double payment is detected;
 Examine the system of preparation of vouchers for payment to vendors in order to ensure
that normal internal control procedure applicable to the disbursement of payments including
the levels of authority specified by the Corporate in respect of such payments are followed;
 Examine the system of reconciliation between the outstanding balance in the Creditors Sub-
ledger and the unpaid suppliers’ bills available in the Estate;
 Examine the system of control exercised over the partly paid bills regarding the payment of
the balance unpaid part.

Accounts Payable/Cash Disbursements


Internal audits in Accounts payable/ cash disbursement usually lead to cost savings through best
practices, retrieving duplicate payments and tightening controls to minimize error and potential
fraud.
 Internal auditor has to review the company’s cash disbursements system to ensure that
appropriate controls are in place to reduce errors.
 In the case of disbursements internal auditor has to do data mining to further examine
disbursement trends and search for duplicate payments. The cash disbursement process in
any company usually has the highest risk due to the amount of company funds involved.
 Internal auditor has to check the list of officers who are authorize to make purchases and
expenditure;
 Whether any internal control process is performed before payment to ascertain that only
authorized goods and services are being paid after proper verifications documents and
vendor invoices;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 151


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether preventative control system exist to prevent duplicate payments and lost discounts;
 The accounts payable process must have controls over methods of payment (cheque, wire,
credit) that include matching authorized purchases to receipt of goods or services and to the
vendor’s invoice;
Accounts payable:
 Verify the individual accounts of creditors for purchases with the purchase invoice and the
payment details;
 Correlate the purchase invoice with the purchase order, road challan, and entry at the gate,
inspection report and receipt by the store-keeper;
 Verify whether any returns have been properly accounted for and adjustment in the amount
due, has been made;
 Where cash discounts are available, whether decision has been taken at proper level of
hierarchy to ascertain ,whether payment is made early to avail the discount, whether
discount has been availed and entry made in the creditor’s account;
 Verify the amount payable to the brokers in case of auction sale by referring to the auction
house sales statement, discount allowed, agreement with the broker and broker’s note;
 Verify the other creditors for expenses by referring to the authorization for such expenses
(which shall mention the nature of work, name of person whom the work is assigned and the
payment and other terms and conditions), certificate for completion of the work by proper
authority, any deduction to be made as per such certificate and payment details (like cheque
or other instrument issued or advice issued for fund transfer, bank statement and receipt
issued);
 Whether payments have been made after proper authorization and where payment has
been made in cash, whether the recipient is properly identified and is authorized by the
creditor.
 Where balance confirmation has been sought by the party, whether there is a dispute and
whether it has been resolved under proper authorization. The internal auditor in case of
doubt over any balance of debtors may seek balance confirmation from the debtor.
Accounts Receivable
Lack of aging and managing accounts receivable prevented the company from identifying slow
pays, enforcing customers’ credit limits and identifying customers to be contacted by the
collection department. In addition, this lack of record keeping can also hide an employee kiting
accounts, which entails borrowing between accounts to cover up embezzlement. The Internal
auditor has to check the following:
 Whether all sales being recorded and collected;
 Whether the company has proper segregation of duties for sales, recording, collections and
deposit functions;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 152


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 In case company hired a collection agency, is there a reconciliation process of accounts out
for collection and amounts that been collected and returned;
 Whether all invoices are accurate and billed on a timely basis.
 Internal auditor has to investigate and to recommend solutions to tighten controls in these
areas.
(i) Verify the accounts of debtors by referring to the sales invoice and details of receipt
(like cheque or other instrument received and deposited into bank, advice for fund
transfer, bank statements and copy of money receipt issued).
(ii) Verify whether account confirmation is obtained from the debtors and any difference is
sorted out under proper authorization.
(iii) Whether any collection mechanism is in place and whether it is active.
(iv) Whether age-analysis of debtors are being done and in respect of dues exceeding the
credit period as per the general/special terms and conditions, what steps have been
taken for collection of the amount due. Bad debt not written off will result in overpaid
income taxes, sales bonuses and commissions.

Scrutiny of Advance:
Advance given to staff and employees:
 Examine the records maintained in respect of advance given to workers, staff and
management staff;
 Whether a single record is maintained for advances given to an employees for different
purposes i.e. for Salary, Medical, Festival, Travelling, other official purposes etc. or separate
records are maintained;
 Examine the system of maintaining the records by which the advance given to individual
workers/ employees vis-à-vis its recovery and outstanding advances are easily identifiable
from such records;
 To check that regular recovery of advance is made according to the terms of approval of the
advance;
 To scrutinize the record for advance – whether any advance remains unadjusted/ un-
recovered for a substantial period of time and also to find out the reasons for such advances
remaining un-recovered/ unadjusted;
 Whether any advance remains unadjusted/ unrecovered in respect of any superannuated or
deceased ex-employee or who has left the services or whose service has been terminated
and also to find out the reasons for such non-adjustment. Whether there are any dues of
such employee from which those outstanding advances can be adjusted/ recovered.
Advance paid to suppliers, service providers, contractors & for miscellaneous purposes:
 Examine the system of keeping records in respect of advances paid to suppliers, service
providers, contractors and for other miscellaneous purposes;
 Whether payment of advance, recovery of advance and balance of unadjusted advances are
clearly exhibited in subsidiary Ledger/ Register;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 153


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check the system of reconciliation between the Estate’s monthly accounts and the subsidiary
ledger/ register for advance – whether such reconciliations are made regularly, at least
monthly;
 Examine the cases of individual advances given to the suppliers, service providers,
contractors, etc, whether such advances were paid in compliance with the terms of orders
placed on them;
 Whether the recovery is made in accordance with the terms of the orders;
 Whether any advance remains unadjusted for a substantial period of time without any valid
reason;
 In case of payment of advance to the contractors, to check that Income-Tax is being deducted
at source from such advance according to the provisions of Income Tax Act;
 In case of bulk purchase of HSD oil or TD Oil from the Oil marketing companies, to check that
regular reconciliation is done between the amount of advance paid and the value of the
corresponding bills raised by the oil companies and also to find that regular recovery is made
of excess advance paid, if any;
 Examine the cases of advances paid for miscellaneous other purposes as to the purpose of
the advances and their timely recovery.
Power & Fuel:
Electricity:
 Examine the records maintained for consumption of electricity at the Estate;
 Whether separate records are maintained for consumption of electricity ( in terms of number
of Units, i.e. Kwh ) for manufacturing and for other purpose like consumption in Office,
Bungalow, Hospital, Street Lighting, Staff Quarters, etc.;
 Whether there is separate KWH Meters for supply to the factory and supply to other points
and consumption of unit is recorded on the basis of the meter reading of the individual
meters;
 Where there is single KWH Meter for Grid supply from Power Supply Agency, to check
whether sub-meters are installed for recording consumption in manufacturing and
consumption for other purposes;
 If separate sub-meters are not installed, the basis followed for allocation of electricity
consumption between manufacturing and other purposes should be checked;
 Where there are separate rates charged by the Electricity Board for consumption in
manufacturing and domestic consumption and there is single KWH Meter, the reason for not
having separate Meter should be examined;
 In a Rubber Estate, it should be examined whether separate Sub-Meters are installed for
recording the electricity consumption for different lines of production as follows:
1) For Cenex i.e. Centrifuged Latex Centrifuge
2) Skim Crepe Skim Rollers/ Skim Milling & Skim Pressing
3) Crumb Production Crumb Drier, Crumb Milling & Crumble Pressing

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 154


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(This is required for computing the cost of power for different lines of productions)
 Whether the readings of the Sub-meters recorded in the Estate’s own records are reconciled
with the readings of the main meter, as mentioned in the bills sent by Electric supply
agencies;
 Examine the bills of the Electric supply agencies as to the following aspects:
a) Whether any extra charge is paid due to lower power factor;
b) Whether any penalty/additional charge is payable due to running the factory at higher
load than the maximum load declared to the electricity supply agency;
c) If there is any findings on scrutiny of the electric bills, as mentioned in Clause (a)& (b)
above, to examine the corrective actions taken by the estate;
 To check the records maintained for consumption of electricity supplied through Grid and to
check whether the period of disruption in Grid supply, if any, is recorded;
Captive Generation of Power:
 Whether Log Books are maintained for individual generators installed at the Estate;
 Examine the Log Book whether following information are recorded therein:
a) Date;
b) Hours run;
c) Consumption of Fuel;
d) Units generated.
 Where HSD is used as fuel, to check whether opening stock, receipt from Stores , closing
stock and consumption is recorded in the Log Book on day-to-day basis;
 Where natural gas is used as fuel, to check whether separate meter is installed for recording
the consumption of gas for running generators;
 Whether separate Kwh meter is installed for recording the captive generation or generators
are connected through the same Kwh meters connected with the Grid supply by State
Electricity Boards/ Power Supply agencies;
 Where same KWH meter is used for recording the consumption from Grid supply as well as
from captive generation, to check whether proper reading of the meter is taken whenever
generator is run;
 Whether any average fuel efficiency of the individual generators are computed by the Estate
at regular interval i.e. at the end of each month and also at the end of the year considering
the following parameters:
a) No. of Units generated per unit of fuel consumption;
b) Quantity of fuel consumed per hour run;
c) Cost of generation per Unit.
 Compare the fuel efficiency figures of each generator for consecutive 4 – 5 years including
year under audit and to analyze the reasons for variation, if any;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 155


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Check the receipts of HSD as shown in the Log Book with the corresponding issue shown in
the Stores record;
 Cross-check the period of running of generators recorded in the Log Book with the period of
disruption of Grid supply, as recorded in the relevant record of consumption of electricity
from Grid supply
 Whether generator of lower capacity is run to provide supply of electricity to Bungalows,
Hospitals, etc. when the factory is not operative (This analysis is required for
rationalization/economization of fuel used in captive generation);
 Whether separate records are maintained for consumption of captively generated power for
manufacturing and other purposes;
 Review the unit of electricity consumed (taking Grid supply and captive generation together)
per Unit of finished product) and to make a comparative study of these figures for
consecutive 4 – 5 years.
Travel and Entertainment Policy
 Whether there is a written travel and entertainment policy and it comply with tax laws;
 Whether the lowest fares and best discounts are being obtained;
 Whether the company uses a travel agency;
 Whether National and Corporate accounts utilized to obtain better pricing or larger
discounts;
 Whether the employees use a company credit card, floaters, or payment card industry (PCI);
 Periodic reviews of credit card expenditures;
 How does an employee get a company credit card;
 How are cards handled when an employee leaves the company;
 Whether there are unauthorized cards in existence or unauthorized charges.

Telephone and other Utilities Expenses:


Internal auditor has to review these areas and provide suggestions for improvement and potential
cost savings.
 Whether company is paying for phone lines that have been disconnected or paying for rates
that should have been adjusted;
 Review of utility bills and see the correct rates being used and duplicate payments are not
made. Many companies pay utilities by the “just about the same as last month” method;
looking at previous month’s bill and if it’s close, pay it with checking of error in previous bill;
 Checking the courier or postage bills.

Capital Expenditure:
 Whether there is a system of preparing Budget for procurement of Capital Goods/ execution
of Capital Projects and the same is approved by Board of Directors;
 To ensure that all capital expenditure proposals are covered by the approved Capital
Expenditure Budget;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 156


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 To review the method of fixation of technical details of capital items to be procured or capital
projects to be executed; it should also be examined that while deciding upon the
specification and make for procurement of any capital equipment it is ensured that the
equipment to be purchased conforms to the latest specification and technology available in
the market as far as practicable, depending on the availability of fund, present infrastructure,
etc.;
 Examine that while sending the price enquiries, it is ensured that enquiries are made directly
to the manufacturers or to their authorized distributors/ dealers as far as practicable;
 Whether procurement of capital equipments / execution of Projects are initiated at H.O. level
or left to the Estate level -- in case of the procurement action is initiated at Estate level, how
the internal control is exercised on such procurement;
 Whether there is any pre-fixed level of authority for approving the procurement action
according to the value;
 All cases of capital expenditure should be reviewed to see that assets created are properly
used for the purpose for which it has been procured; in case of any idle assets, the same
should be reported;
 Whether actual expenditure remains within the budget and to report on reasons for
variations, if any;
 Examination of the actual transactions on procurement of Capital goods and execution of
Capital Projects with regard to the following aspects, mainly –
(i) Selection of Vendors/ Contractors;
(ii) Fixation of Price vis-à-vis other terms and conditions;
(iii) Actual delivery of goods / completion of the projects – whether within the stipulated
period mentioned in Purchase Order; Payment of advance, if any -- whether given as per
terms stipulated in P.O. and recovery of advance as per terms of P.O.; Payment to the
Vendors/ Contractors – whether in compliance with the terms of P.O.;
 Check the records maintained for documenting progress of jobs, particularly in case of long
term projects and civil constructions, whether the payment to the contractors is linked to
the progress of jobs;
 Whether the Warranty Clause is included in all P.Os. placed for procurement of Capital
goods/ execution of projects or Civil Construction and a minimum amount (say 5% of the
total Order value) is retained as Retention Money till the completion of the Warranty period.
Security Deposit:
 Examine the records maintained for deposit of Security Money made to different authorities
like Electricity Board, Excise Dept., Sales Tax Dept., etc. – to reconcile these records with the
amount of Security Deposit shown in the Estate’s Accounts;
 Whether the original receipts of payment of each of the security deposits are available;
 Whether the purpose of any Security Deposit has lost its necessity and necessary claim has
been made with the respective authority for refund of such Security Deposit.
Investments:

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 157


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Review the management’s policy of investment including the established procedure for
deciding on an investment and withdrawal of investment and whether the same have been
complied with;
 Whether proper record of investment is being maintained;
 Whether income from the investment has been received and accrued income and any tax
deducted at source have been accounted for;
 Whether the investment certificates in physical form are being kept in safe custody of
authorized personnel;
 Whether the established procedure for transaction in physical or electronic form have been
strictly adhered to and security aspects have been complied with;
 Whether the activities are being properly administered by the Management.
Loans:
 Review the system of administration of loans;
 Critically examine the loans particularly the unsecured loans and those taken from
individuals/ institutions not engaged in extending loans in the normal course of the business,
to ascertain whether the terms and conditions are favourable for the entity;
 Whether any loan fund is being diverted to non-operating or non-profit making activities of
the entity.(iv) Verify whether the loans are being serviced properly and monthly statement of
stock and debtors are being forwarded within time, in case these are lodged as primary
security.
Property and Equipment:
 Whether the company has an acquisition policy and Disposal policy;
 Whether the proceeds received on disposal of assets deposited and recorded with
appropriate procedures;
 Whether vehicles, building plant or other assets adequately insured. Some companies do
not write off assets properly and as a result pay for insurance on assets that no longer exist.

FIXED ASSETS:
 Whether the Fixed Assets Register (FAR) in proper form is maintained both at Corporate
Office as well as at the Estate containing the following information:
a) Class of Assets;
b) Description of Assets;
c) Identification No.;
d) Location;
e) Quantity;
f) Date of putting into use;
g) Total cost of procurement of assets on which depreciation is chargeable;
h) Rate of Depreciation;
i) Total Depreciation;
j) Written Down Value (WDV)
k) Disposal , Adjustment and Transfer of Assets , if any;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 158


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 It should be checked in what form the Fixed Assets record is maintained - whether manually
in a register or in computerized form;
 In case, the FAR is maintained in computerized form, the program for maintaining such
record should be reviewed in order to check that any addition/ deletion or alteration in this
FAR would be possible only with the approval of the designated official appointed by top
management;
 It should be checked that respective Asset Identification Numbers., as per FAR, are properly
written/ painted on all the fixed assets , specifically on the labour quarters and utilities
constructed in the labour line;
 Whether FAR is updated regularly;
 Review the records evidencing regular physical verification of assets by the Estate
Management;
 Internal Auditor should also verify physically all class of assets over a specified period of
time;
 Check the status of fixed assets:-
 Whether any idle or unutilized asset is lying in the Estate and action taken by
Management for alternative use or disposal of such assets;
 Whether any scrap or redundant asset is lying in the Estate and action taken by
Management in respect of such scrapped assets.
 In case any asset has been disposed of , the system/ procedure followed for disposal of such
asset is to be reviewed with emphasis on the following aspects –
i) Whether it has been carried out with the appropriate sanction from the authority
specified in the Articles of Association of the Company or any other authority appointed
by the Court;
ii) Whether there is any laid down procedure of the entity for disposal of fixed assets and
whether it has been complied with in those cases;
iii) How the best price realization on such disposal has been ensured.
Board and other subsidy: The various schemes run by the Tea/Coffee/Rubber Board entitle the
participants to various subsidies. The internal auditor has to verify:
i) Whether the necessary forms and returns have been filed and other requirements have
been complied with;
ii) whether the claim for subsidy has been lodged and followed up;
iii) Similar verification needs to be done for any other subsidy the entity is entitled to.
Housekeeping and Fire Fighting arrangements:
 Whether there exists a proper plan for periodical house-keeping exercises and arrangement
for fighting fire breakout like keeping sand buckets and fire-extinguishers (of appropriate
type) at strategic positions;
 Whether the plan is being executed and monitoring is being done to check whether the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 159


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
refilling of the fire extinguishers is being done in time.
CONTRACT:

CIVIL CONSTRUCTION & OTHER CONTRACTS INCLUDING CONTRACTS FOR REPAIR TO BUILDING,
MACHINERY & VEHICLE:

Civil Construction & Civil Repairs:


 Examine the system of executing civil construction/ repairs –
i) Whether all the jobs are done through contractors; or
ii) Whether all the jobs are done internally engaging masons/ labour contractors and
materials are supplied by the Estates; or
iii) Whether major jobs are done through civil contractors and minor repairs are undertaken
internally;
iv) Whether any value limit has been determined by the Corporate for defining major jobs;
 Whether any panel of civil contractors are maintained by the estate from which the
contractors are engaged or civil contractors are selected on the basis of requirement of
individual jobs;
 Examine the process of selection of civil contractors - whether there is pre-fixed criteria
which are followed for selection;
 Scrutinize the credentials of the contractors selected;
 Review the process of preparation of Bill of Quantities for the jobs executed / to be
executed and the process of estimation –
i) Whether it is prepared for all jobs – major or minor;
ii) Whether it is prepared for the jobs contracted out or for all types of jobs including the
jobs done internally;
 Where the jobs are contracted out, to review the process of fixation of contract price/ rates
– whether through a competitive bidding or through negotiations on the basis of bill of
quantities and the estimates prepared;
 Examine the orders placed on the contractors including the terms & conditions – whether
the following points are covered in the contract -
(i) Schedule of jobs to be done and quantity of jobs;
(ii) Basis of rates –
a) Whether fixed for the period of contract;
b) Where variable - escalation/ de-escalation formula
c) Where high value materials like cement & steel are issued free, the method for
valuation of such free-issue items;
(iii) Security Deposit – To be retained till the completion of construction;
(iv) Period of completion;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 160


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(v) Penalty clause for delayed completion;
(vi) Warranty period;
(vii) Retention money for warranty period;
(viii) Terms of payment including interim payment on the basis of progress of jobs;
 Examine the method of recording the progress of jobs – whether the measurement book is
maintained;
 Check the method of recording the progress of jobs in measurement books and certification of
progress of jobs in measurement book – whether the recordings are in tune with the orders
placed on the contractors;
 Whether the measurement books are regularly examined and certified by any senior
management personnel in the estate;
 Whether the estate follows the practice of issuing cement/ steel as free-issue items in case of
all contracts to keep control over the quality of materials used in jobs;
 Examine the method followed for issuing free-issue items to the contractors, keeping records
of such free-issue items, accounting of free-issue items and exerting control over the utilization
and consumption of free-issue items;
 Whether the Estate maintains any register for recording the requests from staff/ workers for
carrying out repairs in their quarters and to check the system of monitoring the execution of
repairs on the basis of this record;
 Where civil construction/ repairs are done internally –
(i) To examine the method of issue materials from Stores, records maintained for utilization/
consumption of materials and system of control over the use of materials;
(ii) To examine the records pertaining to recording the attendance of missions/ labours and
their payment;
 Whether measurement book is also maintained and certified in respect of civil jobs executed
internally;
 Check the system of processing the civil contractors’ bills for payment with reference to
measurement book and terms of contract;
 Check the bills in respect of which payments have already been made – whether the
established system of processing the bills for payment have been followed in practice;
 Where advance/ progressive payment is made to the contractors in terms of contracts/orders ,
to examine the records maintained for such payments and internal control system followed for
adjustments of such payments against subsequent bills;
 Whether security deposits are obtained from the contractors and the records maintained for
this purpose;
 In case of execution of civil construction through contractors, to check whether the system of
keeping Retention Money for the warranty period has been followed in all cases;
 Compare job-wise actual expenditure with corresponding estimate/ budgeted expenditure.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 161


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Electrical & Mechanical Repair, Repair of Vehicles & Fabrication Jobs:
A lot of electrical & mechanical repairs and other fabrication jobs are required to be undertaken in
the Estates regularly including routine annual maintenance. Tea Estates, Coffee Estates and
Rubber Estates, mostly being located in remote areas, are not always facilitated with the easy
availability of the external resources equipped with upgraded and modern facilities of such repair.
In most of the cases, either the Estate has to depend on the estate’s own mechanic, electrician,
etc. or on whatever local facilities are available. External resources are only hired in case of major
repairs or big jobs. Therefore, there should be a strong internal control system to check that
those repair and fabrication jobs are executed properly and there is no wastage of resources of
fund. So, Internal Audit should concentrate on the following points for evaluation of the
effectiveness and efficacy of such internal control system.
 Whether the Budgetary Control system prevailing in respect of repair expenditure and other
fabrication jobs;
 Whether there is any laid down policy of the entity being audited for undertaking different
types of repairs and fabrication jobs;
 Review the system of preparation of estimate for individual repair to be undertaken – whether
such estimates are vetted by appropriate technical person;
 Whether in case of all major repairs and fabrication jobs, Bill of Materials (BOM) are prepared
and the same is checked and authenticated by any competent people;
 Whether the specification, make of the spare-parts/ components required for different types
of mechanical & electrical repair are standardized by any technical people before procurement;
 Check that spare parts required for electrical & mechanical repairs, which are meant to be
procured by H.O. are not procured locally except in case of extreme emergency or there is a
specific instructions from H.O. for local procurement;
 Check that the items procured at Estate level are purchased from the local authorized
distributors/ dealers of the respective manufacturers of those items;
 Whether any list of such authorized distributors/ dealers are maintained by the Estate;
 In case of machinery repair, mechanical fabrication, CTC Sharpening, etc. whether the Estate
has identified the workshop/ fabricators having appropriate infrastructure and a list of such
workshops is prepared and maintained by the Estate;
 Whether such repair/ fabrication jobs are undertaken through those enlisted parties only;
 For repair of machines or vehicles through outside workshops – whether quotations are
obtained from such parties before undertaking such repair;
 For up-gradation of engine/ processing equipments, overhauling of vehicles, whether
procurement of spare-parts including servicing are done either from the respective
manufacturers directly or from the manufacturers’ authorized dealers and service centers only;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 162


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Examine the instances of major repair expenditures whether the company’s laid down policies
are followed and whether multiple quotations have been obtained to ensure execution of jobs
most economically;
 Check that the enquiries sent to the workshops inviting quotations include all required details
so that complete quotations may be obtained as far as practicable;
 Examine the method of checking of the quotations obtained with reference to the enquiries
sent to the parties and methods followed for assessing the rates quoted for repair of vehicles
and machine from outside workshop;
 Examine the method followed for assessing the quotations as to their reasonableness where
quotations are obtained from limited sources or from single source only;
 Whether separate Repair Registers are maintained in respect of the repair of the following
categories:
(a) Electrical Repair – Machine Centre-wise or Location-wise e.g. Factory, bungalows,
office, staff quarters, labour quarters etc.
(b) Machinery –Machine-wise or Machine Group-wise,
(c) Vehicle- Vehicle-wise
These registers are required to quantify the repair job carried out against individual assets or
group of assets during a year or in successive years and to assess the viability of retaining any
asset;

 To examine the repair registers that those registers contain at least the following details:-
i) Identification No of respective machines / Vehicle Registration No
ii) Make & Model
iii)Year of put to use
iv) Nature of repair
v) In case of repair done internally- date of repair, stores requisition no for the spares issued,
value of spares and other direct expenses
vi) In case of repair done at outside workshop – works order no and date, name of the
workshop, factory gate pass no. & date, workshop challan no. & date , workshop bill no.
and date, passed bill amount;
 Review the control system exerted for movement of machines and vehicles out of estate
to workshops and back –
a) Whether pre-printed challans are used for sending them to the respective
workshops;
b) How such challans are recorded to keep track over the return of such assets after the
repair;
c) Whether a target date for completion of the repair are mentioned on the orders
placed on the workshops – whether regular checking is done for return of the assets
with reference to those targets;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 163


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
d) Whether the identification no of the machine, vehicle registration no., machine &
motor serial no is mentioned in the gate pass issued for sending any machine or
vehicle to outside workshop for repair;
e) To check whether the challans accompanying delivery of repaired machinery items
to the Estate are signed by the concerned Technical personnel of the Estate, who
checks and receives such item;
 Whether the estate follows the practice of issuing new machine spares or vehicle spares
only after the mechanic deposits the old, damaged or replaced spare parts to the Stores;
 Check the entries made in the scrap register against each issue of machine / vehicle spare
parts;
 Check the system followed for certification of the completion of repair jobs done either
through in-house workshops or through outside parties – whether certification of such
repair jobs are made by the responsible executives.
Statutory Matters:
Company Law and other statutory compliances:
(iii) Tax Laws (Excise, Agricultural tax, VAT, CST, Income tax, Service tax): Review the
administration of taxes, duties, cess etc., whether the tax liabilities are being calculated
correctly, payments are being made in time to avoid penalties, claim for refunds/rebates
have been lodged in time and follow up is being done, various tax returns are being filled
properly and submitted in time and whether tax proceedings are followed up with effective
representation.
(iv) Companies Act: Review the functioning of the secretarial department regarding
maintenance of statutory records, filing of returns with appropriate authorities, arranging
for meetings mandated by the statute and other activities, to form a judgment about the
functioning of the secretarial department. In this connection, the internal auditor shall also
refer to the report of the secretarial audit if there is any.
(v) Export and Import laws: Review compliance with export and import laws, whether
documentation has been done properly and records maintained, whether claims for export
subsidy has been made in time and followed up.
(vi) Factories Act: Review the maintenance of statutory records and filing of statutory returns.
Whether an order issued by the authority based on inspection/query made, has been
complied with or contested at the proper forum and being followed up properly.
(vii) Labour laws: Review the maintenance of statutory records and filing of statutory returns.
Whether an order issued under any of the labour laws, based on inspection/query made,
has been complied with or contested at the proper forum and being followed up properly.
(viii) Provident Fund, ESI and employee welfare schemes: Review whether deposits are being
made in time, returns are being submitted in time and proper records are being maintained.
(ix) Land Revenue and local laws: Verify whether payments are being made and records are
being made maintained.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 164


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Deposit of Statutory Dues:
 Whether the following statutory liabilities are paid within the due dates –
a) Employers’ contribution to PF and Employees’ contribution to PF deducted from their
wages;
b) PF Administration Charges;
c) Tax deducted at Source and Tax collected at Source as per Income Tax Act;
d) Service Tax
e) Cess on Made Tea;
f) Green Leaf Cess;
g) Contribution to State level Labour Welfare Fund;
h) Professional Tax/ Employment Tax deducted from the employees
i) State Level Value Added Tax/ Sales Tax and Central Sales Tax;
 Whether the contribution to Deposit Linked Insurance deducted from Salaries & Wages are
deposited with the Insurance Company in time.
Submission of Returns:
 Whether quarterly TDS Returns (Form 26-Q) are submitted regularly within due date;
 To check quarterly Service Tax Return (Form ST-3) are submitted regularly within due date;
 Whether the Returns required to be submitted to Tea Board/ Rubber Board/ Coffee Board are
submitted regularly;
 Whether Returns to be submitted under the rules framed by the respective States under
Plantation Labour Act are submitted within the due dates.
Provident Fund:
 To review the compliance with the provisions of Employees’ Provident Fund & Miscellaneous
Provisions Act, 1952 and Rules made there under.
 To check the compliance with the provisions of Assam Tea Plantation Provident Fund (in
respect of Tea Estates located in Assam);
 To check the status of submission PF Annual Return;
 To review the cases of pending Provident Fund Settlement – Whether proper follow-up is
being made with the Local Provident Fund authorities for settlement of the cases;
 To check the reasons for long pending cases of PF settlement and to report thereon.
 To check the status of filling the nomination forms by the employees ,specifically by the new
recruits;
Excise Records (For Tea Plantation only)
VAT/ Sales Tax:
 Check that State VAT/ Central Sales Tax Returns are submitted regularly and report in case of
any irregularities found;
 Scrutinize the assessment orders where the assessment is complete and to report on the
additional demand, if any, imposed by the respective Sales Tax authority;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 165


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether appeals have been filed with the Appellate Authority within the time specified in the
Act against the demands , if any , made in the Assessment Orders;
 Examine the status of receipt of Sales Tax Declaration Forms from the customers; it should
also be checked that appropriate recoveries have been made from the customers where the
customers have failed to provide with the valid Sales Tax Declaration Forms for which the
Company has to pay additional tax to the authority;
 Examine the status of receipt ‘F’ forms in case of inter-state transfer of finished goods (this is
particularly applicable in respect of transfer of Tea to the Auction Centres in other States or to
C&F Agents );
 Verify that no Input Tax Credit has been failed to be availed.
Licenses & Certificates:
 To examine the period of validity of following licenses / certificates:
i) Air & Water Pollution Certificates;
ii) Tea Waste License;
iii) Factory License;
iv) Standard Weights & Measures License;
v) Explosive License in case of HSD if stored in tanks;
vi) Pressure Vessel and Air Compressor License;
vii) Certificate of fitness Pressure Lifts, Tackles, Chain Pully, etc.;
viii) Fire Extinguishment Equipment License;
ix) Prevention of Food & Adulteration License;
x) Licences & Pollution Control Certificates pertaining to all the vehicles (including tractors,
tractor trailor, etc.) used by the estate.
 Whether the validity of the licenses or certificates have expired or going to be expired within
a short span of time;
 Check the record of the number and locations of Fire Extinguishers placed in the factory;
 Examine that records are maintained for periodical refilling of Fire Extinguishers on expiry of
their validity;
 Test check physically that content of the Fire Extinguishers have not expired.
V. Marketing and Distribution Department:
The expenses relating to the marketing and distribution department play a very vital role in any
company. Adequate care is required to be taken for collection and segregation of the expenditure
relating to the marketing, advertisement, identifying the allocation of the expenditure,
apportionment of the total expenditure where the benefit of high cost TV advertisements would
be spread over a period of more than 12 months in which case, it is appropriate to treat as
deferred revenue expenditure. Internal auditor to check:
 Check the Budget of Marketing and Distribution department and it’s comparison with actual
expenditure;
 Identify the heavy advertisement expenditure incurred in respect of electronic and print
media and its approvals as per Company policy and to check its allocation and apportionment

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 166


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
of the same in the subsequent years where its benefit passes for more than one year or
subsequent periods;
 Check the incentive policy of the Company and the commission paid for the sales relating to
the turnover and verify that the same is forming part of the selling and distribution overheads
or not;
 Whether the company is having any marketing/sales/distribution offices located throughout
the country and identify as to how the expenditure is collected, allocated and apportioned to
the cost sheet and ultimately to the product;
Check the policy of the company – whether any credit period is extended or cash and carry
scheme is in operation, for identifying the system of realization of the sale proceeds.

Marketing:
(i) Verify the management’s laid down policy and strategy for marketing/publicity through print
and electronic media, display on hoardings, distribution of pamphlets, distribution of
samples, setting up stalls at the Trade fares etc., whether within the country or abroad and
whether the same is being reviewed periodically;
(ii) Whether the credential of the advertising agency has been established and the
competitiveness of the rates offered has been verified before entering into an agreement
with the agency;
(iii) Whether proper monitoring of the agency’s activities as per the agreement is being done;
(iv) Where marketing activities are done other than through advertising agency or is
decentralized, whether proper approval has been taken and there is a check on the activities
and the expenditure incurred;
(v) Where samples are being distributed whether a plan has been drawn up for the quantity of
samples to be distributed and the targeted recipients and whether the plan has been
adhered to;
(vi) Whether assessment of the benefits derived in terms of queries received and sales generated
are being made.
Sales:
(i) Compare the quantity of dispatched from the factory with the quantity available for sale, for
any major variation;
(ii) Verify whether the transporters reported in time, timely delivery has been made and the
standard quantity per vehicle has been carried;
(iii) Compare the rates realized for different grades of tea between the productions from different
gardens;
(iv) Whether the quantity offered for various types of sales like local direct sales, export sales,
retail sales and sales through auction have been authorized by proper authority and ascertain
the comparative profitability, net of expenses;
(v) In case of direct local sales correlate the sales agreement (along with subsequent
amendments) which may be in the form of correspondence with the sales invoice issued,
stock register, gate pass, road challan, transport documents, confirmation of receipt and
excise and CST/VAT records;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 167


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(vi) In case of counter sale or other cash sales, verify the amount of sale by referring to the stock,
cash memo issued and cash received;
(vii) In case of direct export, correlate the sales agreements, sales invoices, delivery notes, bank
documents (like ‘letter of credit’) and shipping documents (like customs documents and
shipping bill) and where the amount of sale-proceeds has changed (between the amount as
per invoice, customs document and actual remittance) due to foreign exchange fluctuation,
whether the change has been accounted for in accordance with the accounting standards;
(viii) In case of sale through auction house, reconcile the quantity sold by referring to the dispatch
from warehouse, sales statements and delivery orders and other documents of the auction
house, broker’s sales advice and the report of the enterprise’s representative who attended
the auction. Verify the deductions made for claims on account of poor quality, shortage in
quantity and warehouse charges and various selling expenses with reference to the broker’s
note, the terms and conditions and other record;
Freight and Transportation:
As the Freight and Transportation costs are increasing this area should be audited more frequently
and in different ways than in the past. An internal audit of this area usually reveals that best
procedures are not always used. It is found that due to poor planning ,lack of lead time from
other department or a lack of communication result in rush shipment. Internal auditors facilitate
meetings made up of various personnel involved in a process which enables everyone to become
familiar with the process from beginning to shipment and usually improved communication across
all departments. Internal auditor has to check the following:
 Whether there are controls over what is shipped, how it is shipped, who is charged ;
 Whether the best rates attained;
 Whether there is any written policy on appropriate shipping methods and locations;
 Whether customers are being served on a timely basis. Whether freight being charged to
the customer appropriately and accurately;
 Whether there are any insurance issues, it should be investigated.
 Whether prescribed procedure has been followed by the company in issuing the
advertisement and notice inviting tenders;
 Whether all the renderers qualify to participate in the bid or are they disqualify for having
failed to discharge similar such transport contract either in that area of that company or in
any other areas of similar such companies;
 What is the back ground of the transport contractor whether he was any habitual offender in
respect of payment of taxes to the Government;
 Whether the weighing machines have been properly calibrated at periodical intervals by
authorized persons and the certificates to that effect are made available in the company ;
 Whether the transporter has given a list of dumpers of various capacities before the start of
the work and the actual transportation has been undertaken with those vehicles only and
there was no deviation;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 168


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
 Whether the transport contractor has deployed those vehicles which was supposed to have
been deployed by him as indicated in the tender notification and there was no violation or
deviation there from;
 The transport contract did not violate any the legal provisions in respect of deployment of the
Contract Labour either under the Contract Labour Act or paid the minimum wages as
prescribed under the Minimum Wages Act.
IT Department
Information Technology (IT) audits address the internal control environment of automated
information systems and how these systems are used. IT audits typically evaluate system input,
output and processing controls, backup and recovery plans, and system security. As companies
continue to automate tasks, the increase in automation leads to increased risks and the need for
proper checks and balances. Companies are required to protect data from non-authorized
individuals, whether they are employees or outside hackers. The new world has introduced new
threats such as Identity theft and cyber terrorism. Failures in information security not only a
matter of embarrassment or financial liability but lose the wrong kind of data and it could
become a criminal matter. Much of the risk can be understood and mitigated by performing
vulnerability assessments, penetration testing and security reviews on computer systems.

Potential IT Audit Areas


Disaster Recovery Program:
 Whether the company have disaster recovery programme;
 What happens if the computer fails;
 Where is your hot site or backup location;
 How will disaster affect the company payroll and product or service fulfillment;
 Internal auditor can test the disaster recovery program of the company.
Physical and Cyber Security
 Whether Company is protecting its employees, assets and information from a physical or
cyber attack;
 Whether system is setup to protect against identity theft;
 Whether the company has a plan in place in case of employee negligence or malicious
actions;
Internal auditor can conduct tests to evaluate preparedness, as well as assist with the setup of
protection against a physical or cyber security threat.

Network Security
A company’s network is exposed to significant risks as a result of internet connections, remote
access and the use of laptops. These risks include theft, systems failures, and unauthorized access
to accounting records. Exposure of some confidential information can result in loss to the
company. Companies have to consider a vulnerability assessment, penetration test or security
assessment to evaluate the effectiveness of their network security.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 169


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
Vulnerability Assessment - A vulnerability assessment uses security hardware and software to
scan a company’s outside facing computers and connections for all known software
vulnerabilities. The scan is usually non-intrusive and can take place any time of the day or night.
There is no “user” action necessary. Vulnerability assessment reports list the vulnerabilities found
on each computer scanned and provides information on how to remove or mitigate the
vulnerability found.

Penetration Test - A penetration test involves trying to legally break in to network using known
exploits and vulnerabilities. The methods used can vary from simple “social engineering,” that is,
tricking users into giving up a user ID or password, to sophisticated fake websites and emails that
trick users into giving their user ID’s or passwords to a phony “administrator.” Penetration tests
usually cost more than vulnerability assessments due to their sophistication. Unlike vulnerability
scans, penetration tests can degrade the performance of network while they are being executed.
Penetration tests are invaluable in pinpointing greatest risks. Reports are produced which detail if
and how the systems were penetrated. This information can then be used to direct computer
security resources more effectively.

Security Assessment - A security assessment requires the visit to the site, review the security
processes and policies, test the computers for vulnerabilities, test internal security settings and
make recommendations to help “harden” the security posture.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 170


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 19 Maintenance of Cost Records and Cost Audit specific to the


Industry

Government of India for the first time notified “Cost Accounting Records (Plantation Products)
Rules, 2002 published vide G.S.R. 685(E) dated 8th October, 2002” under Section 209(1)(d) of the
Companies Act, 1956.
Till year 2010, the Companies were covered under Cost Audit by specific order issued by Central
Government to a Company/Industry. In year 2011, Ministry of Corporate Affairs superseded Cost
Accounting (Plantation Products) Rules, 2002 by “Companies (Cost Accounting Records) Rules,
2011” and Plantation companies covered under these Rules were required to maintain the cost
records as per the provisions contained therein. During the year 2011-2012 separate Cost Audit
Orders were issued by the Government of India for audit of cost records by the Planation
companies if they were covered under Excise Chapters 8, 9, 21 and 40 vide Cost Audit Orders
F. No. 52/26/CAB‐2010 dated 24th January, 2012/ 6th November 2012. The Companies required to
conduct the cost audit as per the provisions of those Cost Audit Orders were required to e-file the
cost audit reports in XBRL Format as per the provisions of Companies (Cost Audit Report) Rules
2011 issued by Ministry of Corporate Affairs vide GSR 430(E) dated 3rd June 2011.
The Ministry of Corporate Affairs, Government of India has again revised the above rules pursuant
to provisions contained in the Companies Act 2013 relating to maintenance of cost records and
cost audit vide Section 148(1) and (2) and notified “Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules
2014 vide GSR 425(E) dated 1st July 2014. These Rules have been amended vide Companies (Cost
Records and Audit) Amendment Rules 2014 vide GSR 01(E) dated 1st January 2015. As per
Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 as amended, the Rubber and allied products
being regulated by the Rubber Board, Coffee and Tea are covered for maintenance of cost records
and cost audit. The provisions of the said Rules are given below:
a) Application of cost records: As per Rule 3 for the purposes of sub-section (1) of Section 148 of
the Act, the class of companies, including foreign companies defined in clause (42) of Section
2 of the Act, engaged in the production of the goods or providing services under Item (B)
Non-regulated Sectors specified in the Table below, having an overall turnover from all its
products and services of rupees thirty five crore or more during the immediately preceding
financial year, shall include cost records for such products or services in their books of
account.
b) Extract of items covered under the Plantation Industry as per Table: Item (B) Non-Regulated
Sectors are as follows:
S. Industry/ Sector/ Product/ Service CETA Heading (Wherever
No.
Applicable )
1. Rubber and allied products being regulated 4001 to 4017
by the Rubber Board
2 Coffee and tea 0901 to 0902

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 171


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Provided further that nothing contained in this rule shall apply to a company which is classified as
a micro enterprise or a small enterprise including as per the turnover criteria under sub-section
(9) of section 7 of the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development Act, 2006 (27 of 2006).
c) The cost records are to be maintained in the Form-CRA-1 of the said Rules by the companies
on which these rules are applicable. Extract of Form-CRA-1 is given at Annexure I.
The gist of the details required to be maintained under Form CRA-1 by the companies are as
follows:
 Material Costs
 Employee Cost
 Utilities
 Direct Expenses
 Repairs and Maintenance
 Fixed Assets, Depreciation
 Overheads
 Administrative Overheads
 Transportation Cost
 Royalty and Technical Know-how
 Research & Development Expenses
 Quality Control Expenses
 Pollution Control Expenses
 Service Department Expenses
 Packing Expenses
 Interest & Financing Charges
 Any other item of Cost
 Capacity Determination
 Work-in-Progress and Finished Stock
 Captive Consumption
 By-Products and Joints Products
 Adjustment of Cost Variances
 Reconciliation of Cost and Financial Accounts
 Related Party Transactions
 Expenses or Incentives on Exports
 Production Records
 Sales Records
 Cost Statements
 Statistical Records
 Records of Physical Verifications
d) The cost records referred to in sub-rule (1) shall be maintained on regular basis in such
manner as to facilitate calculation of per unit cost of production or cost of operations, cost of
sales and margin for each of its products and activities for every financial year on monthly or

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 172


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
quarterly or half-yearly or annual basis.
e) The cost records shall be maintained in such manner so as to enable the company to exercise,
as far as possible, control over the various operations and costs to achieve optimum
economies in utilization of resources and these records shall also provide necessary data
which is required to be furnished under these rules.
f) What does Constitute cost Records: As per Rule 2(e) of the Companies (Cost Records and
Audit Report) Rules, 2014, “cost records” means ‘books of account relating to utilization of
materials, labour and other items of cost as applicable to the production of goods or provision
of services as provided in section 148 of the Act and these Rules’ that provides
data/information to calculate the cost of production, cost of sales and margin of each of the
products/activities of the company on monthly or quarterly or half-yearly or annual basis are
considered part of the cost records. It includes statistical, quantitative and other records
which enable the company to exercise, as far as possible, control over the various operations
and costs to achieve optimum economies in utilization of resources and these records shall
also provide necessary data which is required to be furnished under the rules.
There cannot be any exhaustive list of cost records. This would depend on the materiality of
cost components in the cost of the production of goods or provision of services.
The abridged cost statement can be used as a sample cost statement. This may be modified
according to the need of the company.
Applicability of Cost Audit: As per sub-rule (2) of Rule 4, every company specified item (B) of rule-
3 “Rubber and allied products being regulated by the Rubber Board under Chapter Heading 4001
to 4017 and Coffee and tea under Chapter heading 0901 to 0902” shall be required to get its cost
records audited in accordance with these rules if the overall annual turnover of the company from
all its products and services during the immediately preceding financial year is rupees one
hundred crore or more and the aggregate turnover of the individual product or products or
service or services for which cost records are required to be maintained under rule 3 is rupees
thirty five crore or more.
Sub-rule (3) of Rule 4 provides that the requirement for cost audit under these rules shall not
apply to a company which is covered in rule 3, and-
(i) whose revenue from exports, in foreign exchange, exceeds seventy five per cent of its
total revenue; or
(ii) which is operating from a special economic zone
Cost Audit Report: Every cost auditor, who conducts an audit of the cost records of a company,
shall submit the cost audit report along with his or its reservations or qualifications or
observations or suggestions, if any, in form CRA-3 along with Annexure to the Cost Audit Report
as prescribed under Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 as amended.
The CRA-3 gives “Form of the Cost Audit Report” and Annexures to Cost Audit Report. Brief
description of the Annexures to Cost Audit Report as follows:
(i) Part-A of CRA-3 includes General Information about Company, General information of
Cost Auditor, Cost Accounting Policy, and Product/ Service details. It has been provided to

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 173


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
explain the difference, if any, between turnover as per annual accounts and turnover as
per excise / service tax records.

(ii) Part-B of CRA-3 provides for following Annexures for manufacturing sector:
 Quantitative Information.
 Abridged Cost Statement.
 Details of Material Consumed.
 Details of Utilities Consumed.
 Details of Industry Specific Operating Expenses.
All the above annexures are to be prepared for each product with CETA Code separately
(iii) Part C of CRA3 provides for following Annexures for Service sector. The Annexures are to
be prepared for each service separately:
 Quantitative Information.
 Abridged Cost Statement.
 Details of Material Consumed.
 Details of Utilities Consumed.
 Details of Industry Specific Operating Expenses.
(iv) Part D of CRA3 provides for following Annexures:
 Product and service profitability statement (for audited products / services).
 Profit reconciliation (for the company as a whole).
 Value addition and distribution of earning (for the company as a whole).
 Financial position and Ratio Analysis (for the company as a whole).
 Related Party Transactions (for the Company as a whole).
 Reconciliation of Indirect Taxes (for the company as a whole).
Submission of Cost Audit Report to Central Government: Every company covered under these
rules shall, within a period of thirty days from the date of receipt of a copy of the cost audit
report, furnish the Central Government with such report along with full information and
explanation on every reservation or qualification contained therein, in form CRA-4 along with fees
specified in the Companies (Registration Offices and Fees) Rules, 2014.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 174


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Chapter 20 Audit Follow up

The Institute of Internal Auditors definition of a follow-up: "A follow-up is defined as a process by
which the internal auditors determine the adequacy, effectiveness and timeliness of actions taken
by management on reported audit findings".
The value of the audit must be assessed to assure that the findings and recommendations,
reflecting cost- conscious, workable and timely solutions, have been achieved to some
quantifiable degree and provide value to the organization. Unfortunately, this does not happen as
often as it should in practice. More organizations would not outsource their audit function if they
gained a thorough understanding of the savings and improvement to operations and processes
the audit can bring.
The bottom line is how does audit enhance an organization's value? Follow-up is the answer, if an
organization is to understand what value audit can have to improving operational integrity,
efficiency and effectiveness. By looking at the prior audit recommendations of earlier work,
auditors are able to assess if the agency, company or corporation has taken any action toward the
report recommendations. If it has, a process is in place to try to assess what impact those
recommendations had and to formally report the assessment and findings. Often, auditors will
receive direct feedback from managers, supervisors or staff that their actions were the results of
an earlier audit report. In some instances, they may even provide direct information and cost
figures on how much is being saved as the result of new controls in place or improvements to the
existing processes.
Where agreed action plans are not completely implemented the auditor asks the following
questions:
 What remains to be done?
 By whom and when?
 Have alternatives been implemented that may be more appropriate?
 Has the agreed action plan ceased to be of value?
 If no action was taken, why not?
 What is the issue or concern causing inaction?
The end result should be a brief summary of the status of every action plan agreed upon. The
final summary is reviewed with the person responsible for clearing the audit report before the
follow-up report is issued.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 175


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Annexure-I
Form – CRA-1

[Pursuant to Rule 5(1) of the companies (cost


records and audit) rules, 2014]
FORM CRA-1
(Pursuant to rule 5(1) of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules, 2014)
Particulars relating to the Items of Costs to be included in the Books of Accounts

1. Material Costs-
(a) Proper records shall be maintained showing separately all receipts, issues and balances both
in quantities and cost of each item of raw material or input services (including all direct
charges) required for the production of goods or rendering of services under reference.
(b) The material receipt shall be valued at purchase price including duties and taxes, freight
inwards, insurance, and other expenditure directly attributable to procurement (net of trade
discounts, rebates, taxes and duties refundable or to be credited by the taxing authorities)
that can be quantified with reasonable accuracy at the time of acquisition.
(c) Finance costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of materials shall not form part of
material cost.
(d) Self-manufactured materials shall be valued including direct material cost, direct employee
cost, direct expenses, factory overheads, share of administrative overheads relating to
production but excluding share of other administrative overheads, finance cost and marketing
overheads.
(e) Spares which are specific to an item of equipment shall not be taken to inventory, but shall be
capitalized with the cost of the specific equipment. Cost of capital spares and or insurance
spares, whether procured with the equipment or subsequently, shall be amortised over a
period, not exceeding the useful life of the equipment.
(f) Normal loss or spoilage of material prior to reaching the factory or at places where the
services are provided shall be absorbed in the cost of balance materials net of amounts
recoverable from suppliers, insurers, carriers or recoveries from disposal.
(g) Losses due to shrinkage or evaporation and gain due to elongation or absorption of moisture
etc., before the material is received shall be absorbed in material cost to the extent they are
normal, with corresponding adjustment in the quantity.
(h) The forex component of imported material cost shall be converted at the rate on the date of
the transaction. Any subsequent change in the exchange rate till payment or otherwise shall
not form part of the material cost.
(i) Any demurrage or detention charges, or penalty levied by transport or other authorities shall
not form part of the cost of materials.
(j) Subsidy or Grant or Incentive and any such payment received or receivable with respect to
any material shall be reduced from cost for ascertainment of the cost of the cost object to
which such amounts are related.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 176


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
(k) Issues shall be valued using appropriate assumptions on cost flow, e.g. First-in-First-out, Last-
in-First-out, Weighted Average Rate. The method of valuation shall be followed on a
consistent basis.
(l) Where materials are accounted at standard cost, the price variances related to materials shall
be treated as part of material cost.
(m) Any abnormal cost shall be excluded from the material cost.
(n) Wherever, material costs include transportation costs, determination of costs of
transportation shall be governed by Para No. 9 on Determination of Cost of Transportation.
(o) Self-manufactured components and sub-assemblies shall be valued including direct material
cost, direct employee cost, direct expenses, factory overheads, share of administrative
overheads relating to production but excluding share of other administrative overheads,
finance cost and marketing overheads.
(p) The material cost of normal scrap or defectives which are rejects shall be included in the
material cost of goods manufactured. The material cost of actual scrap or defectives, not
exceeding the normal shall be adjusted in the material cost of good production. Material Cost
of abnormal scrap or defectives should not be included in material cost but treated as loss
after giving credit to the realisable value of such scrap or defectives.
(q) Material costs shall be directly traced to a Cost object to the extent it is economically feasible
or shall be assigned to the cost object on the basis of material quantity consumed or similar
identifiable measure and valued as per above principles.
(r) Where the material costs are not directly traceable to the cost object, the same shall be
assigned on a suitable basis like technical estimates.
(s) Where a material is processed or part manufactured by a third party according to
specifications provided by the buyer, the processing or manufacturing charges payable to the
third party shall be treated as part of the material cost.
(t) Wherever part of the manufacturing operations or activity is subcontracted, the subcontract
charges related to materials shall be treated as direct expenses and assigned directly to the
cost object.
(u) The cost of indirect materials shall be assigned to the various Cost objects based on a suitable
basis such as actual usage or technical norms or a similar identifiable measure.
(v) The cost of materials like catalysts, dies, tools, moulds, patterns etc, which are relatable to
production over a period of time shall be amortized over the production units benefited by
such cost.
(w) The cost of indirect material with life exceeding one year shall be included in cost over the
useful life of the material.

2. Employee Cost
a) Proper records shall be maintained in respect of employee costs in such a manner as to
enable the company to book these expenses cost centre wise or department wise with
reference to goods or services under reference and to furnish necessary particulars. Where
the employees work in such a manner that it is not possible to identify them with any specific
cost centre or service centre or department, the employees cost shall be apportioned to the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 177


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
cost centre or service centres or departments on equitable and reasonable basis and applied
consistently.
b) Employee Cost shall be ascertained taking into account the gross pay including all allowances
payable along with the cost to the employer of all the benefits.
c) Bonus whether payable as a Statutory Minimum or on a sharing of surplus shall be treated as
part of employee cost. Ex gratia payable in lieu of or in addition to Bonus shall also be treated
as part of the employee cost.
d) Remuneration payable to Managerial Personnel including Executive Directors on the Board
and other officers of a corporate body under a statute shall be considered as part of the
Employee Cost of the year under reference whether the whole or part of the remuneration is
computed as a percentage of profits. Remuneration paid to non-executive directors shall not
form part of Employee Cost but shall form part of Administrative Overheads.
e) Separation costs related to voluntary retirement, retrenchment, termination etc. shall be
amortised over the period benefitting from such costs.
f) Employee cost shall not include imputed costs.
g) Cost of Idle time is ascertained by the idle hours multiplied by the hourly rate applicable to
the idle employee or a group of employees.
h) Where Employee cost is accounted at standard cost, variances due to normal reasons related
to Employee cost shall be treated as part of Employee cost. Variances due to abnormal
reasons shall be treated as part of abnormal cost.
i) Any Subsidy, Grant, Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to any
Employee cost shall be reduced for ascertainment of cost of the cost object to which such
amounts are related.
j) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall not form part of the Employee
cost.
k) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the Employee cost.
l) The cost of free housing, free conveyance and any other similar benefits provided to an
employee shall be determined at the total cost of all resources consumed in providing such
benefits.
m) Any recovery from the employee towards any benefit provided, namely, housing shall be
reduced from the employee cost.
n) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the determination of the Employee
cost should be made only if it is required by law or for compliance with the requirements of a
cost accounting standard or a change would result in a more appropriate preparation or
presentation of cost statements of an enterprise.
o) Where the Employee services are traceable to a cost object, such Employees’ cost shall be
assigned to the cost object on the basis such as time consumed or number of employees
engaged etc. or similar identifiable measure.
p) While determining whether a particular Employee cost is chargeable to a separate cost object,
the principle of materiality shall be adhered to.
q) Where the Employee costs are not directly traceable to the cost object, these may be assigned
on suitable basis like estimates of time based on time study.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 178


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
r) The amortised separation costs related to voluntary retirement, retrenchment, and
termination etc. for the period shall be treated as indirect cost and assigned to the cost
objects in an appropriate manner. However unamortised amount related to discontinued
operations, shall not be treated as employee cost.
s) Recruitment costs, training cost and other such costs shall be treated as overheads and dealt
with accordingly.
t) Overtime premium shall be assigned directly to the cost object or treated as overheads
depending on the economic feasibility and the specific circumstance requiring such overtime.
u) Idle time cost shall be assigned direct to the cost object or treated as overheads depending on
the economic feasibility and the specific circumstances causing such idle time.

3. Utilities
a) Proper records shall be maintained showing the quantity and cost of each major utility such as
power, water, steam, effluent treatment, etc. produced and consumed by the different cost
centres in such detail as to have particulars for each utility separately.
b) Each type of utility shall be treated as a distinct cost object.
c) Cost of utilities purchased shall be measured at cost of purchase including duties and taxes,
transportation cost, insurance and other expenditure directly attributable to procurement
(net of trade discounts, rebates, taxes and duties refundable or to be credited) that can be
quantified with reasonable accuracy at the time of acquisition.
d) Cost of self-generated utilities for own consumption shall comprise direct material cost, direct
employee cost, direct expenses and factory overheads.
e) In case of Utilities generated for the purpose of inter unit transfers, the distribution cost
incurred for such transfers shall be added to the cost of utilities determined as above.
f) Cost of Utilities generated for the intercompany transfers shall comprise direct material cost,
direct employee cost, direct expenses, factory overheads, distribution cost and share of
administrative overheads.
g) Cost of Utilities generated for the sale to outside parties shall comprise direct material cost,
direct employee cost, direct expenses, factory overheads, distribution cost, share of
administrative overheads and marketing overheads. The sale value of such utilities shall also
include the margin.
h) Finance costs incurred in connection with the utilities shall not form part of cost of utilities.
i) The cost of utilities shall include the cost of distribution of such utilities. The cost of
distribution will consist of the cost of delivery of utilities up to the point of consumption.
j) Cost of utilities shall not include imputed costs.
k) Where cost of utilities is accounted at standard cost, the price variances related to utilities
shall be treated as part of cost of utilities and the portion of usage variances due to normal
reasons shall be treated as part of cost of utilities. Usage variances due to abnormal reasons
shall be treated as part of abnormal cost.
l) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
any cost of utilities shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost to which such amounts are
related.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 179


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
m) The cost of production and distribution of utilities shall be determined based on the normal
capacity or actual capacity utilization whichever is higher and unabsorbed cost, if any, shall be
treated as abnormal cost. Cost of a Stand-by Utility shall include the committed costs of
maintaining such a utility.
n) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall not form part of the cost of
utilities.
o) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the cost of utilities.
p) Credits or recoveries relating to the utilities including cost of utilities provided to outside
parties, material and quantifiable, shall be deducted from the total cost of utility to arrive at
the net cost of utility.
q) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the cost of
utilities shall be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the requirements of
a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate preparation or
presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
r) While assigning cost of utilities, traceability to a cost object in an economically feasible
manner shall be the guiding principle.
s) Where the cost of utilities is not directly traceable to cost object, it shall be assigned on the
most appropriate basis.
t) The most appropriate basis of distribution of cost of a utility to the departments consuming
services is to be derived from usage parameters.
4. Direct Expenses
a) Proper records shall be maintained in respect of direct expenses in such a manner as to
enable company to book these expenses cost centre wise or cost abject or department wise
with reference to goods or services under reference and to furnish necessary particulars.
b) Direct expenses incurred for the use of bought out resources shall be determined at invoice or
agreed price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure directly attributable thereto
net of trade discounts, rebates, taxes and duties refundable or to be credited.
c) Other expenses shall be determined on the basis of amount incurred in connection therewith.
d) Direct Expenses paid or incurred in lump-sum or which are in the nature of ‘one – time’
payment, shall be amortised on the basis of the estimated output or benefit to be derived
from such direct expenses.
e) If an item of Direct Expenses does not meet the test of materiality, it can be treated as part of
overheads.
f) Finance costs incurred in connection with the self-generated or procured resources shall not
form part of Direct Expenses. Direct Expenses shall not include imputed costs.
g) Where direct expenses are accounted at standard cost, variances due to normal reasons shall
be treated as part of the Direct Expenses. Variances due to abnormal reasons shall not form
part of the Direct Expenses.
h) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
any Direct Expenses shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of the cost object to which
such amounts are related.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 180


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
i) Any abnormal portion of the direct expenses where it is material and quantifiable shall not
form part of the Direct Expenses.
j) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the Direct Expenses.
k) Credits or recoveries relating to the Direct Expenses, material and quantifiable, shall be
deducted to arrive at the net Direct Expenses.
l) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the Direct
Expenses should be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the
requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate
preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
m) Direct Expenses that are directly traceable to the cost object shall be assigned to that cost
object.
5. Repairs and Maintenance
a) Proper records showing the expenditure incurred by the workshop, tool room and on repairs
and maintenance in the various cost centres or departments shall be maintained under
different heads.
b) Repairs and maintenance cost shall be the aggregate of direct and indirect cost relating to
repairs and maintenance activity. Direct cost shall include the cost of materials, consumable
stores, spares, manpower, equipment usage, utilities and other identifiable resources
consumed in such activity. Indirect cost shall include the cost of resources common to various
repairs and maintenance activities such as manpower, equipment usage and other costs
allocable to such activities.
c) Cost of in-house repairs and maintenance activity shall include cost of materials, consumable
stores, spares, manpower, equipment usage, utilities, and other resources used in such
activity.
d) Cost of repairs and maintenance activity carried out by outside contractors inside the entity
shall include charges payable to the contractor and cost of materials, consumable stores,
spares, manpower, equipment usage, utilities, and other costs incurred by the entity for such
jobs.
e) Cost of repairs and maintenance jobs carried out by contractor at its premises shall be
determined at invoice or agreed price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure
directly attributable thereto net of discounts (other than cash discount), taxes and duties
refundable or to be credited. This cost shall also include the cost of other resources provided
to the contractors.
f) Cost of repairs and maintenance jobs carried out by outside contractors shall include charges
made by the contractor and cost of own materials, consumable stores, spares, manpower,
equipment usage, utilities and other costs used in such jobs.
g) Each type of repairs and maintenance shall be treated as a distinct activity, if material and
identifiable.
h) Cost of repairs and maintenance activity shall be measured for each major asset category
separately.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 181


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
i) Cost of spares replaced which do not enhance the future economic benefits from the existing
asset beyond its previously assessed standard of performance shall be included under repairs
and maintenance cost.
j) High value spare, when replaced by a new spare and is reconditioned, which is expected to
result in future economic benefits, the same shall be taken into stock. Such a spare shall be
valued at an amount that measures its service potential in relation to a new spare which
amount shall not exceed the cost of reconditioning the spare. The difference between the
total of the cost of the new spare and the reconditioning cost and the value of the
reconditioned spare should be treated as repairs and maintenance cost.
k) The cost of major overhaul shall be amortized on a rational basis.
l) Finance costs incurred in connection with the repairs and maintenance activities shall not
form part of Repairs and maintenance costs.
m) Repairs and maintenance costs shall not include imputed costs.
n) Price variances related to repairs and maintenance, where standard costs are in use, shall be
treated as part of repairs and maintenance cost. The portion of usage variances attributable
to normal reasons shall be treated as part of repairs and maintenance cost. Usage variances
attributable to abnormal reasons shall be excluded from repairs and maintenance cost.
o) Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or amount of similar nature received or receivable with respect
to repairs and maintenance activity, if any, shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of
the cost object to which such amounts are related.
p) Any repairs and maintenance cost resulting from some abnormal circumstances, e.g., major
fire, explosions, flood and similar events, if material and quantifiable, shall not form part of
the repairs and maintenance cost.
q) Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to statutory authorities or other third parties
shall not form part of the repairs and maintenance cost.
r) Credits or recoveries relating to the repairs and maintenance activity, material and
quantifiable, shall be deducted to arrive at the net repairs and maintenance cost.
s) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the repairs and
maintenance cost should be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the
requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate
preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
t) Repairs and maintenance costs shall be traced to a cost object to the extent economically
feasible.
u) Where the repairs and maintenance cost is not directly traceable to cost object, it shall be
assigned based on either of the following the principles of (1) Cause and Effect - Cause is the
process or operation or activity and effect is the incurrence of cost and (2) Benefits received –
overheads are to be apportioned to the various cost objects in proportion to the benefits
received by them.
v) If the repairs and maintenance cost (including the share of the cost of reciprocal exchange of
services) is shared by several cost objects, the related cost shall be measured as an aggregate
and distributed among the cost objects.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 182


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
6. Fixed Assets and Depreciation
a) Proper and adequate records shall be maintained for assets used for production of goods or
rendering of services under reference in respect of which depreciation has to be provided for.
These records shall, inter-alia, indicate grouping of assets under each good or service, the cost
of acquisition of each item of asset including installation charges, date of acquisition and rate
of depreciation.
b) Depreciation and Amortisation shall be measured based on the depreciable amount and the
useful life. The residual value of an intangible asset shall be assumed to be zero unless:
i) there is a commitment by a third party to purchase the asset at the end of its useful
life; or
ii) there is an active market for the asset and:
a. residual value can be determined by reference to that market; and
b. it is probable that such a market will exist at the end of the asset’s useful life.
c. The residual value of a fixed asset shall be considered as zero if the entity is
unable to estimate the same with reasonable accuracy.
c) The minimum amount of depreciation to be provided shall not be less than the amount
calculated as per principles and methods as prescribed by any law or regulations applicable to
the entity and followed by it.
d) In case of regulated industry the amount of depreciation shall be the same as prescribed by
the concerned regulator.
e) While estimating the useful life of a depreciable asset, consideration shall be given to the
following factors:
i) Expected physical wear and tear;
ii) Obsolescence; and
iii) Legal or other limits on the use of the asset.
f) The useful life of an intangible asset that arises from contractual or other legal rights shall not
exceed the period of the contractual or other legal rights, but may be shorter depending on
the period over which the entity expects to use the asset.
g) If the contractual or other legal rights are conveyed for a limited term that can be renewed,
the useful life of the intangible asset shall include the renewal period(s) only if there is
evidence to support renewal by the entity without significant cost. The useful life of a re-
acquired right recognised as an intangible asset in a business combination is the remaining
contractual period of the contract in which the right was granted and shall not include
renewal periods.
h) The useful life of an intangible asset, in any situation, shall not exceed 10 years from the date
it is available for use.
i) Depreciation shall be considered from the time when a depreciable asset is first put into use.
An asset which is used only when the need arises but is always held ready for use. Example:
fire extinguisher, stand by generator, safety equipment shall be considered to be an asset in
use. Depreciable assets will be considered to be put into use when commercial production of
goods and services commences.
j) Depreciation on an asset which is temporarily retired from production of goods and services
shall be considered as abnormal cost for the period when the asset is not in use.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 183


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
k) Depreciation of any addition or extension to an existing depreciable asset which becomes an
integral part of that asset shall be based on the remaining useful life of that asset.
l) Depreciation of any addition or extension to an existing depreciable asset which retains a
separate identity and is capable of being used after the expiry of the useful life of that asset
shall be based on the estimated useful life of that addition or extension.
m) The impact of higher depreciation due to revaluation of assets shall not be assigned to cost
object.
n) Impairment loss on assets shall be excluded from cost of production.
o) The method of depreciation used shall reflect the pattern in which the asset’s future
economic benefits are expected to be consumed by the entity.
p) An entity can use any of the methods of depreciation to assign depreciable amount of an
asset on a systematic basis over its useful life, viz., Straight-line method; Diminishing balance
method; and Units of production method.
q) The method of amortisation of intangible asset shall reflect the pattern in which the economic
benefits accrue to entity.
r) The methods and rates of depreciation applied shall be reviewed at least annually and, if
there has been a change in the expected pattern of consumption or loss of future economic
benefits, the method applied shall be changed to reflect the changed pattern.
s) Spares purchased specifically for a particular asset, or class of assets, and which would
become redundant if that asset or class of asset was retired or use of that asset was
discontinued, shall form part of that asset. The depreciable amount of such spares shall be
allocated over the useful life of the asset.
t) Cost of small assets shall be written off in the period in which they were purchased as per the
accounting policy of the entity.
u) Depreciation of an asset shall not be considered in case cumulative depreciation exceeds the
original cost of the asset, net of residual value.
v) Where depreciation for an addition of an asset is measured on the basis of the number of
days for which the asset was used for the preparation and presentation of financial
statements, depreciation of the asset for assigning to cost of object shall be measured in
relation to the period, the asset actually utilized.
w) Depreciation shall be traced to the cost object to the extent economically feasible.
x) Where the depreciation is not directly traceable to cost object, it shall be assigned based on
either of the following two principles, namely;
i) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the
incurrence of cost and
ii) Benefits received – overheads are to be apportioned to the various cost objects in
proportion to the benefits received by them.
7. Overheads
a) Proper records shall be maintained for various items of indirect expenses comprising
overheads pertaining to goods or services under reference. These expenses shall be analysed,
classified and grouped according to functions.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 184


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
b) Overheads representing procurement of resources shall be determined at invoice or agreed
price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure directly attributable thereto net of
discounts (other than cash discounts), taxes and duties refundable or to be credited.
c) Overheads other than those referred to above shall be determined on the basis of cost
incurred in connection therewith.
d) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall not form part of the overheads.
e) Finance costs incurred in connection with procured or self-generated resources shall not form
part of overheads.
f) Overheads shall not include imputed cost.
g) Overhead variances attributable to normal reasons shall be treated as part of overheads.
Overhead variances attributable to abnormal reasons shall be excluded from overheads.
h) Any subsidy or Grant or Incentive or amount of similar nature received or receivable with
respect to overheads shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of the cost object to
which such amounts are related.
i) Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to statutory authorities or other third parties
shall not form part of the overheads.
j) Credits or recoveries relating to the overheads, material and quantifiable, shall be deducted
from the total overhead to arrive at the net overheads. Where the recovery exceeds the total
overheads, the balance recovery shall be treated as other income.
k) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the overheads
shall be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the requirements of a cost
accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate preparation or
presentation of cost statements of an entity.
l) While assigning overheads, traceability to a cost object in an economically feasible manner
shall be the guiding principle. The cost which can be traced directly to a cost object shall be
directly assigned.
m) Overheads shall be classified according to functions, viz., works, administration, selling &
distribution, head office, corporate etc.
n) Assignment of overheads to the cost objects shall be based on either of the following two
principles; (1) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the
incurrence of cost and (2) Benefits received – overheads are to be apportioned to the various
cost objects in proportion to the benefits received by them.
o) The variable production overheads shall be absorbed to products or services based on actual
capacity utilisation.
p) The fixed production overheads shall be absorbed based on the normal capacity.
q) Assignment of Administration Overheads shall be in accordance with para no. 8.
r) Marketing Overheads that can be identified to a product or service shall be assigned to that
product or service.
s) Marketing Overheads that cannot be identified to a product or service shall be assigned to the
products or services on the most appropriate basis.
8. Administrative Overheads
a) Administrative overheads shall be the aggregate of cost of resources consumed in activities
relating to general management and administration of an organisation.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 185


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
b) In case of leased assets, if the lease is an operating lease, the entire rentals shall be included
in the administrative overheads. If the lease is a financial lease, the finance cost portion shall
be segregated and treated as part of finance costs.
c) The cost of software (developed in house, purchased, licensed or customised), including up-
gradation cost shall be amortised over its estimated useful life.
d) The cost of administrative services procured from outside shall be determined at invoice or
agreed price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure directly attributable thereto
net of discounts (other than cash discount), taxes and duties refundable or to be credited.
e) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any amount of similar nature received or receivable with
respect to any Administrative overheads shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of the
cost object to which such amounts are related.
f) Administrative overheads shall not include any abnormal administrative cost.
g) Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to statutory authorities or other third parties
shall not form part of the administrative overheads.
h) Credits or recoveries relating to the administrative overheads including those rendered
without any consideration, material and quantifiable, shall be deducted to arrive at the net
administrative overheads.
i) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the
administrative overheads should be made only if it is required by law or for compliance with
the requirements of a cost accounting standard or a change would result in a more
appropriate preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
j) While assigning administrative overheads, traceability to a cost object in an economically
feasible manner shall be the guiding principle.
k) Assignment of administrative overheads to the cost objects shall be based on either of the
following two principles;
(i) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the incurrence
of cost.
(ii) Benefits received – overheads are to be apportioned to the various cost objects in
proportion to the benefits received by them.
9. Transportation Cost
a) Proper records shall be maintained for recording the actual cost of transportation showing
each element of cost such as freight, cartage, transit insurance and others after adjustment
for recovery of transportation cost. Abnormal costs relating to transportation, if any, are to be
identified and recorded for exclusion of computation of average transportation cost.
b) In case of a manufacturer having his own transport fleet, proper records shall be maintained
to determine the actual operating cost of vehicles showing details of various elements of cost
such as salaries and wages of driver, cleaners and others, cost of fuel, lubricant grease,
amortized cost of tyres and battery, repairs and maintenance, depreciation of the vehicles,
distance covered and trips made, goods hauled and transported to the depot.
c) In case of hired transport charges incurred for despatch of goods, complete details shall be
recorded as to date of despatch, type of transport used, description of the goods, destination
of buyer, name of consignee, challan number, quantity of goods in terms of weight or volume,
distance involved, amount paid and other related details.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 186


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
d) Records shall be maintained separately for inward and outward transportation cost specifying
the details particulars of goods despatched, name of supplier or recipient, amount of freight
etc.
e) Separate records shall be maintained for identification of transportation cost towards inward
movement of material (procurement) and transportation cost of outward movement of goods
removed or sold for both home consumption and export.
f) Records for transportation cost from factory to depot and thereafter shall be maintained
separately.
g) Records for transportation cost for carrying any material or product to job-workers place and
back shall be maintained separately so as include the same in the transaction value of the
product.
h) Records for transportation cost for goods involved exclusively for trading activities shall be
maintained separately and the same shall not be included for claiming any deduction for
calculating assessable value excisable goods cleared for home consumption.
i) Records of transportation cost directly allocable to a particular category of products shall be
maintained separately so that allocation can be made.
j) For common transportation cost both for own fleet or hired ones, proper records for basis of
apportionment shall be maintained.
k) Records for transportation cost for exempted goods, excisable goods cleared for export shall
be maintained separately.
l) Separate records of cost for mode of transportation other than road like ship or air are to be
maintained, which shall be included in total cost of transportation.
m) Inward transportation costs shall form the part of the cost of procurement of materials which
are to be identified for proper allocation or apportionment to the materials or products.
n) Outward transportation cost shall form the part of the cost of sale and shall be allocated or
apportioned to the materials and goods on a suitable basis.
o) The following basis shall be used, in order of priority, for apportionment of outward
transportation cost depending upon the nature of products, unit of measurement followed
and type of transport used:
i) Weight
ii) Volume of goods
iii) Tonne-Km
iv) Unit or Equivalent unit
v) Value of goods
vi) Percentage of usage of space
p) Once a basis of apportionment is adopted, the same shall be followed consistently.
q) For determining the transportation cost per unit, distance shall be factored in to arrive at
weighted average cost.
r) Abnormal and non-recurring cost shall not be a part of transportation cost.
10. Royalty and Technical Know-how
a) Adequate records shall be maintained showing royalty and or or technical know-how fee
including other recurring or non-recurring payments of similar nature, if any, made for the

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 187


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
goods or services under reference to collaborators or technology suppliers in terms of
agreements entered into with them.
b) Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee paid or incurred in lump-sum or which are in the nature
of ‘one–time’ payment, shall be amortised on the basis of the estimated output or benefit to
be derived from the related asset. Amortisation of the amount of Royalty or Technical Know-
how fee paid for which the benefit is ensued in the current or future periods shall be
determined based on the production or service volumes estimated for the period over which
the asset is expected to benefit the entity.
c) Amount of the Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee shall not include finance costs and
imputed costs.
d) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how fee shall be reduced to measure the amount of
royalty and technical know- how fee.
e) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how fee.
f) Credits or recoveries relating to the amount Royalty and Technical Know-how fee, material
and quantifiable, shall be deducted to arrive at the net amount of Royalty and Technical
Know-how fee.
g) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the amount of
Royalty and Technical Know-how Fee should be made only if, it is required by law or for
compliance with the requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in
a more appropriate preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
h) Royalty and Technical Know-how fee that is directly traceable to a cost object shall be
assigned to that cost object. In case such fee is not directly traceable to a cost object then it
shall be assigned on any of the following basis:
i) Units produced
ii) Units sold
iii) Sales value
i) The amount of Royalty fee paid for mining rights shall form part of the cost of material.
j) The amount of Royalty and Technical Know-how fee shall be assigned on the nature or
purpose of such fee. The amount of royalty and technical know-how fee related to product or
process know how shall be treated as cost of production; if it is related to trademarks or
brands shall be treated as cost of sales.
11. Research and Development Expenses
a) Research, and Development Costs shall include all the costs that are directly traceable to
research and or development activities or that can be assigned to research and development
activities strictly on the basis of a) cause and effect or b) benefits received. Such costs shall
include the following elements:
i. The cost of materials and services consumed in Research and Development
activities.
ii. Cost of bought out materials and hired services as per invoice or agreed price
including duties and taxes directly attributable thereto net of trade discounts,
rebates, taxes and duties refundable or to be credited.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 188


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
iii. The salaries, wages and other related costs of personnel engaged in Research, and
Development activities;
iv. The depreciation of equipment and facilities, and other tangible assets, and
amortisation of intangible assets to the extent that they are used for Research,
and Development activities;
v. Overhead costs, other than general administrative costs, related to Research and
Development activities.
vi. Costs incurred for carrying out Research, and Development activities by other
entities and charged to the entity; and
vii. Expenditure incurred in securing copyrights or licences
viii. Expenditure incurred for developing computer software
ix. Costs incurred for the design of tools, jigs, moulds and dies
x. Other costs that can be directly attributed to Research, and Development
activities and can be identified with specific projects.
b) Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or amount of similar nature received or receivable with respect
to Research and Development Activity, if any, shall be reduced from the cost of such Research
and Development Activity.
c) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall not form part of the Research
and Development Cost.
d) Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to statutory authorities or other third parties
shall not form part of the Research, and Development Cost.
e) Research and Development costs shall not include imputed costs.
f) Credits or recoveries relating to Research, and Development cost, if material and quantifiable,
including from the sale of output produced from the Research and Development activity shall
be deducted from the Research and Development cost.
g) Research and Development costs attributable to a specific cost object shall be assigned to that
cost object directly. Research & development costs that are not attributable to a specific
product or process shall not form part of the product cost.
h) Development cost which results in the creation of an intangible asset shall be amortised over
its useful life. Assignment of Development Costs shall be based on the principle of “benefits
received”.
i) Research and Development Costs incurred for the development and improvement of an
existing process or product shall be included in the cost of production. In case the Research
and Development activity related to the improvement of an existing process or product
continues for more than one accounting period, the cost of the same shall be accumulated
and amortised over the estimated period of use of the improved process or estimated period
over which the improved product will be produced by the entity after the commencement of
commercial production, as the case may be, if the improved process or product is distinctly
different from the existing process or product and the product is marketed as a new product.
The amount allocated to a particular period shall be included in the cost of production of that
period. If the expenditure is only to improve the quality of the existing product or minor
modifications in attributes, the principle shall not be applied.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 189


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
j) Development costs attributable to a saleable service namely; providing technical know-how to
outside parties shall be accumulated separately and treated as cost of providing the service.
12. Quality Control Expenses
a) Adequate records shall be maintained to indicate the expenses incurred in respect of quality
control department or cost centre or service centre for goods or services under reference.
Where these services are also utilized for other goods or services of the company, the basis of
apportionment to goods or services under reference and to other goods or services shall be
on equitable and reasonable basis and applied consistently.
b) Quality Control cost incurred in-house shall be the aggregate of the cost of resources
consumed in the Quality Control activities of the entity. The cost of resources procured from
outside shall be determined at invoice or agreed price including duties and taxes, and other
expenditure directly attributable thereto net of discounts (other than cash discounts), taxes
and duties refundable or to be credited by the Tax Authorities. Such cost shall include: Cost of
conformance to quality: (a) prevention cost; and (b) appraisal cost.
c) Identification of Quality Control costs shall be based on traceability in an economically
feasible manner.
d) Quality Control costs other than those referred to above shall be determined on the basis of
amount incurred in connection therewith.
e) Finance costs incurred in connection with the self-generated or procured resources shall not
form part of Quality Control cost.
f) Quality Control costs shall not include imputed costs.
g) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
any Quality Control cost shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of the cost object to
which such amounts are related.
h) Any abnormal portion of the Quality Control cost where it is material and quantifiable shall
not form part of the Cost of Quality Control.
i) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the Quality Control cost.
j) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the Quality
Control cost shall be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the
requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate
preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
k) Quality Control cost that is directly traceable to the cost object shall be assigned to that cost
object. Assignment of Quality Control cost to the cost objects shall be based on benefits
received by them on the principles, namely;
(1) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the incurrence
of cost and
(2) Benefits received – overheads are to be apportioned to the various cost objects in
proportion to the benefits received by them.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 190


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
13. Pollution Control Expenses
a) Adequate records shall be maintained to indicate the expenses incurred in respect of pollution
control. The basis of apportionment to goods or services under reference and to other goods
or services shall be on equitable and reasonable basis and applied consistently.
b) Pollution Control costs shall be the aggregate of direct and indirect cost relating to Pollution
Control activity. Direct cost shall include the cost of materials, consumable stores, spares,
manpower, equipment usage, utilities, resources for testing & certification and other
identifiable resources consumed in activities such as waste processing, disposal, remediation
and others. Indirect cost shall include the cost of resources common to various Pollution
Control activities such as Pollution Control Registration and such like expenses.
c) Costs of Pollution Control which are internal to the entity should be accounted for when
incurred. They should be measured at the historical cost of resources consumed.
d) Future remediation or disposal costs which are expected to be incurred with reasonable
certainty as part of Onerous Contract or Constructive Obligation, legally enforceable shall be
estimated and accounted based on the quantum of pollution generated in each period and
the associated cost of remediation or disposal in future.
e) Contingent future remediation or disposal costs e.g. those likely to arise on account of future
legislative changes on pollution control shall not be treated as cost until the incidence of such
costs become reasonably certain and can be measured.
f) External costs of pollution which are generally the costs imposed on external parties including
social costs are difficult to estimate with reasonable accuracy and are excluded from general
purpose cost statements.
g) Social costs of pollution are measured by economic models of cost measurement. The cost by
way of compensation by the polluting entity either under future legislation or under social
pressure cannot be quantified by traditional models of cost measurement. They are best kept
out of general purpose cost statements.
h) Cost of in-house Pollution Control activity shall include cost of materials, consumable stores,
spares, manpower, equipment usage, utilities, and other resources used in such activity.
i) Cost of Pollution Control activity carried out by outside contractors inside the entity shall
include charges payable to the contractor and cost of materials, consumable stores, spares,
manpower, equipment usage, utilities, and other costs incurred by the entity for such jobs.
j) Cost of Pollution Control jobs carried out by contractor at its premises shall be determined at
invoice or agreed price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure directly attributable
thereto net of discounts (other than cash discount), taxes and duties refundable or to be
credited. This cost shall also include the cost of other resources provided to the contractors.
k) Cost of Pollution Control jobs carried out by outside contractors shall include charges made by
the contractor and cost of own materials, consumable stores, spares, manpower, equipment
usage, utilities and other costs used in such jobs.
l) Each type of Pollution Control e.g. water, air, soil pollution shall be treated as a distinct
activity, if material and identifiable.
m) Finance costs incurred in connection with the Pollution Control activities shall not form part of
Pollution Control costs.
n) Pollution Control costs shall not include imputed costs.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 191


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
o) Price variances related to Pollution Control, where standard costs are in use, shall be treated
as part of Pollution Control cost. The portion of usage variances attributable to normal
reasons shall be treated as part of Pollution Control cost. Usage variances attributable to
abnormal reasons shall be excluded from Pollution Control cost.
p) Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or amount of similar nature received or receivable with respect
to Pollution Control activity, if any, shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost of the cost
object to which such amounts are related.
q) Any Pollution Control cost resulting from abnormal circumstances, if material and
quantifiable, shall not form part of the Pollution Control cost.
r) Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to statutory authorities or other third parties
shall not form part of the Pollution Control cost.
s) Credits or recoveries relating to the Pollution Control activity, material and quantifiable, shall
be deducted to arrive at the net Pollution Control cost.
t) Research and development cost to develop new process, new products or use of new
materials to avoid or mitigate pollution shall be treated as research and development costs
and not included under pollution control costs. Development costs incurred for commercial
development of such product, process or material shall be included in pollution control costs.
u) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the Pollution
Control cost should be made only if, it is required by law or for compliance with the
requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate
preparation or presentation of cost statements of an organisation.
v) Pollution Control costs shall be traced to a cost object to the extent economically feasible.
w) Direct costs of pollution control such as treatment and disposal of waste shall be assigned
directly to the product, where traceable economically.
x) Where these costs are not directly traceable to the product but are traceable to a process
which causes pollution, the costs shall be assigned to the products passing through the
process based on the quantity of the pollutant generated by the product.
y) Where the Pollution Control cost is not directly traceable to cost object, it shall be treated as
overhead and assigned based on either of the following two principles, namely;
(1) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the incurrence
of cost and
(2) Benefits received – overheads are to be apportioned to the various cost objects in
proportion to the benefits received by them.
14. Service Department Expenses
a) Proper records shall be maintained in respect of Service Departments, i.e., cost centres which
primarily provides auxiliary services across the enterprise, to indicate expenses incurred in
respect of each such service cost centre like engineering, work shop, designing, laboratory,
safety, transport, computer cell, welfare etc.
b) Each identifiable service cost centre shall be treated as a distinct cost object for measurement
of the cost of services subject to the principle of materiality.
c) Cost of service cost centre shall be the aggregate of direct and indirect cost attributable to
services being rendered by such cost centre.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 192


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
d) Cost of in-house services shall include cost of materials, consumable stores, spares,
manpower, equipment usage, utilities, and other resources used in such service.
e) Cost of other resources shall include related overheads.
f) Cost of services rendered by contractors within the facilities of the entity shall include charges
payable to the contractor and cost of materials, consumable stores, spares, manpower,
equipment usage, utilities, and other resources provided to the contractors for such services.
g) Cost of services rendered by contractors at their premises shall be determined at invoice or
agreed price including duties and taxes, and other expenditure directly attributable thereto
net of discounts (other than cash discount), taxes and duties refundable or to be credited. This
cost shall also include the cost of resources provided to the contractors.
h) Cost of services for the purpose of inter unit transfers shall also include distribution costs
incurred for such transfers.
i) Cost of services for the purpose of inter-company transfers shall also include distribution cost
incurred for such transfers and administrative overheads.
j) Cost of services rendered to outside parties shall also include distribution cost incurred for
such transfers, administrative overheads and marketing overheads.
k) Finance costs incurred in connection with the Service Cost Centre shall not form part of the
cost of Service Cost Centre.
l) The cost of service cost centre shall not include imputed costs.
m) Where the cost of service cost centre is accounted at standard cost, the price and usage
variances related to the services cost Centre shall be treated as part of cost of services. Usage
variances due to abnormal reasons shall be treated as part of abnormal cost.
n) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
any service cost centre shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost to which such amounts
are related.
o) The cost of production and distribution of the service shall be determined based on the
normal capacity or actual capacity utilization whichever is higher and unabsorbed cost, if any,
shall be treated as abnormal cost. Cost of a Stand-by service shall include the committed costs
of maintaining such a facility for the service.
p) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall not form part of the cost of the
service cost centre.
q) Penalties, damages paid to statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of
the cost of the service cost centre.
r) Credits or recoveries relating to the service cost centre including charges for services rendered
to outside parties, material and quantifiable, shall be reduced from the total cost of that
service cost centre.
s) Any change in the cost accounting principles applied for the measurement of the cost of
Service Cost Centre shall be made, only if it is required by law or for compliance with the
requirements of a cost accounting standard, or a change would result in a more appropriate
preparation or presentation of cost statements of an enterprise.
t) While assigning cost of services, traceability to a cost object in an economically feasible
manner shall be the guiding principle.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 193


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
u) Where the cost of services rendered by a service cost centre is not directly traceable to a cost
object, it shall be assigned on the most appropriate basis.
v) The most appropriate basis of distribution of cost of a service cost centre to the cost centres
consuming services is to be derived from logical parameters which could be related to the
usage of the service rendered. The parameter shall be equitable, reasonable and consistent.
15. Packing Expenses
a) Proper records shall be maintained separately for domestic and export packing showing the
quantity and cost of various packing materials and other expenses incurred on primary and or
or secondary packing indicating the basis of valuation.
b) The packing material receipts should be valued at purchase price including duties and taxes,
freight inwards, insurance, and other expenditure directly attributable to procurement (net of
trade discounts, rebates, taxes and duties refundable or to be credited) that can be quantified
at the time of acquisition.
c) Finance costs directly incurred in connection with the acquisition of Packing Material shall not
form part of Packing Material Cost.
d) Self-manufactured packing materials shall be valued including direct material cost, direct
employee cost, direct expenses, job charges, factory overheads including share of
administrative overheads comprising factory management and administration and share of
research and development cost incurred for development and improvement of existing
process or product.
e) Normal loss or spoilage of packing material prior to receipt in the factory shall be absorbed in
the cost of balance materials net of amounts recoverable from suppliers, insurers, carriers or
recoveries from disposal.
f) The forex component of imported packing material cost shall be converted at the rate on the
date of the transaction. Any subsequent change in the exchange rate till payment or
otherwise shall not form part of the packing material cost.
g) Any demurrage, detention charges or penalty levied by the transport agency or any authority
shall not form part of the cost of packing materials.
h) Any Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or any such payment received or receivable with respect to
packing material shall be reduced for ascertainment of the cost to which such amounts are
related.
i) Issue of packing materials shall be valued using appropriate assumptions on cost flow,
namely; First In First Out, Last In First Out, Weighted Average Rate. The method of valuation
shall be followed on a consistent basis.
j) Wherever, packing material costs include transportation costs, determination of costs of
transportation shall be governed by Cost Accounting Standard on determination of average
(equalized) cost of transportation.
k) Packing Material Costs shall not include imputed costs.
l) Where packing materials are accounted at standard cost, the price variances related to such
materials shall be treated as part of packing material cost and the portion of usage variances
due to normal reasons shall be treated as part of packing material cost. Usage variances due
to abnormal reasons shall be treated as part of abnormal cost.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 194


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
m) The normal loss arising from the issue or consumption of packing materials shall be included
in the packing materials cost.
n) Any abnormal cost where it is material and quantifiable shall be excluded from the packing
material cost.
o) The credits or recoveries in the nature of normal scrap arising from packing materials if any,
should be deducted from the total cost of packing materials to arrive at the net cost of packing
materials.
p) Packing material costs shall be directly traced to a cost object to the extent it is economically
feasible.
q) Where the packing material costs are not directly traceable to the cost object, these may be
assigned on the basis of quantity consumed or similar measures like technical estimates.
r) The packing material cost of reusable packing shall be assigned to the cost object taking into
account the number of times or the period over which it is expected to be reused.
s) Cost of primary packing materials shall form part of the cost of production.
t) Cost of secondary packing materials shall form part of distribution overheads.
16. Interest & Financing Charges
a) Interest and Financing charges are costs incurred by an enterprise in connection with the
borrowing of fund or other costs which in effect represent payment for the use of non- equity
fund.
b) Interest and Financing Charges incurred shall be identified for:
i) acquisition or construction or production of qualifying assets including fixed assets; and
ii) Other finance costs for production of goods or operations or services rendered which
cannot be classified as qualifying assets.
c) Interest and Financing Charges directly attributable to the acquisition or construction or
production of a qualifying asset shall be included in the cost of the asset.
d) Interest and Financing Charges shall not include imputed costs.
e) Subsidy or Grant or Incentive or amount of similar nature received or receivable with respect
to Interest and Financing Charges, if any, shall be reduced to ascertain the net interest and
financing charges.
f) Penal Interest for delayed payment, Fines, penalties, damages and similar levies paid to
statutory authorities or other third parties shall not form part of the Interest and Financing
Charges. In case the company delays the payment of Statutory dues beyond the stipulated
date, interest paid for delayed payment shall not be treated as penal interest.
g) Interest paid for or received on investment shall not form part of the other financing charges
for production of goods or operations or services rendered;
h) Assignment of Interest and Financing Charges to the cost objects shall be based on either of
the following two principles, namely;
(1) Cause and Effect - Cause is the process or operation or activity and effect is the incurrence
of cost and
(2) Benefits received – to be apportioned to the various cost objects in proportion to the
benefits received by them.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 195


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
17. Any other item of Cost
Proper records shall be maintained for any other item of cost being indispensable and
considered necessary for inclusion in cost records for calculating cost of production of goods
or rendering of services, cost of sales, margin in total and per unit of the goods or services
under reference.

18. Capacity Determination


a) Capacity shall be determined in terms of units of production or equivalent machine or man
hours.
b) Installed capacity is determined based on:
i) Manufacturers’ Technical specifications
ii) Capacities of individual or interrelated production centres.
iii) Operational constraints or capacity of critical machines or
iv) Number of shifts
c) In case manufacturers’ technical specifications are not available, the estimates by technical
experts on capacity under ideal conditions shall be considered for determination of installed
capacity. In case any production facility is added or discarded the installed capacity shall be
reassessed from the date of such addition or discard. In case the same is reassessed as per
direction of the Government, it shall be in accordance with the principles laid down in the
said directives. In case of improvement in the production process, the installed capacity shall
be reassessed from the date of such improvement.
d) Normal capacity shall be determined vis-a-vis installed capacity after carrying out following
adjustments:
i) Holidays, normal shut down days and normal idle time,
ii) Normal time lost in batch change over,
iii) Time lost due to preventive maintenance and normal break downs of equipment,
iv) Loss in efficiency due to ageing of the equipment, or
v) Number of shifts.
e) Capacity utilization is actual production measured as a percentage of installed capacity.

19. Work-in-Progress and Finished Stock


The method followed for determining the cost of work-in-progress and finished stock of the
goods and for services under delivery or in-process shall be appropriate and shall be indicated
in the cost records so as to reveal the cost element that have been taken into account in such
computation. All conversion costs incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location
and condition shall be taken into account while computing the cost of work-in-progress and
finished stock. The method adopted for determining the cost of work-in progress and finished
goods shall be followed consistently.

20. Captive Consumption


If the goods or services under reference are used for captive consumption, proper records
shall be maintained showing the quantity and cost of each such goods or services transferred
to other departments or cost centres or units of the company for self-consumption and sold
to outside parties separately.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 196


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
21. By-Products and Joint Products
a) Proper Records shall be maintained for each item of by-product, if any, produced showing the
receipt, issues and balances, both in quantity and value. The basis adopted for valuation of by-
product for giving credit to the respective process shall be equitable and consistent and
should be indicated in cost records. Records showing the expenses incurred on further
processing, if any, as well as actual sales realization of by-product shall be maintained. The
proper records shall be maintained in respect of credits or recoveries from the disposal of by-
products.
b) Proper records shall be maintained the cost up to the point of separation of products or
services shall be apportioned to joint products or services on reasonable and equitable basis
and shall be applied consistently. The basis on which such joint costs are apportioned to
different products or services arising from the process shall be indicated in the cost records.
Proper records shall be maintained in respect credits or recoveries from the disposal of joint
products or services.

22. Adjustment of Cost Variances


Where the company maintains cost records on any basis other than actual such as standard
costing, the records shall indicate the procedure followed by the company in working out the
cost of the goods or services under such system. The cost variances shall be shown against
separate heads and analysed into material, labour, overheads and further segregated into
quantity, price and efficiency variances. The method followed for adjusting the cost variances
in determining the actual cost of the goods or services shall be indicated clearly in the cost
records. The reasons for the variances shall be duly explained in the cost records and
statements.

23. Reconciliation of Cost and Financial Accounts


The cost statements shall be reconciled with the financial statements for the financial year
specifically indicating the expenses or incomes not considered in the cost records or
statements so as to ensure accuracy and to adjust the profit of the goods or services under
reference with the overall profit of the company. The variations, if any, shall be clearly
indicated and explained.

24. Related Party Transactions


a) Related Party means related party as defined under sub-section 76 of section 2 of the
Companies Act, 2013.
b) “Normal” Price means price charged for comparable and similar products in the ordinary
course of trade and commerce where the price charged in the sole consideration of sale and
such sale is not made to a related party. Normal price can be construed to be a price at which
two unrelated and non-desperate parties would agree to a transaction and where such
transaction is not clouded due to the proximity of the parties to the transaction and free from
influence though the parties may have shared interest.
c) The basis adopted to determine Normal price should be classified as under:
i) Comparable uncontrolled price method
ii) Resale price method;

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 197


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
iii) Cost plus method;
iv) Profit split method;
v) Transactional net margin method;
vi) Any other method, to be specified.
d) In respect of related party transactions or supplies made or services rendered by a company
to a company termed “related party relationship” and vice-a-versa, records shall be
maintained showing contracts entered into, agreements or understanding reached in respect
of -
(i) purchase and sale of raw materials, finished good(s), rendering of service(s),
process materials and rejected goods including scraps, etc.;
(ii) utilisation of plant facilities and technical know-how;
(iii) supply of utilities and any other services;
(iv) administrative, technical, managerial or any other consultancy services;
(v) purchase and sale of capital goods including plant and machinery; and
(vi) any other payment related to the production of goods or rendering of services
under reference.
e) These records shall also indicate the basis followed for arriving at the rates charged or paid for
such goods or services so as to enable determination of the reasonableness of such rates in so
far as they are in any way related to goods or services under reference.
25. Expenses or Incentives on Exports
a) Proper records showing the expenses incurred on the export sales, if any, of the goods or
services under reference shall be separately maintained so that the cost of export sales can be
determined correctly. Separate cost statements shall be prepared for goods or services
exported giving details of export expenses incurred or incentive earned.
b) Proper records shall be maintained giving details of export commitments license-wise and the
fulfilment of these commitments giving the reasons for non-compliance, if any. In case, duty
free imports are made, the cost statements shall reflect this fact. If the duty free imports have
been made after actual production, the statement shall reflect this fact also.
26. Production Records
Quantitative records of all finished goods (packed or unpacked) or services rendered showing
production, issues for sales and balances of different type of the goods or services under
reference, shall be maintained. The quantitative details of production of goods or services
rendered shall be maintained separately for self-produced, third party on job work, loan
license basis etc.
27. Sales Records
Separate details of sales shall be maintained for domestic sales at control price, domestic sales
at market price, export sales under advance license, export sales under other obligations,
export sales at market price, and sales to related party or inter unit transfer. In case of
services, details of domestic delivery or sales at control price, domestic delivery or sales at
market price, export delivery or sales under advance license, export delivery or sales under
other obligations, export delivery or sales under market price, and delivery or sales to related
party or inter unit transfer. Such details shall be maintained separately for each plant or unit

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 198


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
wise or service centre wise for total as well as per unit sales realization.
28. Cost Statements
a) Cost statements (monthly, quarterly and annually) showing quantitative information in
respect of each good or service under reference shall be prepared showing details of available
capacity, actual production, production as per excise records, capacity utilization (in-house),
stock purchased for trading, stock and other adjustments, quantity available for sale, wastage
and actual sale during current financial year and previous year.
b) Such statements shall also include details in respect of all major items of costs constituting
cost of production of goods and services, cost of sales of goods or services and margin in total
as well as per unit of the goods and services. The goods or services emerging from a process,
which forms raw material or an input material or service for a subsequent process, shall be
valued at the cost of production or cost of service up to the previous stage.
c) Cost statements (monthly, quarterly and annually) in respect of reconciliation of indirect taxes
showing details of total clearances of goods or services, assessable value, duties or taxes paid,
CENVAT or VAT or Service Tax credit utilized, duties or taxes recovered and interest or penalty
paid.
d) If the company is operating more than one plant, factory or service centre, separate cost
statements as specified above shall be prepared in respect of each plant. Factory or service
centre.
e) Any other statement or information considered necessary for suitable presentation of costs
and profitability of goods or services produced by the company shall also be prepared.
29. Statistical Records
a) The records regarding available machine hours or direct labour hours in different production
departments and actually utilized shall be maintained for production of goods or rendering of
services under reference and shortfall suitably analysed. Suitable records for computation of
idle time of machines or labor shall also be maintained and analysed.
b) Proper records shall be maintained to enable company to identify the capital employed, net
fixed assets and working capital separately for the production of goods or rendering of
services under reference and other goods or services to the extent such elements are
separately identifiable. Non-identifiable items shall be allocated on a suitable and reasonable
basis to different goods or services. Fresh investments on fixed assets for production of goods
or rendering of services under reference that have not contributed to the production of goods
or rendering of services during the relevant period or year shall be indicated in cost records.
The records shall, in addition, show assets added as replacement and those added for
increasing existing capacity.
30. Records of Physical Verification
Records for physical verification may be maintained in respect of all items held in the stock
such as raw material, process materials, packing materials, consumables, stores, machinery
spares, chemicals, fuels, finished goods and fixed assets etc. Reasons for shortages or surplus
arising out of such verifications and the method followed for adjusting the same in the cost of
the goods or services shall be indicated in the records.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 199


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India

Annexure II
Form CRA-3
[Pursuant to Rule 6(4) of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules, 2014]
FORM OF THE COST AUDIT REPORT

I/We,........................................... having been appointed as Cost Auditor(s) under Section 148(3)of


the Companies Act, 2013 (18 of 2013) of .........................................................(mention name of the
company) having its registered office at ..................................................... (mention registered
office address of the company) (hereinafter referred to as the company), have audited the Cost
Records maintained under section 148 of the said Act, in compliance with the cost auditing
standards, in respect of the....................................[mention name (s) of Product(s) / service(s)] for
the period/year............................. (mention the financial year) maintained by the company and
report, in addition to my/our observations and suggestions in para 2.
(i) I/We have/have not obtained all the information and explanations, which to the best of
my/our knowledge and belief were necessary for the purpose of this audit.
(ii) In my/our opinion, proper cost records, as per Rule 5 of the Companies (Cost Records and
Audit) Amendment Rules, 2014 have/have not been maintained by the company in respect
of product(s)/service(s) under reference.
(iii) In my/our opinion, proper returns adequate for the purpose of the Cost Audit have/have not
been received from the branches not visited by me/us.
(iv) In my/our opinion and to the best of my/our information, the said books and records give/do
not give the information required by the Companies Act, 2013, in the manner so required.
(v) In my/our opinion, the company has/does not have adequate system of internal audit of cost
records which to my/our opinion is commensurate to its nature and size of its business.
(vi) In my/our opinion, information, statements in the annexure to this cost audit report
gives/does not give a true and fair view of the cost of production of product(s)/rendering of
service(s), cost of sales, margin and other information relating to product(s)/service(s) under
reference.
(vii) Detailed unit-wise and product/service-wise cost statements and schedules thereto in
respect of the product/ service under reference of the company duly audited and certified by
me/us are/are not kept in the company.

2. Observations and suggestions, if any, of the Cost Auditor, relevant to the cost audit.

Dated: this ____ day of _________ 20__


at _________ (mention name of place of signing this report)

SIGNATURE AND SEAL OF THE COST AUDITOR (S)


MEMBERSHIP NUMBER (S)

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 200


The Institute of Cost Accountants of India
NOTES:
(1) Delete words not applicable.
(2) If as a result of the examination of the books of account, the Cost Auditor desires to point out
any material deficiency or give a qualified report, he/she shall indicate the same against the
relevant para (i) to (vi) in the prescribed form of the Cost Audit Report giving details of
discrepancies he/she has come across.
(3) The report, suggestions, observations and conclusions given by the Cost Auditor under this
paragraph shall be based on verified data, reference to which shall be made here and shall,
wherever practicable, be included after the company has been afforded an opportunity to
comment on them.

Guidance Note on Internal Audit of Plantation Industry Page 201

You might also like